Nothing Special   »   [go: up one dir, main page]

US20110020924A1 - Highly pure plasmid dna preparations - Google Patents

Highly pure plasmid dna preparations Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20110020924A1
US20110020924A1 US12/433,645 US43364509A US2011020924A1 US 20110020924 A1 US20110020924 A1 US 20110020924A1 US 43364509 A US43364509 A US 43364509A US 2011020924 A1 US2011020924 A1 US 2011020924A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
dna
plasmid dna
composition
polypeptide
acid
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US12/433,645
Inventor
Nancy Smyth Templeton
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
STRIKE BIO Inc
Original Assignee
Gradalis Inc
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Gradalis Inc filed Critical Gradalis Inc
Priority to US12/433,645 priority Critical patent/US20110020924A1/en
Assigned to GRADALIS,INC. reassignment GRADALIS,INC. ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: TEMPLETON, NANCY SMYTH
Publication of US20110020924A1 publication Critical patent/US20110020924A1/en
Priority to US13/431,359 priority patent/US20120231537A1/en
Priority to US14/099,488 priority patent/US20140093888A1/en
Assigned to STRIKE BIO, INC. reassignment STRIKE BIO, INC. ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: GRADALIS, INC.
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N15/00Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
    • C12N15/09Recombinant DNA-technology
    • C12N15/10Processes for the isolation, preparation or purification of DNA or RNA
    • C12N15/1003Extracting or separating nucleic acids from biological samples, e.g. pure separation or isolation methods; Conditions, buffers or apparatuses therefor
    • C12N15/1017Extracting or separating nucleic acids from biological samples, e.g. pure separation or isolation methods; Conditions, buffers or apparatuses therefor by filtration, e.g. using filters, frits, membranes
    • BPERFORMING OPERATIONS; TRANSPORTING
    • B01PHYSICAL OR CHEMICAL PROCESSES OR APPARATUS IN GENERAL
    • B01DSEPARATION
    • B01D15/00Separating processes involving the treatment of liquids with solid sorbents; Apparatus therefor
    • B01D15/08Selective adsorption, e.g. chromatography
    • B01D15/26Selective adsorption, e.g. chromatography characterised by the separation mechanism
    • B01D15/32Bonded phase chromatography
    • B01D15/325Reversed phase
    • B01D15/327Reversed phase with hydrophobic interaction
    • BPERFORMING OPERATIONS; TRANSPORTING
    • B01PHYSICAL OR CHEMICAL PROCESSES OR APPARATUS IN GENERAL
    • B01DSEPARATION
    • B01D15/00Separating processes involving the treatment of liquids with solid sorbents; Apparatus therefor
    • B01D15/08Selective adsorption, e.g. chromatography
    • B01D15/26Selective adsorption, e.g. chromatography characterised by the separation mechanism
    • B01D15/36Selective adsorption, e.g. chromatography characterised by the separation mechanism involving ionic interaction
    • B01D15/361Ion-exchange
    • B01D15/362Cation-exchange
    • BPERFORMING OPERATIONS; TRANSPORTING
    • B01PHYSICAL OR CHEMICAL PROCESSES OR APPARATUS IN GENERAL
    • B01DSEPARATION
    • B01D15/00Separating processes involving the treatment of liquids with solid sorbents; Apparatus therefor
    • B01D15/08Selective adsorption, e.g. chromatography
    • B01D15/26Selective adsorption, e.g. chromatography characterised by the separation mechanism
    • B01D15/36Selective adsorption, e.g. chromatography characterised by the separation mechanism involving ionic interaction
    • B01D15/361Ion-exchange
    • B01D15/363Anion-exchange
    • BPERFORMING OPERATIONS; TRANSPORTING
    • B01PHYSICAL OR CHEMICAL PROCESSES OR APPARATUS IN GENERAL
    • B01DSEPARATION
    • B01D15/00Separating processes involving the treatment of liquids with solid sorbents; Apparatus therefor
    • B01D15/08Selective adsorption, e.g. chromatography
    • B01D15/26Selective adsorption, e.g. chromatography characterised by the separation mechanism
    • B01D15/38Selective adsorption, e.g. chromatography characterised by the separation mechanism involving specific interaction not covered by one or more of groups B01D15/265 - B01D15/36
    • B01D15/3804Affinity chromatography
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C07ORGANIC CHEMISTRY
    • C07HSUGARS; DERIVATIVES THEREOF; NUCLEOSIDES; NUCLEOTIDES; NUCLEIC ACIDS
    • C07H21/00Compounds containing two or more mononucleotide units having separate phosphate or polyphosphate groups linked by saccharide radicals of nucleoside groups, e.g. nucleic acids
    • C07H21/04Compounds containing two or more mononucleotide units having separate phosphate or polyphosphate groups linked by saccharide radicals of nucleoside groups, e.g. nucleic acids with deoxyribosyl as saccharide radical
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N15/00Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
    • C12N15/09Recombinant DNA-technology
    • C12N15/10Processes for the isolation, preparation or purification of DNA or RNA
    • C12N15/1003Extracting or separating nucleic acids from biological samples, e.g. pure separation or isolation methods; Conditions, buffers or apparatuses therefor
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N15/00Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
    • C12N15/09Recombinant DNA-technology
    • C12N15/10Processes for the isolation, preparation or purification of DNA or RNA
    • C12N15/1003Extracting or separating nucleic acids from biological samples, e.g. pure separation or isolation methods; Conditions, buffers or apparatuses therefor
    • C12N15/1006Extracting or separating nucleic acids from biological samples, e.g. pure separation or isolation methods; Conditions, buffers or apparatuses therefor by means of a solid support carrier, e.g. particles, polymers
    • C12N15/101Extracting or separating nucleic acids from biological samples, e.g. pure separation or isolation methods; Conditions, buffers or apparatuses therefor by means of a solid support carrier, e.g. particles, polymers by chromatography, e.g. electrophoresis, ion-exchange, reverse phase
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N15/00Mutation or genetic engineering; DNA or RNA concerning genetic engineering, vectors, e.g. plasmids, or their isolation, preparation or purification; Use of hosts therefor
    • C12N15/09Recombinant DNA-technology
    • C12N15/63Introduction of foreign genetic material using vectors; Vectors; Use of hosts therefor; Regulation of expression
    • CCHEMISTRY; METALLURGY
    • C12BIOCHEMISTRY; BEER; SPIRITS; WINE; VINEGAR; MICROBIOLOGY; ENZYMOLOGY; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING
    • C12NMICROORGANISMS OR ENZYMES; COMPOSITIONS THEREOF; PROPAGATING, PRESERVING, OR MAINTAINING MICROORGANISMS; MUTATION OR GENETIC ENGINEERING; CULTURE MEDIA
    • C12N9/00Enzymes; Proenzymes; Compositions thereof; Processes for preparing, activating, inhibiting, separating or purifying enzymes
    • C12N9/14Hydrolases (3)
    • C12N9/24Hydrolases (3) acting on glycosyl compounds (3.2)
    • C12N9/2402Hydrolases (3) acting on glycosyl compounds (3.2) hydrolysing O- and S- glycosyl compounds (3.2.1)
    • YGENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
    • Y02TECHNOLOGIES OR APPLICATIONS FOR MITIGATION OR ADAPTATION AGAINST CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02ATECHNOLOGIES FOR ADAPTATION TO CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02A50/00TECHNOLOGIES FOR ADAPTATION TO CLIMATE CHANGE in human health protection, e.g. against extreme weather
    • Y02A50/30Against vector-borne diseases, e.g. mosquito-borne, fly-borne, tick-borne or waterborne diseases whose impact is exacerbated by climate change

Definitions

  • the present invention generally relates to highly pure plasmid compositions having low, or undetectable, levels of colanic acid and other contaminants.
  • the compositions described herein have a range of uses, including diverse applications in the field of bioterrorism, environmental science, food science, forensics, molecular biology, and health and medicine.
  • nucleic acid A key step for any application in which nucleic acid is introduced into an organism is the need to produce highly purified, often pharmaceutical grade, nucleic acid. Such purified nucleic acid must meet drug quality standards of safety, potency and efficacy. In addition, it is desirable to have a scaleable process that can be used to produce multi-gram quantities of DNA. Thus, it is desirable to have a process for producing highly pure nucleic acid that does not require toxic chemicals, mutagens, organic solvents, or other reagents that would compromise the safety or efficacy of the resulting nucleic acid, or make scale-up difficult or impractical. It is also desirable to prepare nucleic acids free from contaminating endotoxins, which if administered to a patient could elicit a toxic response. Removal of contaminating endotoxins is particularly important, for example, where plasmid DNA is purified from gram negative ( ⁇ ) bacterial sources that have high levels of endotoxins and colanic acid as an integral component of the outer cell membrane.
  • gram
  • Plasmids are self-replicating genetic elements that reside and multiply in host bacteria. Basically, all molecular genetic methods involving the manipulation of specific DNA fragments utilize plasmid DNA to produce large amounts of the specific DNA fragment (or protein/RNA derived from said fragment).
  • E. coli Escherichia coli
  • E. coli K-12 the primary microorganism for bacterial geneticists to study.
  • Molecular geneticists now use this same strain of E. coli for routine procedures because it turned out to be an extremely good host for a variety of molecular genetic applications.
  • E. coli K-12 has proved to be an innocuous biological host for the propagation of recombinant DNA molecules.
  • the attenuated E. coli K-12 strain does not thrive outside of the laboratory environment and it is unable to compete against the more genetically robust E. coli serotypes normally found in the human intestine.
  • plasmid DNA preparations which are produced from bacterial preparations and often contain a mixture of relaxed and supercoiled plasmid DNA, frequently require endotoxin removal, as required by the FDA, as endotoxins produced by many bacterial hosts are known to cause inflammatory reactions, such as fever or sepsis, or in some cases death, in the host receiving the plasmid DNA.
  • endotoxins are generally lipopolysaccharides, or fragments thereof, that are components of the outer membrane of gram negative ( ⁇ ) bacteria, and are present in the DNA preparation of the host cells and host cell membranes or macromolecules.
  • removal of endotoxins can be a key step in the purification of plasmid DNA for therapeutic or prophylactic use.
  • Endotoxin removal from plasmid DNA solutions primarily uses the negatively charged structure of the endotoxins. Plasmid DNA, however, also is negatively charged and thus separation is frequently achieved with anion exchange resins which bind both these molecules and, under certain conditions, preferentially elute plasmid DNA while binding the endotoxins. Such a separation results in only partial removal as significant amounts of endotoxins elute with the plasmid DNA and/or a very poor recovery of plasmid DNA is achieved.
  • nucleic acids can be separated and purified keeping the same structure in a reproducible manner, and in order to avoid the adverse effect of impurities on mammalian body, the nucleic acids are required to have been separated and purified up to high purity.
  • Plasmid DNA used for gene therapy is typically isolated from E. coli K-12.
  • Endotoxins also known as lipopolysaccharides (LPS)
  • LPS lipopolysaccharides
  • LPS contains a hydrophobic lipid A moiety, a complex array of sugar residues and negatively charged phosphate groups.
  • the lipid A moiety of LPS has demonstrated endotoxin activity and elicits a strong, potentially life-threatening inflammatory response in mammals. This inflammatory response is characterized by fever, decreased blood pressure, local inflammation, and septic shock. Lipid A induces this response by binding to serum lipopolysaccharide-binding protein (LBP) and triggering signaling through the CD14 receptor expressed on monocytes, endothelial cells, and polymorphonuclear leukocytes (Ingalls, R. R. et al. 1998 . J. Immunol. 161:5413-5420).
  • LBP serum lipopolysaccharide-binding protein
  • Endotoxin is extremely lethal when injected into mice, causing death within an hour of injection. Endotoxin is also known to drastically reduce transfection efficiencies in cells (Weber, M., et al. 1995. Biotechniques 19:930-940). Thus, the importance of using endotoxin-free plasmid DNA for gene therapy applications has long been emphasized.
  • micellar LPS separates on size exclusion resins with large DNA molecules.
  • the negative charges present on LPS molecules interacts with anion-exchange resins in a manner that leads to their copurification with DNA on anion-exchange resins.
  • Plant polysaccharides that contaminate plant genomic DNA are reported to inhibit both restriction endonuclease treatments and the polymerase chain reaction (Robbins, M. et al. 1995 . Benchmarks 18: 419-422). Furthermore, polysaccharides purified from the slime Physarum polycephalum have been reported to inhibit DNA polymerase activity (Shioda, M. and K. Murakami-Murofushi. 1987 . Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 146:61-66) and the acid polysaccharides from sea urchin embryos are known to inhibit RNA polymerase activity (Aoki, Y. and H. Koshihara. 1972 . Biochim. Biophys. Acta 272:33-43).
  • Lipid A purification methods are based on the hydrophobic properties of Lipid A. Thus, these methods remove Lipid A and the polysaccharides that are covalently linked to Lipid A. However, since only a small fraction of the capsular polysaccharides of E. coli are covalently linked to Lipid A only a few of them are removed during the standard preparation and purification procedures of plasmid DNA (Jann, B. and K. Jann. 1990 . Curr. Top. Microbiol. Immunol. 150:19-42; Wicken, A. J. 1985.
  • E. coli capsular polysaccharides have phosphatidic acid as a lipid moiety; however, the phosphatidic acid is typically hydrolyzed during the standard plasmid isolation procedures. Thus, these polysaccharides are not removed from DNA by the currently used methods that deplete endotoxin based on hydrophobicity (i.e., the presence of Lipid A binding).
  • Affinity chromatography has been proposed for removal of polysaccharide contaminants from DNA.
  • an early paper reported purification of DNA from a variety of sources, including plants, insects, fungi, and algae using affinity chromatography where deproteinized DNA fractions are passed through a column of concanavalin A linked to Sepharose (Edelman, M. 1975. Anal. Biochem. 65:293-29).
  • E. coli polysaccharides generally do not contain the sugars that bind to concanavalin A.
  • lectin affinity chromatography has been reported to be useful for removing polysaccharide contaminants from DNA isolated from fungi and plants (Do, N. and R. P. Adams. 1991 . Biotechniques 10:162-166); but the sugars recognized by lectin are not present in most polysaccharides from organisms such as E. coli.
  • a salt wash of gram-negative bacterial pellets has also been proposed as a method of purifying bacterial genomic DNA (Cahn, J. W. and P. H. Goodwin. 1995. Biotechniques 18:519-422). Salt washing was suggested as a way to improve purification of DNA because of the interference the polysaccharides present in DNA caused with restriction enzyme digestion. None of these methods, however, successfully removed all polysaccharides found in plasmid DNA.
  • WO 95/20594 and U.S. Pat. No. 5,969,129 describe a method for batch purification of genomic DNA, from corn and other plants. This purification process used polymer gels containing boronate groups to isolate DNA from DNA/polysaccharide mixtures.
  • the plasmid DNA compositions described herein have very low, or undetectable, levels of colanic acid and other contaminants.
  • the present invention is directed to gram negative bacterial plasmid composition
  • gram negative bacterial plasmid composition comprising gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA and less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • the composition comprises less than about 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • the composition comprises no detectable colanic acid.
  • the composition may also comprise less than 0.1 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative plasmid DNA, and/or less than 0.1 mg of fucose per gm of gram negative plasmid DNA.
  • the composition further comprises less than 0.05 mg uronic acid per mg of gram negative plasmid DNA. In another embodiment, the composition comprises less than 0.05 mg fucose per mg of gram negative plasmid DNA. In other embodiments, the composition comprises no detectable level of uronic acid and/or fucose.
  • Another aspect of the invention is directed to a gram negative bacterial plasmid composition
  • a gram negative bacterial plasmid composition comprising gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.1 mg uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • Another aspect of the invention is directed to a gram negative bacterial plasmid composition
  • a gram negative bacterial plasmid composition comprising gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, less than about 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.05 mg fucose acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • the composition comprises no detectable colanic acid, fucose, uronic acid chromosomal or genomic DNA, RNA, protein, and/or endotoxin contaminants.
  • FIGS. 1A , 1 B, 1 C, and 1 D shows the nucleotide and amino acid sequence of a colanic acid-degrading enzyme according to one embodiment.
  • FIG. 2 shows a gel where several different DNA plasmid samples were tested using this gel electrophoretic method for polysaccharide visualization and quantification.
  • FIGS. 3-8 show the polypeptide sequences of SEQ ID NOS: 1-6.
  • FIGS. 9-10 show the polynucleotide sequences of SEQ ID NO: 7 and SEQ ID NO: 8.
  • FIG. 11 shows the polypeptide sequences of SEQ ID NOS: 9-17.
  • FIGS. 12-14 show tables of results from post-iv injections of 120 mice with high doses of DNA-BIV liposomal complexes, purified according to the processes described herein.
  • analog refers to a molecule which is structurally similar or shares similar or corresponding attributes with another molecule (e.g. a CAE-related protein).
  • a CAE-related protein e.g. an analog of a CAE protein can be specifically bound by an antibody or T cell that specifically binds to CAE.
  • Antibody is used in the broadest sense. Therefore an “antibody” can be naturally occurring or man-made such as monoclonal antibodies produced by conventional hybridoma technology.
  • Anti-CAE antibodies comprise monoclonal and polyclonal antibodies as well as fragments containing the antigen-binding domain and/or one or more complementarity determining regions of these antibodies.
  • An “antibody fragment” is defined as at least a portion of the variable region of the immunoglobulin molecule that binds to its target, i.e., the antigen-binding region. In one embodiment it specifically covers single anti-CAE antibodies and clones thereof (including agonist, antagonist and neutralizing antibodies) and anti-CAE antibody compositions with polyepitopic specificity.
  • homolog refers to a molecule which exhibits homology to another molecule, by for example, having sequences of chemical residues that are the same or similar at corresponding positions.
  • hybridize used in the context of nucleic acids, are meant to refer to conventional hybridization conditions, preferably such as hybridization in 50% formamide/6 ⁇ SSC/0.1% SDS/100 ⁇ g/ml ssDNA, in which temperatures for hybridization are above 37° C. and temperatures for washing in 0.1 ⁇ SSC/0.1% SDS are above 55° C.
  • isolated or “biologically pure” refer to material which is substantially or essentially free from components which normally accompany the material as it is found in its native state.
  • isolated peptides in accordance with the invention preferably do not contain materials normally associated with the peptides in their in situ environment.
  • a nucleic acid or polynucleotide is said to be “isolated” when it is substantially separated from contaminant polynucleotides that correspond or are complementary to genes other than the target genes or that encode polypeptides other than the target gene product or fragments thereof.
  • a skilled artisan can readily employ nucleic acid isolation procedures to obtain an isolated polynucleotide.
  • a protein is said to be “isolated,” for example, when physical, mechanical or chemical methods are employed to remove the target proteins or polypeptides from cellular constituents that are normally associated with the protein.
  • a skilled artisan can readily employ standard purification methods to obtain an isolated protein.
  • an isolated protein can be prepared by chemical means.
  • mammal refers to any organism classified as a mammal, including mice, rats, rabbits, dogs, cats, cows, horses and humans. In one embodiment of the invention, the mammal is a mouse. In another embodiment of the invention, the mammal is a human.
  • the term “monoclonal antibody” refers to a collection of antibodies encoded by the same nucleic acid molecule which are optionally produced by a single hybridoma or other cell line, or by a transgenic mammal such that each monoclonal antibody will typically recognize the same epitope on the antigen.
  • the term “monoclonal” is not limited to any particular method for making the antibody, nor is the term limited to antibodies produced in a particular species, e.g., mouse, rat, etc.
  • the term “polyclonal antibody” refers to a heterogeneous mixture of antibodies that recognize and bind to different epitopes on the same antigen. Polyclonal antibodies may be obtained, for example, from crude serum preparations or may be purified using, for example, antigen affinity chromatography, or Protein A/Protein G affinity chromatography.
  • percent (%) amino acid sequence identity is defined as the percentage of amino acid residues in a candidate sequence that are identical with the amino acid residues in a specific polypeptide sequence, after aligning the sequences and introducing gaps, if necessary, to achieve the maximum percent sequence identity, and not considering any conservative substitutions as part of the sequence identity. Alignment for purposes of determining percent amino acid sequence identity can be achieved in various ways that are within the skill in the art, for instance, using publicly available computer software such as BLAST, BLAST-2, ALIGN, ALIGN-2, or Megalign (DNASTAR) software.
  • percent amino acid sequence identity may be determined using the sequence comparison program NCBI-BLAST2 (Altschul et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 25:3389 3402 (1997)).
  • NCBI-BLAST2 sequence comparison program may be obtained from the National Institute of Health, Bethesda, Md.
  • percent (%) nucleic acid sequence identity with respect to polypeptide-encoding nucleic acid sequences identified herein is defined as the percentage of nucleotides in a candidate sequence that are identical with the nucleotides in the polypeptide nucleic acid sequence of interest, after aligning the sequences and introducing gaps, if necessary, to achieve the maximum percent sequence identity. Alignment for purposes of determining percent nucleic acid sequence identity can be achieved in various ways that are within the skill in the art, for instance, using publicly available computer software such as BLAST, BLAST-2, ALIGN, ALIGN-2, or Megalign (DNASTAR) software.
  • nucleic acid sequence identity may also be determined using the sequence comparison program NCBI-BLAST2 (Altschul et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 25:3389 3402 (1997)).
  • NCBI-BLAST2 sequence comparison program may be obtained from the National Institute of Health, Bethesda, Md.
  • polynucleotide means a polymeric form of nucleotides of at least 10 bases or base pairs in length, either ribonucleotides or deoxynucleotides or a modified form of either type of nucleotide, and is meant to include single and double stranded forms of DNA and/or RNA.
  • a polynucleotide can comprise a nucleotide sequence disclosed herein wherein thymidine (T) can also be uracil (U); this definition pertains to the differences between the chemical structures of DNA and RNA, in particular the observation that one of the four major bases in RNA is uracil (U) instead of thymidine (T).
  • polypeptide means a polymer of at least about 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8 amino acids. Throughout the specification, standard three letter or single letter designations for amino acids are used. In the art, this term is often used interchangeably with “peptide” or “protein”.
  • a “recombinant” polynucleotide (e.g., DNA or RNA molecule) or “recombinant” polypeptide is a polynucleotide or polypeptide that has been subjected to molecular manipulation in vitro.
  • “Stringency” of hybridization reactions is readily determinable by one of ordinary skill in the art, and generally is an empirical calculation dependent upon probe length, washing temperature, and salt concentration. In general, longer probes require higher temperatures for proper annealing, while shorter probes need lower temperatures. Hybridization generally depends on the ability of denatured nucleic acid sequences to reanneal when complementary strands are present in an environment below their melting temperature. The higher the degree of desired homology between the probe and hybridizable sequence, the higher the relative temperature that can be used. As a result, it follows that higher relative temperatures would tend to make the reaction conditions more stringent, while lower temperatures less so. For additional details and explanation of stringency of hybridization reactions, see Ausubel et al., Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, Wiley Interscience Publishers, (1995).
  • “Stringent conditions” or “high stringency conditions”, as defined herein, are identified by, but not limited to, those that: (1) employ low ionic strength and high temperature for washing, for example 0.015 M sodium chloride/0.0015 M sodium citrate/0.1% sodium dodecyl sulfate at 50° C.; (2) employ during hybridization a denaturing agent, such as formamide, for example, 50% (v/v) formamide with 0.1% bovine serum albumin/0.1% Ficoll/0.1% polyvinylpyrrolidone/50 mM sodium phosphate buffer at pH 6.5 with 750 mM sodium chloride, 75 mM sodium citrate at 42° C.; or (3) employ 50% formamide, 5 ⁇ SSC (0.75 M NaCl, 0.075 M sodium citrate), 50 mM sodium phosphate (pH 6.8), 0.1% sodium pyrophosphate, 5 ⁇ Denhardt's solution, sonicated salmon sperm DNA (50 ⁇ g/ml), 0.1% SDS, and
  • Modely stringent conditions are described by, but not limited to, those in Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, New York: Cold Spring Harbor Press, 1989, and include the use of washing solution and hybridization conditions (e.g., temperature, ionic strength and % SDS) less stringent than those described above.
  • washing solution and hybridization conditions e.g., temperature, ionic strength and % SDS
  • An example of moderately stringent conditions is overnight incubation at 37° C.
  • variant refers to a molecule that exhibits a variation from a described type or norm, such as a protein that has one or more different amino acid residues in the corresponding position(s) of a specifically described protein (e.g. the CAE-protein shown in FIG. 1 or FIG. 2 ).
  • An analog is an example of a variant protein.
  • Splice isoforms and single nucleotides polymorphisms (SNPs) are further examples of variants.
  • polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading (CAE) activity of the invention include those specifically identified herein, as well as allelic variants, conservative substitution variants, analogs and homologs that can be isolated/generated and characterized without undue experimentation following the methods outlined herein or readily available in the art.
  • Fusion proteins that combine parts of different CAE proteins or fragments thereof, as well as fusion proteins of a CAE protein and a heterologous polypeptide are also included.
  • Such CAE proteins are collectively referred to as the CAE-related proteins, the proteins of the invention, or CAE.
  • CAE-related protein refers to a polypeptide fragment or a CAE protein sequence of at least 10, 15, 25, 50, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 450, 500, 550, 600, 650, 700, or more than 700 amino acids.
  • the present disclosure generally relates to “superclean” plasmid DNA preparations, processes for their preparation, and enzymes useful in these processes.
  • Polysaccharides, particularly colanic acid have been found to contaminate purportedly “clean” preparations of plasmid DNA that induce toxic effects in humans and mammals when used, e.g., for gene therapy.
  • the components that are believed to induce these toxic effects have not been identified in the literature.
  • DNA preparations include clinical diagnostics, forensics, and other biotechnology methodologies, such as chips and microarrays including nucleic acids thereon, and in molecular studies (e.g., building chromosomes, analyses of transcriptional start sites, X-ray crystallography, and DNA structural studies, among others).
  • biotechnology methodologies such as chips and microarrays including nucleic acids thereon, and in molecular studies (e.g., building chromosomes, analyses of transcriptional start sites, X-ray crystallography, and DNA structural studies, among others).
  • the present invention provides isolated, purified, and recombinant polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading activity, and processes involving their use.
  • the invention also provides isolated polynucleotides encoding such polypeptides.
  • the polypeptides described herein have a range of uses, and enable processes for digesting colanic acid in a biological material, and processes for removing endotoxins from compositions including biological macromolecules.
  • the polypeptides also enable the preparation of plasmid DNA preparations, preferably gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, comprising less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of plasmid DNA, and more preferably less than about 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of plasmid DNA.
  • no detectable colanic acid can be found in the plasmid compositions prepared by the processes described herein.
  • the plasmid compositions may also have very low levels, or undetectable levels, of other polysaccharide contaminants, such as uronic acid and fucose.
  • the disclosure relates, in part, to the discovery that the polypeptide compounds of the invention are capable of digesting colanic acid (also known as M-antigen), an exopolysaccharide produced by a range of enterobacteria, including the majority of Escherichia coli strains.
  • colanic acid may be comprised of fucose, glucose, galactose, and glucuronic acid, together with acetate and pyruvate, in various ratios (see, e.g., Sutherland, Biochem. J. 115, 935-945 (1969).
  • endotoxins and polysaccharides have been found to contaminate preparations of nucleic acids, e.g., for therapeutic uses, and it is difficult to separate endotoxins and polysaccharides such as colanic acid from nucleic acids using current standard purification procedures.
  • the polypeptides described herein may be generally used in the digestion of colanic acid in a material.
  • any material including colanic acid may be treated with the polypeptides described herein; typically, the material is a biological material.
  • the biological material may be derived from, or a part of, microbes, tissues from humans and animals, and environmental samples such as archaeological remains, compost or other decomposing matter, peat bogs, plant matter, sediment, sludge, soil, and wastewater, e.g., that are terrestrial or subterranean in origin.
  • the biological material is a biological slime.
  • the colanic acid may be present in the cellular membrane of the intact bacteria.
  • the biological material may be a crude bacterial lysate, a partially purified bacterial lysate, or an aqueous solution comprising extracted bacterial nucleic acid.
  • the biological material may be a biofilm.
  • the biological material may be pulp or pulp derivative (e.g., such as those mechanically or chemically prepared from wood or fiber sources).
  • the polypeptides described herein may be used in processes for the removal of endotoxins from aqueous compositions comprising bacterial macromolecues (e.g., plasmid DNA).
  • the polypeptides are used in processes for the purification of plasmid DNA, typically gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • compositions for example, may generally be produced by the colanic acid enzymatic digestion processes described herein, which may or may not be combined with conventional purification techniques, such as one or more combinations of chromatography and filtration steps.
  • the invention encompasses, or in addition comprises, a process of producing and isolating highly purified plasmid compositions that are essentially free of polysaccharides including colanic acid, fucose, and uronic acid, and other contaminants, and thus is pharmaceutical grade DNA.
  • the plasmid DNA produced and isolated by the processes described herein includes very low levels of endotoxin generally, including one or more of contaminating chromosomal DNA, RNA, protein, and endotoxins, and preferably contains mostly closed circular form plasmid DNA.
  • the plasmid DNA produced according to the processes described herein is of sufficient purity for use research and plasmid-based therapy.
  • the plasmid compositions of the present invention may include any types of vectors with any sizes.
  • the size range of plasmid DNA that may be purified by the processes described herein may be from approximately 0.3 kbp (mini-circle or minimal transcription unit) to approximately 50 kbp, typically 3 kbp to 20 kbp, or larger (e.g., 5 to 100 kbp, or larger, such as phage-derived shuttle vectors, HACs, YACs, MACS, and episomes derived from EBV or other non-integrating viruses).
  • the DNA includes a vector backbone of approximately 0.3 kbp, 0.5 kbp, 0.75 kbp, 1 kbp, 3 kbp, 5 kbp, 10 kbp, 15 kbp, or 20 kbp, a therapeutic gene, and associated regulatory sequences.
  • This may also apply to single stranded DNA (i.e., 0.3 kb to 50 kb, etc., such as those derived from M13).
  • a vector backbone may be capable of carrying inserts of approximately 1-50 kbp, or larger (e.g., 3-20 kbp), or approximately 1-50 kb, or larger (e.g., 3-20 kb).
  • the insert will generally depend on application in which the plasmid composition is to be used.
  • the insert may include DNA from any organism, but will typically be of mammalian origin, and may include, in addition to a gene encoding a therapeutic protein, regulatory sequences such as promoters, poly adenylation sequences, enhancers, locus control regions, etc.
  • the gene encoding a therapeutic protein may be of genomic origin, and therefore contain exons and introns as reflected in its genomic organization, or it may be derived from complementary DNA.
  • Such vectors may include for example vector backbone replicatable with high copy number replication, having a polylinker for insertion of a therapeutic gene, a gene encoding a selectable marker, e.g., the tetracycline or kanamycin resistance gene, and is physically small and stable.
  • the vector backbone of the plasmid advantageously permits inserts of fragments of mammalian, other eukaryotic, prokaryotic or viral DNA, and the resulting plasmid may be purified as described herein and used in vivo or ex vivo plasmid-based therapy, or other use.
  • the plasmid compositions can also comprise other pharmaceutically acceptable components, buffers, stabilizers, or compounds for improving gene transfer and particularly plasmid DNA transfer into a cell or organism.
  • the plasmid DNA composition is a gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition.
  • an efficient enzymatically-based process has been developed that allows for the removal of colanic acid contamination from a variety of bacterial materials, such as plasmid DNA samples.
  • the first step in the process may involve detection of colanic acid as a source of contamination (e.g., plasmid DNA contamination). This may be directly or indirectly accomplished, for example, by assaying for the presence of fucose in the sample (described below), since fucose is known to make up about 22% of colanic acid.
  • the plasmid DNA composition is a gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition comprising gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA and less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. More preferably in this embodiment, the composition comprises less than about 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. In one particularly preferred embodiment, the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition comprises no detectable colanic acid.
  • the plasmid DNA compositions of the invention also preferably include low or undetectable levels or other polysaccharide contaminants, such as uronic acid or fucose.
  • the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition comprises less than 0.1 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. More preferably in this embodiment, the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition comprises less than 0.05 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • no detectable uronic acid can be found in the plasmid DNA composition.
  • the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition preferably comprises less than 0.1 mg of fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. More preferably in this embodiment, the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition comprises less than 0.05 mg of fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. Preferably, no detectable fucose can be found in the plasmid DNA composition.
  • the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition may comprise less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.1 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition may comprise 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.05 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • no detectable colanic acid and no detectable uronic acid is present in the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition.
  • the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition may comprise less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.1 mg of fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition may comprise 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.05 mg of fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • no detectable colanic acid and no detectable fucose is present in the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition.
  • the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition may comprise less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, less than about 0.1 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.1 mg of fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition may comprise 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, less than about 0.05 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than 0.05 mg of fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • no detectable colanic acid, no detectable uronic acid, and no detectable fucose is present in the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition.
  • the plasmid compositions described herein may also include, for example, less than 0.01 mg chromosomal or genomic DNA, RNA, protein, and/or endotoxin contaminants per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA; more preferably, the composition includes less than 0.001 mg, less than 0.0001 mg, or less than 0.00001 mg chromosomal or genomic DNA, RNA, protein, and/or endotoxin contaminants per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • the plasmid compositions may comprise less than 0.1 mg (more preferably, less than 0.05 mg; still more preferably, no detectable amount) of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than 0.01 mg (more preferably, less than 0.001 mg; still more preferably, 0.0001 mg) host cell chromosomal DNA or genomic DNA contaminants per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • the plasmid composition may also comprise less than 0.1 mg (more preferably, less than 0.05 mg; still more preferably, no detectable amount) of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition, and less than 0.01 mg (more preferably, less than 0.001 mg; still more preferably, 0.0001 mg) host cell protein contaminants per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • Assays for detecting levels of colanic acid, uronic acid, fucose, and other polysaccharides are generally known in the art (or are described herein); methods of detecting chromosomal or genomic DNA, RNA, protein, and/or endotoxin that may be present in the plasmid compositions are also generally known in the art.
  • the plasmid composition of the present invention may include, less than 0.1 mg, preferably less than 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative plasmid DNA (e.g., 0.04, 0.03, 0.02, or 0.01 mg), and more preferably no detectable colanic acid, as measured by a bicinchoninic acid (BCA) assay.
  • BCA bicinchoninic acid
  • Suitable BCA assays are described, for example, in Meeuwsen et al., Biosci. Bioeng. 89, 107-109 (2000); and Verhoef et al., Carbohyd. Res. 340(11), 1780-1788 (2005).
  • An exemplary BCA assay for measuring colanic acid levels is found in Example 16.
  • the plasmid composition may include colanic acid at the levels recited in the previous paragraph, and further comprise less than about 0.1 mg, preferably less than about 0.05 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative plasmid DNA (e.g., 0.04, 0.03, 0.02, or 0.01 mg), and more preferably no detectable uronic acid, as measured by a uronic acid assay.
  • the uronic acid content of a plasmid DNA sample is measured using standard curves generated with heparin sulfate or glucuronic acid as standards. For instance, heparin sulfate resembles the polysaccharide contaminants from E.
  • Heparin sulfate consists of 50% sugars by weight. Half of these sugars are glucosamine and the other half of the sugars are iduronic acid and glucuronic acid; the rest of the heparin sulfate is contributed by modifications of the sugars including sulfates and acetylamides.
  • glucuronic acid can be used to create a standard curve for the direct measurement of uronic acid.
  • the standard solution is placed is a glass test tube with a borate/sulfuric acid solution (e.g., 0.025 M sodium tetraborate 10-hydrate dissolved in sulfuric acid having a specific gravity of 1.84) and mixed.
  • a borate/sulfuric acid solution e.g., 0.025 M sodium tetraborate 10-hydrate dissolved in sulfuric acid having a specific gravity of 1.84
  • a solution of carbazole in absolute ethanol is added to the mixture and the entire mixture is vortexed and immersed in boiling water.
  • the tubes are allowed to cool and the absorbance of the solution at 530 nm is read in a spectrophotometer.
  • the absorbance values obtained for the standards are plotted against the concentration of the standards.
  • the uronic acid content of plasmid DNA samples can be extrapolated from its absorbance value at 530 nm when the DNA sample has undergone the same reaction.
  • the polysaccharide content of the plasmid DNA sample can then be extrapolated by multiplying the amount of uronic acid by a number ranging from 3.3 to 9.1 (depending on the prevalence of colanic acid, ECA and the O- and K-antigens in the sample).
  • An exemplary uronic acid assay for measuring uronic acid levels is found in Example 16.
  • the plasmid composition may include colanic acid and/or uronic acid at the levels recited in the previous paragraphs, and further comprise less than about 0.1 mg, preferably less than about 0.05 mg of fucose per mg of gram negative plasmid DNA (e.g., 0.04, 0.03, 0.02, or 0.01 mg), and more preferably no detectable fucose, as measured by a fucose assay.
  • the basic procedures for assay of fucose content in samples can be found in Morris, Anal. Biochem. 121, 129-134 (1982). Detailed descriptions of the solution preparation and storage conditions for solutions and samples for this assay have also been published (Passonneau, J. V. and O. H. Lowry. 1974.
  • the gram negative plasmid composition preferably comprises no visually detectable polysaccharides when combined with a polysaccharide-selective labeling agent.
  • polysaccharide visualization assays involve labeling polysaccharides with a fluorescent agent and detecting their presence, e.g., on a electrophoretic medium.
  • no polysaccharides are detectable using such agents in combination with the plasmid compositions described herein.
  • the polysaccharide-selective labeling agent is (4,6-dichlorotriazinyl)aminofluorescein (DTAF).
  • DTAF (4,6-dichlorotriazinyl)aminofluorescein
  • Other polysaccharide-selective labeling agents are known or will be evident to those skilled in the art.
  • An exemplary assay utilizing a polysaccharide-selective labeling agent is found in Example 16.
  • viscosity of plasmid DNA compositions are reduced as a result of the colanic acid degradation processes described herein. Accordingly, the presence of colanic acid may be detected by comparing the viscosity of a treated plasmid DNA composition with the viscosity of an untreated plasmid DNA sample.
  • An exemplary assay utilizing viscosity levels of plasmid DNA is described in Example 16.
  • the LD 50 the dose lethal to 50% of the test population
  • the corresponding LD 50 of the plasmid composition is increased by at least 25%; more preferably in this embodiment, by at least 50%.
  • the corresponding LD 50 of the plasmid composition may be increased by at least 50%, by at least 75%, or by at least 100%.
  • the corresponding LD 50 of the plasmid composition may be increased by at least 50%; more preferably in this embodiment, at least 100%.
  • the plasmid compositions of the present invention may be utilized in a wide range of applications, including those in fields of bioterrorism (agent detection and analysis), environmental science (e.g., agriculture, horticulture, and forestry), food science, forensics, molecular biology, health and medicine (e.g., gene therapy, diagnostics, recombinant protein expression), and space science, to name a few.
  • bioterrorism agent detection and analysis
  • environmental science e.g., agriculture, horticulture, and forestry
  • food science e.g., forensics, molecular biology, health and medicine (e.g., gene therapy, diagnostics, recombinant protein expression), and space science, to name a few.
  • the highly pure plasmid compositions described herein may be employed in vivo or ex vivo, for example, in gene therapy and vaccine-based applications (i.e., the plasmid compositions may be administered to mammals, including humans).
  • the plasmid compositions may be used in conventional diagnostics and forensics techniques, for example, to improve the stability, specificity, reproducibility, and/or sensitivity of such methodologies.
  • This may include, for example, the analysis, detection, or examination of samples from the environment, e.g. from public water supplies, samples from foodstuffs, and from other biological or clinical samples, such as blood, saliva, sputum, semen, buccal smears, urine or fecal waste, cell and tissue biopsies and micro dissections, amniotic fluid, or tissue homogenates of plants, animals, or human patients, and the like.
  • plasmid compositions described herein include genotyping microorganisms, DNA fingerprinting of plants and animals, detecting pathogens and beneficial microorganisms in soils, water, plants and animals, forensic identification of biological samples and environmental samples contaminated with different biological entities, and molecular studies such as, for instance, building chromosomes, analyses of transcriptional information, X-ray crystallography, and DNA structural studies.
  • the plasmid compositions may also be used in conjunction or in combination with solid substrate chip formats that detect, among other things, genes, mutations or mRNA expression levels such as nucleic acid microarrays and molecular detection chips employing, for example, fluorescence, radioactivity, optical interferometry, Raman spectrometry, semi-conductor, or other electronics (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 7,098,286; U.S. Pat. No. 6,924,094; and U.S. Pat. No. 6,824,866 (each of which is hereby incorporated by reference herein)).
  • the polypeptides of the present invention can be utilized in a wide range of processes, particularly those which involve, require, or otherwise benefit from digestion or degradation of colanic acid, typically in a biological material, such as a bacterial sample, or compositions (such as aqueous compositions) comprising bacterial macromolecules.
  • biological material including undesirable colanic acid may be treated with the polypeptides described herein, including biofilms (i.e., structured communities of microorganisms encapsulated within self-developed polymeric matrices, either adherent to a living or inert surface, or on its own), bacterial lysates, plasmid DNA, and the like.
  • the processes described herein generally involve the digestion of colanic acid in a biological material, or otherwise in a composition comprising a biological material.
  • the processes employ the polypeptides described herein to digest or degrade colanic acid that may be present in the material.
  • One embodiment of the processes described herein involves, for example, the digestion of colanic acid from a biological material.
  • the processes may involve the digestion of colanic acid in an aqueous composition containing bacterial macromolecules.
  • the processes may involve treating an aqueous composition containing plasmid DNA with a polypeptide to digest colanic acid.
  • a polypeptide is used to digest colanic acid present in the sample; thus, the polynucleotide has colanic acid-degrading activity, or is otherwise a colanic acid-degrading enzyme.
  • the process involves digesting in a biological material and the process comprises contacting the biological material with a polypeptide capable of digesting colanic acid.
  • the biological material may be, for example, a crude bacterial lysate, a partially purified bacterial lysate, and an aqueous solution containing extracted bacterial nucleic acid (such as gram negative plasmid DNA).
  • the biological material may be a bacterial slime.
  • the biological material may be a biofilm comprising gram negative bacteria.
  • the bacterial material may be present in a pulp (e.g., wood or fiber pulp) composition, solution, or mixture.
  • the process involves the removal of endotoxin from an aqueous composition containing bacterial macromolecules and the process comprises digesting colanic acid in the aqueous composition and thereafter combining the aqueous composition with a chromatographic material to separate endotoxin from the bacterial macromolecule.
  • the process involves purification of plasmid DNA, such as gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and the process comprises treating an aqueous composition containing plasmid DNA with a polypeptide to digest colanic acid and separating the plasmid DNA from the treated aqueous composition using, for example, conventional chromatography techniques.
  • the polypeptide may also be employed in a range of industrial processes described below.
  • a process for removal of contaminating polysaccharides from plasmid DNA samples has been developed that allows for the removal of polysaccharides, including those other than LPS, from plasmid DNA samples.
  • polysaccharides including those other than LPS
  • RNA and LPS are also removed from the plasmid DNA samples. Therefore, the method of the present invention results in purified plasmid DNA that contains extremely low, and in many cases undetectable, levels of polysaccharides as described below.
  • the certain steps may be performed to quantify the polysaccharide levels in DNA samples, allowing the investigator to assure the removal of polysaccharides from the DNA sample.
  • polypeptides described herein may be employed.
  • the polypeptide may comprise an amino acid sequence having at least 90% homology to SEQ ID NO: 1, or the polypeptide may comprise an amino acid sequence having at least 90% homology to SEQ ID NO: 2.
  • the polypeptide has the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1.
  • the polypeptide has the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 2.
  • the starting material for certain of the processes described herein is a mass of bacterial material, or an aqueous composition comprising such biological material, such as bacterial cells or other biological matter prepared by, e.g., fermentation or cell culture, isolated from the environment, or derived from tissues or other organisms (e.g., fungi, bacteria, etc.).
  • the biological material comprises bacterial cells derived from enterobacteria, such as E. coli .
  • the biological material is a bacterial slime; according to this embodiment, for example, colanic acid is present in the cellular membrane of the bacteria.
  • the biological material is a gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA material.
  • a variety of cell types can be used as feed for the processes described herein, such as bacteria (e.g., gram ( ⁇ ), gram (+), and Archaea), yeast, and other prokaryotic and eukaryotic cells, including mammalian cells and recombinant cells.
  • bacteria e.g., gram ( ⁇ ), gram (+), and Archaea
  • yeast and other prokaryotic and eukaryotic cells, including mammalian cells and recombinant cells.
  • bacterial cells and in particular gram positive (+) and gram negative ( ⁇ ) bacterial cells, such as E. coli, Salmonella , or Bacillus , are preferred, with gram negative ( ⁇ ) bacterial cells being most preferred.
  • the bacteria is a gram negative ( ⁇ ) bacteria; more preferably in this embodiment, the bacteria is E. coli .
  • E. coli A wide selection of well-established E.
  • coli host strains are useful according to the processes described herein, and are available from Stratagene (La Jolla, Calif.), Qiagen (Valencia, Calif.), New England BioLabs (Ipswich, Mass.), and Promega (Madison, Wis.), among other commercial sources.
  • the biological material is a bacterial lysate, or a derivative thereof.
  • bacterial starting material e.g., bacterial cells, etc.
  • the bacterial lysis step involves any conventional method for breaking open bacterial cells, thus liberating nucleic acids and other cell components therefrom.
  • the lysis procedure may involve the use of mechanical methods, lysing agents or solutions, or combinations thereof.
  • the cells are disrupted by chemical or mechanical techniques as described below, forming a crude lysate.
  • the bacterial cells are lysed to form a crude bacterial lysate.
  • the cellular components including DNA, RNA, proteins, colanic acid, and other polysaccharides, are released from the cells.
  • the lysate may undergo pre-treatment steps, such as purification steps to remove cell contaminants and endotoxins, thus forming a partially purified (e.g., bacterial) lysate.
  • the lysing agent is used to break down cell membranes, thus releasing DNA, RNA and proteins from the cells.
  • One preferred lysing agent comprises an alkaline solution.
  • bases may be employed in conventional alkaline lysis procedures, including, for example, hydroxide salts, such as potassium hydroxide (KOH), lithium hydroxide (LiOH), or sodium hydroxide (NaOH).
  • the base is sodium hydroxide.
  • detergents are employed in lysing solutions, either alone or in combination with the alkaline solution.
  • the detergent may be an cationic, anionic, non-ionic, or zwitterionic detergent, or a combination thereof.
  • One exemplary anionic detergent is sodium dodecyl sulfate (SDS).
  • One exemplary zwitterionic or non-ionic detergent is Tween 20.
  • Mechanical methods for lysing bacterial cells for use either alone or in combination with lysis solutions and agents, include agitation, sonication, centrifugation, freeze/thawing, French cell press, and the like.
  • Alkaline lysis and mechanical techniques for lysing bacterial cells to release and extract proteins and nucleic acids are generally well known, and are described, for example, in Sambrook et al., supra.
  • RNAse can optionally be added at various points in the procedure to create a cleared lysate that is substantially free of RNA.
  • initial removal of many cellular and nucleic acid contaminants can improve colanic acid digestion and/or further purification of the plasmid DNA using conventional chromatographic techniques. Methods of creating cleared lysates are well-known in the art.
  • a cleared lysate can be produced by treating the host cells with sodium hydroxide or its equivalent (0.2N) and sodium dodecyl sulfate (SDS) (1%), centrifuging, and discarding the supernatant.
  • SDS sodium dodecyl sulfate
  • This method of creating a cleared lysate is generally described, for example, in Burnboim et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 7, 1513 (1979); and Horowicz et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 9, 2989 (1981).
  • nucleic acid obtained from the bacterial or other lysate it may be desirable to further purify the nucleic acid obtained from the bacterial or other lysate, either before or after the sample is contacted with the colanic acid-degrading polypeptide.
  • the material or composition comprising the biological matter is combined with an ion exchange chromatographic material prior to treatment with the polypeptide.
  • the chromatographic material is a anion exchange chromatographic resin.
  • the anion exchange chromatographic resin comprises diethylaminoethyl cellulose (DEAE).
  • conventional DNA including plasmid DNA, cleaning techniques can be employed.
  • the biological material may also be combined with chromatographic material following treatment with the polypeptide. This generally involves affinity chromatography and/or hydrophobic interaction chromatography.
  • the biological material or aqueous composition is combined with an anion exchange chromatography resin, treated with the polypeptide, combined with an affinity chromatography resin, combined with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography resin, and subjected to filtration, in that order.
  • the material is treated with the polypeptide described herein.
  • treatment involves contacting or mixing the polypeptide with the biological material such that the polypeptide will have access to the colanic acid substrate present in the material or composition.
  • the biological material and the polypeptide are incubated to allow sufficient interaction between the enzyme and the colanic acid substrate.
  • the duration of the incubation may be from 1 to 6 hours, 6 to 12 hours, 12 to 24 hours, or longer, depending on the size of the sample to be digested, the amount of polypeptide employed, and environmental factors, such as temperature, atmosphere, etc.
  • the incubation is generally carried out at a temperature of between 0° C.
  • the temperature during the incubation process may be desirable to vary the temperature during the incubation process, for example, starting the incubation at a cooler temperature, and then raising the temperature for the remainder of the incubation cycle, or vice versa.
  • the biological material or composition may be combined with a chromatographic material.
  • Suitable chromatographic materials include, for example, ion exchange chromatography resins (such as anion exchange chromatography resins and cation exchange chromatography resins), hydrophobic interaction chromatography resins, and affinity chromatography resins, among a range of others.
  • the chromatographic material is selected from the group consisting of an anion exchange chromatography resin, a cation exchange chromatography resin, a hydrophobic interaction chromatography resin, and an affinity chromatography resin.
  • the biological material or composition may be combined with the chromatographic material(s) prior to, or after, treatment with the polypeptide, or both before and after treatment with the polypeptide, with single or multiple chromatographic separations being employed.
  • the sample can be combined with a chromatography material, treated with the polypeptide as described herein, and subjected to a second (or third, fourth, fifth, etc.) chromatography step.
  • the sample can be subjected to conventional filtration techniques to further purify or remove contaminants from the sample. The filtration steps may occur relatively early in the process, e.g., prior to treatment with the enzyme, or later in the process, e.g., as final filtration steps prior to storage or use of the end product.
  • the processes of the invention comprise the use of an polypeptide capable of degrading colanic acid present in a bacterial lysate sample, which is preceded by or followed by at least one additional chromatography technique.
  • the additional chromatography step may exist optionally or typically as one or more of the final purification steps or at least at the end or near the end of the sample or plasmid purification scheme, or prior to the colanic acid digestion step.
  • ion exchange chromatography e.g., affinity chromatography
  • hydrophobic interaction chromatography e.g., boronate affinity chromatography
  • the method of the invention comprises an colanic acid digestion step with one or more step of ion exchange chromatography and further may include affinity chromatography, hydrophobic interaction chromatography or gel permeation chromatography, and/or filtration (such as tangential flow filtration (TFF) or size exclusion filtration).
  • THF tangential flow filtration
  • the step of ion exchange chromatography may be both in fluidized bed ion exchange chromatography and axial and/or radial high resolution anion exchange chromatography.
  • ion exchange chromatography is performed prior to the colanic acid degradation step, in order to remove particles that may hinder the ability of the enzyme to interact with the substrate.
  • Processes of the invention described herein, e.g., for purifying plasmid DNA, are scalable and thus amenable to scale-up to large-scale manufacture.
  • colanic acid degradation step may be combined with additional purification steps to result in a high purity product containing plasmid DNA. It may, for example, be combined with at least one of flocculate removal (such as lysate filtration, settling, or centrifugation), ion exchange chromatography (such as cation or anion exchange), and hydrophobic interaction chromatography.
  • flocculate removal such as lysate filtration, settling, or centrifugation
  • ion exchange chromatography such as cation or anion exchange
  • hydrophobic interaction chromatography such as flocculate removal, filtration, settling, or centrifugation
  • the colanic acid degradation step is preceded by ion exchange chromatography.
  • the colanic acid degradation step is followed by hydrophobic interaction chromatography.
  • bacterial lysis is followed by ion exchange chromatography
  • ion exchange chromatography is followed by affinity chromatography (e.g., using boronates or other vicinial- or cis-diol specific compounds), which is followed by hydrophobic interaction chromatography.
  • affinity chromatography e.g., using boronates or other vicinial- or cis-diol specific compounds
  • hydrophobic interaction chromatography e.g., using boronates or other vicinial- or cis-diol specific compounds
  • the method of the present invention may also use further steps of size exclusion chromatography (SEC), reversed-phase chromatography, hydroxyapatite chromatography, and/or other available chromatography techniques, methods, or systems in combination with the steps described herein in accordance with the present application.
  • SEC size exclusion chromatography
  • reversed-phase chromatography hydroxyapatite chromatography
  • hydroxyapatite chromatography hydroxyapatite chromatography
  • a flocculate removal step may also be employed to provide higher purity to the resulting plasmid DNA product. This step may be used to remove a large portion of precipitated material (flocculate).
  • One mechanism of performing flocculate removal is through a lysate filtration step, such as through a 1 to 5 mm, and preferably a 3.5 mm grid filter, followed by a depth filtration as a polishing filtration step.
  • Other methods of performing flocculate removal are through centrifugation or settling.
  • the flocculate may be removed by ion exchange chromatography.
  • the sample may be subjected to one or more of ion exchange chromatography (e.g., anion or cation exchange chromatography), affinity chromatography, hydrophobic interaction chromatography, and filtration (e.g., filtered through a 0.2 ⁇ m and/or 0.45 ⁇ m filter), and, optionally, filtered or subjected to chromatography methods a second, third, or fourth time, or more.
  • ion exchange chromatography e.g., anion or cation exchange chromatography
  • affinity chromatography e.g., affinity chromatography
  • hydrophobic interaction chromatography e.g., hydrophobic interaction chromatography
  • filtration e.g., filtered through a 0.2 ⁇ m and/or 0.45 ⁇ m filter
  • the sample can be subjected to a first chromatography material, treated with the polypeptide, subjected to a second chromatography material, and subjected to a third chromatography material.
  • the sample may also be filtered at various times in the sequence, such as after the first chromatographic separation, or after the third chromatographic separation.
  • subjecting the sample to a chromatographic material also involves eluting the desired portion of the sample (such as that portion containing purified plasmid DNA) from the chromatographic material, and discarding undesired portions of the sample.
  • the desired portions may be retained within the chromatographic material and eluted in a separate step while the undesired materials flow through the material, or the undesired materials may be retained in the chromatographic material while the desired portions flow through the chromatographic material.
  • nucleic acid yield and purity are advantageously performed.
  • assays are performed before and after each purification step, as well as to each nucleic acid-containing fraction from, e.g., preparative ion exchange chromatography or filtration.
  • Representative means for performing these analytical determinations include HPLC analysis of purity, spectrophotometric estimation of yield, silver staining and SDS-PAGE for protein analysis, and agarose gel electrophoresis and Southern blotting for DNA analysis.
  • the processes described herein yields a purified concentrate with a plasmid DNA concentration (including, for example, predominantly supercoiled or other plasmid DNA) of around 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, and preferably 99%, or greater.
  • a plasmid DNA concentration including, for example, predominantly supercoiled or other plasmid DNA
  • ion exchange chromatography can be employed to purify the biological sample prior to treatment with the polypeptide, or thereafter. This process generally separates nucleic acid, e.g., plasmid DNA, in the bacterial lysate or lysate derivative from contaminating endotoxin, trace proteins, and residual cellular contaminants. Cation or anion exchange may be selected depending on the properties of the contaminants and the pH of the solution.
  • Anion exchange chromatography functions by binding negatively charged (or acidic) molecules to a support which is positively charged. The use of ion-exchange chromatography, then, allows molecules to be separated based upon their charge. Families of molecules (acidics, basics and neutrals) can be easily separated by this technique.
  • Ion exchange chromatography is a relatively common method for removing proteins and endotoxin from plasmid DNA preparations.
  • the ion exchange chromatography or any one or more of the other chromatography steps or techniques used can employ stationary phases, displacement chromatography methods, simulated moving bed technology, and/or continuous bed columns or systems.
  • the ion exchange columns that can be utilized in the processes of the present invention include both cationic and anionic ion exchange columns.
  • the ion exchange chromatography material is anion exchange chromatography resin.
  • the anion exchange chromatography material resin may comprise diethylaminoethyl cellulose (DEAE), trimethylaminoethyl (TMAE), quaternary amino ethyl (QAE), or polyethyl imide (PEI) resins.
  • the anion exchange chromatography resin comprises DEAE.
  • the anion exchange chromatography resin comprises a quaternary ammonium resin.
  • a chromatography column may be packed with one or more an anion exchange chromatography resins described herein.
  • the optimal capacity of the column will be determined empirically based on the resin used and the size of nucleic acid to be purified.
  • preferred resins are those with no pore or with a large pore size, e.g., greater than 1000 ⁇ , preferably around 3000 ⁇ to 4000 ⁇ ; with a medium bead size, e.g., about 20 to 500 ⁇ m diameter; that does not leach matrix components.
  • the resin is also washable, e.g., with sodium hydroxide, to allow repeated use.
  • Relatively weak cationic and strong cationic ion exchange columns can also be used.
  • Relatively strong cationic exchange columns typically have a surface coated with a polyhydroxylated polymer and functionalized with sulfopropyl, a dextran matrix functionalized with a sulfopropyl group, or a surface coated with a polyhydroxylated polymer functionalized with sulfoethyl.
  • strong cationic ion exchange columns using each of these materials include, respectively, a POROS HSTM, a POROS STM, and a SP-SephadexTM column, among others.
  • Relatively weak cationic exchange columns typically have a dextran matrix functionalized by carboxymethyl or an acrylic matrix functionalized by a carboxylic group.
  • Examples of weak cationic exchange columns using each of these materials include, respectively, CM-SephadexTM and Bio-Rex 70TM.
  • Relatively weak anionic and strong anionic ion exchange columns can also be used in the methods of the present invention.
  • Weak anionic ion exchange columns typically have a surface coated with polyethyleneimine that is capable of surface ionization up to a pH of about 9, a styrene-divinylbenzene copolymer containing sulfonic acid groups or a dextran matrix functionalized by diethylaminoethyl.
  • weak anionic exchange columns using each of these materials include, respectively, a POROS PITM column, a Dowex 50TM column and a DEAE-SephadexTM.
  • Relatively strong anionic exchange columns typically have a surface coated with quaternized polyethyleneimine with a surface ionization over a pH range of about 1 to about 14.
  • An example of a such a strong anionic ion exchange column is a POROS HQTM column, or a SOURCETM column.
  • the resins for the columns listed above can be obtained from Amersham/Pharmacia (Piscataway, N.J.), PerSeptive Biosystems (Foster City, Calif.), Toso Haas (Montgomeryville, Pa.), GE Healthcare (Piscataway, N.J.), and other suppliers.
  • the sample is combined with an ion exchange chromatography resin that is present in a column.
  • the column can be a 0.5 ml column, a 1.5 ml column, a 10 ml column, a 20 ml column, a 30 ml column, a 50 ml column, a 100 ml column, a 200 ml column, a 300 ml column, a 400 ml column, a 500 ml column, a 600 ml column, a 700 ml column, an 800 ml column, a 900 ml column, a 1000 ml (10 column a 2000 ml (2 L) a 10 L column, a 20 L column, a 30 L column, a 40 L column, a 50 L column, a 60 L column, a 70 L column, an 80 L column a 90 L column, a 100 L column, or a column with a capacity greater than 100 L, as well as any other column with a capacity between the volumes listed above.
  • the ion exchange chromatography material is equilibrated prior to use at a pH ranging from about 6.0 to about 7.2 and at a salt concentration that can range from about 100 mM to 200 mM. Therefore, the column can be equilibrated at a pH of about 6.0, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7, 6.8, 6.9, 7.0, 7.1, 7.2 or any other pH in between these pH values and at a salt concentration of about 100 mM, 125 mM, 150 mM, 175 mM, 200 mM or any other concentration in between the salt concentration values listed above.
  • Commonly used salts that can be utilized to equilibrate the chromatography material include NaCl, KCl or any other salt that can be adjusted to match the ionic strength of KCl.
  • a chelating agent for bivalent metal ion may be used such as for example, ethylenediamine-tetraacetic acid (EDTA), for inhibiting the degradation of plasmids due to DNA-degrading enzymes in the lysate of Escherichia coli .
  • EDTA ethylenediamine-tetraacetic acid
  • concentration of chelating agent for bivalent metal ion is preferably 0.1 to 100 mM.
  • any suitable matrix can be employed including, but not limited to aminoethyl, diethylaminoethyl, quaternary aminomethyl, quaternary aminoethyl, diethyl-(2-hydroxypropyl)aminoethyl, triethylaminomethyl, triethylaminopropyl and polyethyleneimine exchangers, to achieve filtration of the protein of interest.
  • anionic exchangers examples include the cellulose ion exchangers such as DE32 and DE52 (WHATMAN, Florham Park, N.J.), the dextran ion exchangers such as DEAE-SEPHADEX C-25, QAE-SEPHADEX C-25, DEAE-SEPHADEX C-50 and QAE-SEPHADEX C-50 (Pharmacia, Piscataway, N.J.), the agarose or cross-linked agarose such as DEAE BIO-GEL A (BIO-RAD, Hercules, Calif.), DEAE-SEPHAROSE CL-6B and Q-SEPHAROSE Fast Flow (Pharmacia), the synthetic organic polymers, such as MONO Q (Pharmacia), DEAE-5-PW and HRLC MA7P (BIO-RAD) and the coated silica matrices such as DEAE Si5500 and TEAP Si100. Desirably, the anion exchange matrix is equilibrated in very low salt concentrations and employed at an alkaline
  • the protein of interest When applying the protein of interest to a cation exchange matrix, it is contemplated that any matrix functionalized with carboxymethyl, sulfonate, sulfoethyl or sulfopropyl groups can be employed. Desirably, the cation exchange matrix is equilibrated and employed at an acidic pH (e.g., pH 3.0 to 6.5) to facilitate binding of basic and mildly acidic contaminants.
  • an acidic pH e.g., pH 3.0 to 6.5
  • Examples of commercially available cationic exchangers are the cellulose-based CM 23, CM 32 and CM 52 (WHATMAN); the dextran based CM-SEPHADEX C-25, SP-SEPHADEX C-25, CM-SEPHADEX C-50 and SP-SEPHADEX C-50 (Pharmacia); the agarose or cross-linked agarose-based CM BIO-GEL A (B10-RAD), CM-SEPHAROSE Fast Flow and S-SEPHAROSE Fast Flow (Pharmacia); the synthetic organic polymer-based MONO S (Pharmacia), SP-5-PW and HRLC MA7C (BIO-RAD) and the coated silica matrices such as CM Si300 and SP Si100.
  • the sample (e.g., the lysate or derivative thereof, including the nucleic acid) is typically loaded onto the column in a loading buffer comprising a salt concentration below the concentration at which the nucleic acid would elute from the column.
  • the salt concentration will be in certain embodiments from about 10 to 50 mS, depending on the resin used. In general, for weaker anion-exchange resins, a lower conductivity solution will be used, whereas for stronger anion-exchange resins, a higher conductivity solution will be used.
  • the column will then be washed with several column volumes of buffer to remove those substances that bind weakly to the resin.
  • Fractions are then eluted from the column using a shallow continuous saline gradient according to conventional methods, for example, using up to 1.5M NaCl in a Tris-HCl buffer.
  • Sample fractions are collected from the column.
  • fractions will typically be at least 50 ml to 2 liters where the nucleic acid peak is expected, with increases in volume in the fractions past the expected peak. Analytical determinations of nucleic acid yield and purity are performed on single or multiple fractions.
  • Limulus ameobocyte lysate (LAL) assays may be performed on each fraction to determine residual endotoxin and/or other assays described herein may be performed on each fraction to determine residual polysaccharide contaminant levels, such as colanic acid or related polysaccharides (as described below), in each fraction.
  • Fractions containing high levels of nucleic acid and low endotoxin or low colanic acid may be pooled, or maintained as separate fractions.
  • the resulting nucleic acid samples may again be filtered (e.g., through a 0.2 ⁇ m filter) or subjected to further chromatography techniques depending on the endotoxin and polysaccharide levels and the desired purity, as described below.
  • support matrices for the ion exchange chromatographic materials disclosed herein are not critical, however, support matrices based on dextran, cellulose, cross-linked agarose, synthetic organic polymers, coated silica or agarose are conventional in the art and suitable for use herein.
  • affinity chromatography can additionally or alternatively be employed to purify the biological sample.
  • a particular aspect of the invention involves the colanic acid degradation process using the polypeptides described herein, and combining the digested material with an affinity chromatography material to selectively remove digested polysaccharides such as colanic acid.
  • affinity chromatography materials have an affinity for vicinal or cis-diols.
  • the affinity chromatography material is a boronate chromatography resin, such as a boronic acid- or boronate-based resin.
  • the affinity chromatography involves preparation of a selective adsorbent by covalent immobilization of a molecule, containing a recognizable region, for which the target sample to be separated is specific, to a suitable insoluble support.
  • the immobilized compound is generally referred to as a ligand and it is recognized that coupling of the ligand to the support must be accomplished in a manner which does not interfere with its ability to be recognized by the target.
  • Affinity between ligand and the target molecule to be purified can be accomplished by passing the sample containing a sample containing the target molecule through a column containing the selective adsorbent.
  • Purification is thereafter accomplished by washing the column with a buffer used to free the adsorbent matrix of unwanted materials, followed by elution of the adsorbed target molecule. Washing is accomplished by passing a volume of physiological buffer, such as phosphate buffered saline, about pH 7.2, through the column. The volume of buffer used in the washing step should not be so great as to result in target molecule loss but, on the other hand, not so limited so as not to remove impurities. Elution is the step wherein the target molecule is removed from the column by using a solvent that reduces the affinity of the target molecule to the ligand or the affinity of the ligand-target molecule complex to the solid support. Elution of an antibody coupled to the antigen may be accomplished by either a salt gradient, to change the pH; buffered step-gradient, to change the ionic strength; or other methods.
  • a salt gradient to change the pH
  • buffered step-gradient to change the ionic strength
  • the ideal solid support or matrix should possess several characteristics including, macroporosity, mechanical stability, ease of activation, hydrophilicity, and inertness, i.e., low nonspecific adsorption. No matrix is ideal in all of these respects; the matrix is often determined empirically.
  • Affinity chromatography matrices commonly used by those skilled in the art include cross-linked dextran, agarose, polyacrylamide, cellulose, silica and poly(hydroxyethylmethacrylate).
  • beaded agarose is generally the preferred solid support by those skilled in the art due to its high adsorptive capacity for proteins, high porosity, hydrophilicity, chemical stability, lack of charge and relative inertness toward nonspecific adsorption.
  • Ligands may be physically adsorbed to matrices or covalently attached to polymeric matrices containing hydroxylic or amino groups by means of bifunctional reagents. Attachment usually requires two steps, activation of the matrix and coupling of the ligand to the activated matrix. Activated matrices are available commercially. The selection method for coupling the ligand to the matrix is dictated in part by the choice of matrix, and, in part, by the choice of ligand.
  • the specific buffering conditions used for equilibrating the affinity column in preparation for sample application should reflect the specific properties of the interacting system being used.
  • the nature of the buffer used, including its pH and ionic strength, should be optimal for the ligand-target molecule system.
  • the target sample applied to the column should preferably be contained in the same buffer used to equilibrate the column. After sample application and adsorption, the column may be washed with the starting buffer to remove any unbound sample and any impurities. It is also common to then wash the column with buffers different from the starting buffer in order to remove nonspecifically adsorbed substances.
  • Elution of the target molecule may be accomplished by a number of methods, including but not limited to these presented here.
  • the conditions of the buffer may be changed such that the affinity of the binding complex falls sufficiently, thereby destroying effective binding to each other or to the solid support. This is achieved by altering the pH, or the ionic strength of the buffer or both, or by chaotropic ions, e.g., cyanates. Increased separation may be obtained by gradient elution.
  • Suitable methods of elution include use of chaotropic agents such as KSCN; organic solvents, e.g., ethylene glycol, DMSO, or acetonitrile; denaturing agents, e.g., 8 M urea or 6 M guanine; electrophoretic elution; pressure induced elution and metal ion elution. Incomplete elution results in both loss of product and loss of column capacity. Ideally, the elution conditions should allow for complete elution of the product after one or two column volumes have passed through the column.
  • Ligands used for affinity chromatography are structurally and biologically closely related to the target molecule to be purified.
  • any suitable affinity chromatography material and ligand thereof can be employed for binding and eluting the sample of interest (i.e., plasmid DNA). In general, this makes the selection of the ligand specific for each case.
  • the ligand used in the affinity chromatography material has specificity for diol complexes, preferably vicinal or cis-diols.
  • the affinity chromatography material is a boronate affinity chromatography material. Boronate affinity columns were first employed for the separation of sugars and nucleic acid components by Weith et al, Biochemistry 9, 4396-4401, 1970; since then, this technique has been employed in the separation of a wide range of cis-diol compounds, including nucleosides, nucleotides, carbohydrates, glycoproteins, and enzymes.
  • the mechanism of action between boronic acids and cis-diols involves hydroxylation of the boronate under basic conditions; the boronate goes from a trigonal coplanar form to a tetrahedral boronate anion, which can then form esters with cis-diols.
  • the resulting diester can by hydrolyzed under acidic conditions, thus reversing the reaction.
  • Other methods for separation of vicinal diols are described by Barry et al., Australian J. Chem. 37, (1984); Gable, Organometallics 13(6), 2486-88 (1994); Liu, J. Microbial Methods 29, 85-95 (1997) Kinrade et al., DaltonTrans. 3713-3716 (2003); and Zhao et al., Analytical Sciences, 22(5), 747 (2006).
  • Suitable boronate ligands for use in the affinity chromatography material of the present processes include, for example, 3-aminophenylboronic acid (3aPBA), 2-(((4-boronophenyl)-methyl)-ethylammonio)ethyl, 2-(((4-boronophenyl)-methyl)-diethylammonio)ethyl, p-( ⁇ -aminoethyl)phenyl-boronate, poly(p-vinylbenzeneboronic acid), N-(4-nitro-3-dihydroxyborylphenyl)succinamic acid, 4-(N-methyl)carboxamido-benzeneboronic acid), 3-nitro-4-carboxamidobenzeneboronic acid, 2-nitro-3-succinamido-benzeneboronic acid, and 3-succinamido-4-nitro-benzeneboronic acid, among others.
  • One preferred boronate ligand is 3-amin
  • a range of support matrices for the affinity chromatographic materials disclosed herein, including boronate affinity chromatographic materials, are not critical, however, support matrices based on dextran, cellulose, agarose, polyacrylamide, silica, polystyrene, and polymethacrylate are conventional in the art and suitable for use herein.
  • Boronate affinity matrices are commercially available from a variety of vendors, including for example, Sigma-Aldrich Inc.
  • boronic acid gel (Boric acid gel; polymethacrylate support) (m-aminophenylboronic acid-acrylate; acrylic bead support); Bio-Rad (Affi-Gel 601; polyacrylamide support); Pierce (immobilized boronic acid gel; polyacrylamide support); and Tosoh (m-aminophenylboronic acid-agarose; agarose support) (TSKgel Boronate-5PW column; polymethacrylate support).
  • Other companies supplying boronic acid and derivatives thereof include Denisco (Hyderabad, India) and Synthonix Corporation (Wake Forest, N.C.).
  • hydrophobic interaction chromatography In the embodiments in which hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) materials and methods are employed, these chromatography methods generally employ hydrophobic moieties on a substrate to attract hydrophobic regions in molecules in the sample for purification.
  • HIC supports work by a clustering effect; typically, no covalent or ionic bonds are formed or shared when these molecules associate.
  • Hydrophobic interaction chromatography is beneficial as it is at least partially removes open circular plasmid forms and other contaminants, such as genomic DNA, RNA, and endotoxin.
  • any suitable hydrophobic interaction matrix can be employed for binding and eluting the sample of interest (e.g., plasmid DNA).
  • hydrophobic interaction matrices include, but are not limited to, natural or artificial surfaces containing uncharged groups, such as methyl, ethyl, or other alkyl groups. These groups form hydrophobic bonds with proteins which are passed through the matrix and result in separation of polynucleotides and/or polypeptides based on the strength of interaction between the polynucleotides and/or polypeptides and matrix groups.
  • the degree of hydrophobicity of the resin material may vary depending on the concentration of salt in the medium or the concentration of salt in the eluent.
  • Hydrophobic interaction columns normally comprise a base matrix (e.g., cross-linked agarose or synthetic copolymer material) to which hydrophobic ligands (e.g., alkyl or aryl groups) are coupled.
  • a base matrix e.g., cross-linked agarose or synthetic copolymer material
  • hydrophobic ligands e.g., alkyl or aryl groups
  • Preferred hydrophobic interaction chromatography resins generally include alkyl moieties of 2 to 20 carbon atoms in length (e.g., 4 to 18 carbon atoms, or 6 to 15 carbon atoms), which are typically unsubstituted.
  • the pore diameter of the base material for hydrophobic interaction chromatography is generally between 500 to 4000 ⁇ , but it can be appropriately selected from said range depending on the molecular size of sample to be separated and the components thereof.
  • Hydrophobic interaction chromatography can be performed at low or high pressures, wherein the column is equilibrated in the presence of aqueous buffers using relatively high salt concentrations (e.g., 1.2 to 1.7 M ammonium sulfate) and eluted in the presence of aqueous buffers using relatively low salt concentrations (e.g., a decreasing ammonium sulfate gradient from 1.2 M to 0.5 M).
  • relatively high salt concentrations e.g., 1.2 to 1.7 M ammonium sulfate
  • relatively low salt concentrations e.g., a decreasing ammonium sulfate gradient from 1.2 M to 0.5 M.
  • hydrophobic interaction matrices for relatively low pressure applications include phenyl-SEPHAROSE (Pharmacia) and butyl, phenyl and ether TOYOPEARL 650 series resins (Toso Haas).
  • hydrophobic interaction chromatography resins are available from Sigma-Aldrich, Inc (St. Louis, Mo.) (e.g., TSK-GEL® Butyl-NPR; TSK-GEL® Ether-5PW; TSK-GEL® Phenyl-5PW; each of which and others may have various particle sizes); GE Healthcare (Piscataway, N.J.) (e.g., HiScreen Phenyl FF (high or low sub); HiScreen Butyl FF; HiScreen Butyl-S FF; HiScreen Octyl FF).
  • Elution from the hydrophobic interaction matrix can be performed with a step-wise or linear gradient.
  • Suitable elution buffers are well known in the art. Suitable column sizes are described above in connection with the ion exchange chromatography materials.
  • the support matrices for the hydrophobic interaction chromatographic materials disclosed herein are not critical, however, support matrices based on dextran, cellulose, cross-linked agarose, synthetic organic polymers, coated silica or agarose are conventional in the art and suitable for use herein.
  • one or more filtration, ultrafiltration, or diafiltration steps may also be performed, including tangential flow filtration.
  • Filtration through size exclusion filters can be used to at least partially remove endotoxin and other contaminants while resulting in minimal nucleic acid loss.
  • the sample e.g., plasmid DNA
  • One or more (initial or final) filtration, ultrafiltration, or diafiltration steps may be performed to generally achieve that result(s).
  • a smaller MWCO ultrafiltration membrane may be used for subsequent or final diafiltration steps than used previously for initial purification, since the nucleic acid will typically be highly purified at later stages and predominantly small solute molecules will be passed through the membrane into the filtrate.
  • a 10,000 to 100,000 MWCO membrane for example, a 10,000 to 100,000 MWCO membrane, or greater may be used.
  • Hollow fiber devices with about a 100,000 MWCO membrane are commonly used, particularly when handling concentrated nucleic acid solutions, due to smaller hold-up volumes, increased flux, higher yields and shorter processing times.
  • Standard, commercially available filtration and diafiltration materials are suitable for use in this process, according to standard techniques known in the art.
  • Filtration of fine particle size contaminants from fluids has been accomplished by the use of various porous filter media through which a contaminated composition is passed such that the filter retains the contaminant.
  • Retention of the contaminant may occur by mechanical straining or electrokinetic particle capture and adsorption.
  • mechanical straining a particle is retained by physical entrapment when it attempts to pass through a pore smaller than itself.
  • electrokinetic capture mechanisms the particle collides with a surface within the porous filter and is retained on the surface by short-range attractive forces.
  • charge-modifying systems can be used to alter the surface charge characteristics of a filter (see, e.g., WO 90/11814).
  • a cationic charge modifier can be used to alter the charge characteristics of the filter such that the contaminant is retained by the filter.
  • the sample is treated with an aqueous solution comprising a zwitterionic detergent.
  • Suitable zwittergents include, for example, EMPIGEN BB® (n-dodecyl-N,Ndimethylglycine), ZWITTERGENT® 3-08, ZWITTERGENT® 3-10, ZWITTERGENT® 3-12, ZWITTERGENT® 3-14, ZWITTERGENT® 3-16, CHAPS, CHAPSO, and others.
  • the sample is filtered using tangential flow filtration.
  • tangential flow filtration The principles, theory and devices used for tangential flow filtration are described in Michaels, S. L. et al., “Tangential Flow Filtration” in Separations Technology, Pharmaceutical and Biotechnology Applications, W. P. Olson, ed., Interpharm Press, Inc., Buffalo Grove, Ill. (1995).
  • MWCO molecular weight cut off
  • a general rule is to select a membrane with a molecular weight cut off that is 3 to 6 times lower than the molecular weight of the molecules to be retained.
  • the membrane is installed, the tangential flow filtration system is initialized (typically flushed with water and tested for water filtrate flow rate and integrity), sample is added, a crossflow is established, feed and retentate pressures are set, and filtrate is collected. When the desired concentration or volume is reached, the process is stopped, and the sample is recovered.
  • One preferred filtration method is diafiltration using an ultrafiltration membrane having a molecular weight cutoff in the range of 30,000 to 500,000 MWCO, depending on the plasmid size. This step of diafiltration allows for buffer exchange, followed by concentration.
  • the eluate is typically concentrated 3- to 4-fold by tangential flow filtration as described above using, for example, 30 kDa membrane cut-off, to a target concentration, and the concentrate is buffer exchanged by diafiltration at constant volume and adjusted to the target plasmid concentration.
  • the resulting plasmid DNA solution may then be further filtered, e.g., through a 0.2 ⁇ m filter, and is typically divided into several aliquots, which are stored in containers at a relatively cold temperature (e.g., ⁇ 0° C.) until further processing.
  • a relatively cold temperature e.g., ⁇ 0° C.
  • the filter may be one which binds nucleic acid while allowing endotoxins and other contaminants to pass through the filter. Once the undesirable materials have passed through the filter, the nucleic acid may be eluted from the filter and collected.
  • Suitable size exclusion filters are available from a variety of commercial sources including, e.g., Ambion (Austin, Tex.), GE Healthcare (Piscataway, N.J.), Gelman (Ann Arbor, Mich.), Pall-Filtron (East Hills, N.Y.), Roche (Basel, Switzerland), Sartorius (Edgewood, N.Y.), and Thermo Scientific Pierce (Rockford, Ill.).
  • the filter used will be one that binds endotoxin and other contaminants while allowing nucleic acid to pass through.
  • Pall Ultipor® N 66 ® filters have been found to remove substantial endotoxin with high yield of nucleic acid.
  • the lysate solution or lysate derivative containing the nucleic acid may also be pre-filtered (e.g., using a 0.45 ⁇ m filter) prior to one or more of the chromatography or filtration steps described herein.
  • a low-conductivity buffer is meant to include any buffer of less than about 10 mS, preferably less than about 1 mS.
  • polypeptides described herein may additionally or alternatively used in a variety of industrial processes requiring or benefiting from the digestion of colanic acid and other polysaccharides. In general, this may involve treating machinery, product and/or effluent pipelines, and the products, intermediates, or effluents themselves with the polypeptides described herein in order to, for instance, remove or prevent corrosion, fouling, or other build-up resulting from these industrial processes.
  • biofilms e.g., those containing bacteria, such as gram negative bacterial
  • biofilms and similar materials can constrict or block passageways and conduits, or increase wear-and-tear on machinery parts or systems.
  • Representative industrial processes that may benefit from use of the polypeptides described herein include, for example, in paper and cellulose-making processes, membrane reconstitution and cleaning, recycling, waste-water treatments (e.g., digestions of aerobic solids and sludges), petrochemical refining and waste remediation, high purity water filtration and systems, water cooling systems/heat exchangers, and food processing.
  • waste-water treatments e.g., digestions of aerobic solids and sludges
  • petrochemical refining and waste remediation e.g., digestions of aerobic solids and sludges
  • high purity water filtration and systems e.g., water cooling systems/heat exchangers
  • food processing e.g., petrochemical refining and waste remediation
  • biofilms may form in intermediate processing streams, which can adversely influence downstream processing and/or affect the quality of the final product.
  • the polypeptides described herein may benefit such processes by removing, minimizing, or preventing such biofilms
  • the present invention relates to polypeptides that are capable of degrading colanic acid that may be found, for example, in biological materials.
  • This may include, for example, biofilms or bacterial nucleic acid preparations derived from bacteria such as E. coli, Salmonella , or other enterobacteriaceae, such as plasmid DNA derived from E. coli .
  • the polypeptides described herein also advantageously enable the preparation of highly pure gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA preparations.
  • the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence generally corresponding to SEQ ID NO: 1, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof.
  • This polypeptide generally corresponds to a full-length colanic acid-degrading polypeptide having a molecular weight of about 84,354 Daltons.
  • the polypeptide is an isolated polypeptide.
  • the polypeptide is isolated from a bacterial source organism and purified.
  • the polypeptide has a purity of at least 70%, more preferably at least 80%, more preferably at least 90%, more preferably at least 95%, more preferably at least 98%, and more preferably at least 99%.
  • Polypeptide fragments are also provided herein. Such fragments may be truncated at the N-terminus or C-terminus, or may lack internal residues, for example, when compared with a full-length protein. For example, certain fragments lack amino acid residues that are not essential for a desired activity (e.g., biological or otherwise) of the polypeptide.
  • the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence generally corresponding to SEQ ID NO: 2, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. This polypeptide generally corresponds to a truncated version of the full-length polypeptide, wherein the first 106 amino acids of the full-length polypeptide (SEQ ID NO: 1) are absent.
  • polypeptide variants can be prepared, e.g., by introducing appropriate nucleotide changes to the polypeptide DNA, and/or by synthesis of the desired polypeptide, or by isolating and purifying a variant polypeptide having colanic acid-degrading activity.
  • amino acid changes may alter certain post-translational processes of the polypeptide, such as changing the number or position of glycosylation sites or altering membrane anchoring characteristics.
  • Variations in the full-length and/or truncated sequences or in various domains of the polypeptides described herein can be made, for example, using any of the techniques and guidelines for conservative and non-conservative mutations set forth in the literature (for example, U.S. Pat. No. 5,364,934 (hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety)).
  • Variations may be a substitution, deletion or insertion of one or more codons encoding the polypeptide that results in a change in the amino acid sequence of the polypeptide as compared with the native sequence polypeptide.
  • the variation is by substitution of at least one amino acid with any other amino acid in one or more of the domains of the polypeptide.
  • Guidance in determining which amino acid residue may be inserted, substituted or deleted without adversely affecting the desired activity may be found by comparing the sequence of the polypeptide with that of homologous protein molecules and minimizing the number of amino acid sequence changes made in regions of high homology.
  • Amino acid substitutions can be the result of replacing one amino acid with another amino acid having similar structural and/or chemical properties, such as the replacement of a leucine with a serine, i.e., conservative amino acid replacements.
  • Insertions or deletions may optionally be in the range of about 1 to 5 amino acids, 5 to 10 amino acids, 10 to 25 amino acids, 25 to 50 amino acids, or more, such as 100 amino acids or more. The variation allowed may be determined by systematically making insertions, deletions or substitutions of amino acids in the sequence and testing the resulting variants for activity exhibited by the full-length or mature native sequence.
  • polypeptide may be a variant of the full-length or truncated polypeptide described herein.
  • a polypeptide variant will have at least about 80% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 81% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 82% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 83% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 84% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 85% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 86% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 87% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 88% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 89% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 90% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 91% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 92% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 93% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 94% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 95% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 96% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 97% amino acid sequence identity
  • the polypeptide variant will ordinarily have at least about 80% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 81% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 82% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 83% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 84% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 85% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 86% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 87% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 88% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 89% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 90% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 91% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 92% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 93% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 94% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 95% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 96% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 97% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 98% amino acid sequence identity and alternatively at least about 99% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 91%
  • the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 90% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 1, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. In another embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 95% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 1, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. In another embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 98% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 1, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. In another embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 99% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 1, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof.
  • the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 90% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 2, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. In another embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 95% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 2, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. In another embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 98% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 2, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. In another embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 99% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 2, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof.
  • exemplary conservative substitutions of interest are shown in Table 1. If such substitutions result in a change in biological activity, or a reduction in the desired activity, then more other changes, such as those described below in reference to amino acid classes, may be introduced and the products screened. It is understood that codons capable of coding for such conservative substitutions are known in the art.
  • polypeptide analogs of the invention arrived at by amino acid substitutions based on the relative similarity of the amino acid side-chain substituents, for example, their hydrophobicity, hydrophilicity, charge, size, etc.
  • One factor that can be considered in making amino acid substitutions is the hydropathic index of amino acids.
  • the importance of the hydropathic amino acid index in conferring interactive biological function on a protein has been discussed by Kyte and Doolittle (J. Mol. Biol., 157: 105-132, 1982). It is accepted that the relative hydropathic character of amino acids contributes to the secondary structure of the resultant protein. This, in turn, affects the interaction of the protein with molecules such as enzymes, substrates, receptors, DNA, antibodies, antigens, etc.
  • each amino acid has been assigned a hydropathic index as follows: isoleucine (+4.5); valine (+4.2); leucine (+3.8); phenylalanine (+2.8); cysteine/cystine (+2.5); methionine (+1.9); alanine (+1.8); glycine ( ⁇ 0.4); threonine ( ⁇ 0.7); serine ( ⁇ 0.8); tryptophan ( ⁇ 0.9); tyrosine ( ⁇ 1.3); proline ( ⁇ 1.6); histidine ( ⁇ 3.2); glutamate/glutamine/aspartate/asparagine ( ⁇ 3.5); lysine ( ⁇ 3.9); and arginine ( ⁇ 4.5).
  • amino acids in a peptide or protein can be substituted for other amino acids having a similar hydropathic index or score and produce a resultant peptide or protein having similar biological activity, i.e., which still retains biological functionality.
  • amino acids having hydropathic indices within ⁇ 2 are substituted for one another. More preferred substitutions are those wherein the amino acids have hydropathic indices within ⁇ 1. Most preferred substitutions are those wherein the amino acids have hydropathic indices within ⁇ 0.5.
  • hydrophilicity values have been assigned to amino acids: arginine/lysine (+3.0); aspartate/glutamate (+3.0 ⁇ 1); serine (+0.3); asparagine/glutamine (+0.2); glycine (0); threonine ( ⁇ 0.4); proline ( ⁇ 0.5 ⁇ 1); alanine/histidine ( ⁇ 0.5); cysteine ( ⁇ 1.0); methionine ( ⁇ 1.3); valine ( ⁇ 1.5); leucine/isoleucine ( ⁇ 1.8); tyrosine ( ⁇ 2.3); phenylalanine ( ⁇ 2.5); and tryptophan ( ⁇ 3.4).
  • amino acids having hydropathic indices within ⁇ 2 are preferably substituted for one another, those within ⁇ 1 are more preferred, and those within ⁇ 0.5 are most preferred.
  • Substantial or minor modifications in function or biological or other identity of the polypeptides of the invention are also accomplished by selecting substitutions that differ significantly in their effect on maintaining, among other things: (a) the structure of the polypeptide backbone in the area of the substitution, for example, as a sheet or helical conformation; (b) the charge or hydrophobicity of the molecule at the target site; or (c) the bulk of the side chain.
  • Naturally occurring residues are divided into groups based on common side-chain properties: (1) hydrophobic: norleucine, met, ala, val, leu, ile; (2) neutral hydrophilic: cys, ser, thr; (3) acidic: asp, glu; (4) basic: asn, gln, his, lys, arg; (5) residues that influence chain orientation: gly, pro; and (6) aromatic: trp, tyr, phe.
  • Non-conservative substitutions will generally entail exchanging a member of one of these classes for another class. Such substituted residues also may be introduced into the conservative substitution sites or, more preferably, into the remaining (non-conserved) sites.
  • the amino acid leucine (L) may alternatively be either leucine (L) or isoleucine (I)
  • the amino acid aspartic acid (D) may alternatively be aspartic acid (D) or asparagine (N)
  • the amino acid glutamine (Q) may alternatively be glutamine (Q) or lysine (K)
  • the amino acid phenylalanine (F) may alternatively be phenylalanine (F) or oxidized methionine.
  • the variations can be made using methods known in the art, such as alanine scanning, oligonucleotide-mediated (site-directed) mutagenesis, and PCR mutagenesis, among other known techniques.
  • Site-directed mutagenesis for example, (see, e.g., Carter et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 13:4331 (1986); Zoller et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 10:6487 (1987)), cassette mutagenesis (see, e.g., Wells et al., Gene, 34:315 (1985)), restriction selection mutagenesis (see, e.g., Wells et al., Philos. Trans. R. Soc.
  • Scanning amino acid analysis can also be employed to identify one or more amino acids along a contiguous sequence.
  • preferred scanning amino acids are relatively small, neutral amino acids.
  • Such amino acids include alanine, glycine, serine, and cysteine.
  • Alanine is typically a preferred scanning amino acid among this group because it eliminates the side-chain beyond the beta-carbon and is less likely to alter the main-chain conformation of the variant (see, e.g., Cunningham and Wells, Science, 244: 1081 1085 (1989)). Alanine is also typically preferred because it is the most common amino acid.
  • Covalent modifications of the polypeptides described herein are also included within the scope of this invention.
  • One type of covalent modification includes reacting targeted amino acid residues of a polypeptide with an organic derivatizing agent that is capable of reacting with selected side chains or the N- or C-terminal residues of the polypeptide.
  • Derivatization with bifunctional agents is useful, for instance, for crosslinking the polypeptide(s) to a water-insoluble support matrix or surface for use in the method for purifying anti-CAE antibodies, and vice-versa.
  • crosslinking agents include, e.g., 1,1-bis(diazoacetyl)-2-phenylethane, glutaraldehyde, N-hydroxysuccinimide esters, for example, esters with 4-azidosalicylic acid, homobifunctional imidoesters, including disuccinimidyl esters such as 3,3′-dithiobis(succinimidylpropionate), bifunctional maleimides such as bis-N-maleimido-1,8-octane and agents such as methyl-3-[(p-azidophenyl)dithio]propioimidate.
  • 1,1-bis(diazoacetyl)-2-phenylethane glutaraldehyde
  • N-hydroxysuccinimide esters for example, esters with 4-azidosalicylic acid
  • homobifunctional imidoesters including disuccinimidyl esters such as 3,3′-dithiobis(s
  • the C-terminal isoleucine of certain polypeptides described herein can be removed or deleted to expose a terminal tyrosine which can be used, for example, to crosslink the polypeptide to an insoluble matrix, either directly or through a spacer, to form an affinity resin or immobilized resin.
  • modifications include, for instance, deamidation of glutaminyl and asparaginyl residues to the corresponding glutamyl and aspartyl residues, respectively, hydroxylation of proline and lysine, phosphorylation of hydroxyl groups of seryl or threonyl residues, methylation of the ⁇ -amino groups of lysine, arginine, and/or histidine side chains (see, e.g., T. E. Creighton, Proteins: Structure and Molecular Properties, W.H. Freeman & Co., San Francisco, pp. 79 86 (1983)), acetylation of the N-terminal amine, and amidation of any C-terminal carboxyl group.
  • altering the native glycosylation pattern of the polypeptide involves deleting one or more carbohydrate moieties found in the polypeptide (e.g., the full-length) sequence (either by removing the underlying glycosylation site or by deleting the glycosylation by chemical and/or enzymatic means), and/or adding one or more glycosylation sites that are not present in the polypeptide sequence.
  • this may include qualitative changes in the glycosylation of the native proteins, involving a corresponding change in the nature and proportions of the various carbohydrate moieties that may be present.
  • Addition of glycosylation sites to the polypeptide of the invention may be accomplished by altering the amino acid sequence.
  • the alteration may be made, for example, by the addition of, or substitution by, one or more serine or threonine residues to the polypeptide sequence (for O-linked glycosylation sites).
  • the amino acid sequences described herein e.g., SEQ ID NO. 1, SEQ ID NO. 2, etc.
  • Another means of increasing the number of carbohydrate moieties on the polypeptide is by chemical or enzymatic coupling of glycosides to the polypeptide. Such methods are generally described in the art, e.g., in PCT International Pub. No. WO 87/05330, and in Aplin and Wriston, CRC Crit. Rev. Biochem., pp. 259 306 (1981).
  • Removal of carbohydrate moieties present on the polypeptides described herein may be accomplished chemically or enzymatically or by mutational substitution of codons encoding for amino acid residues that serve as targets for glycosylation.
  • Chemical deglycosylation techniques are known in the art and described, for instance, by Hakimuddin, et al., Arch. Biochem. Biophys., 259:52 (1987) and by Edge et al., Anal. Biochem., 118:131 (1981).
  • Enzymatic cleavage of carbohydrate moieties on polypeptides can be achieved by the use of a variety of endo- and exo-glycosidases as described by Thotakura et al., Meth. Enzymol., 138:350 (1987).
  • Another type of covalent modification comprises linking the polypeptides described herein to one of a variety of nonproteinaceous polymers, e.g., polyethylene glycol (PEG), polypropylene glycol, or polyoxyalkylenes, in the manner set forth in U.S. Pat. No. 4,640,835; 4,496,689; 4,301,144; 4,670,417; 4,791,192 or 4,179,337 (each of which is hereby incorporated by reference herein).
  • PEG polyethylene glycol
  • polypropylene glycol polypropylene glycol
  • polyoxyalkylenes polyoxyalkylenes
  • polypeptides of the present invention may also be modified in a way to form a chimeric molecule comprising the polypeptide fused to another, heterologous polypeptide or amino acid sequence.
  • the polypeptides may also be labeled with reagents that facilitate their detection.
  • the agents may be combined with fluorescent labels (e.g., Prober et al., Science 238:336-340 (1987); Albarella et al., EP 0 144 914); chemical labels (e.g., Sheldon et al., U.S. Pat. No. 4,582,789; Albarella et al., U.S. Pat. No. 4,563,417); and/or modified bases (e.g., Miyoshi et al., EP 0 119 448) (each of which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entirety).
  • fluorescent labels e.g., Prober et al., Science 238:336-340 (1987); Albarella e
  • such a chimeric molecule comprises a fusion of the polypeptide with a tag polypeptide which provides an epitope to which an anti-tag antibody can selectively bind.
  • the epitope tag is generally placed at the amino- or carboxyl-terminus of the polypeptide amino acid sequence. The presence of such epitope-tagged forms of the polypeptide can be detected using an antibody against the tag polypeptide. Also, provision of the epitope tag enables the polypeptide to be readily purified by affinity purification using an anti-tag antibody or another type of affinity matrix that binds to the epitope tag.
  • tag polypeptides and their respective antibodies are well known in the art.
  • Examples include the c-myc tag and the 8F9, 3C7, 6E10, G4, B7 and 9E10 antibodies thereto (see, e.g., Evan et al., Molecular and Cellular Biology, 5:3610 3616 (1985)); the flu HA tag polypeptide and its antibody 12 CA5 (see, e.g., Field et al., Mol. Cell.
  • Tag polypeptides include an ⁇ -tubulin epitope peptide (see, e.g., Skinner et al., J. Biol. Chem., 266:15163 15166 (1991)); the FLAG®-peptide (Sigma-Aldrich, Inc. (St.
  • an amino acid tag can be added to the polypeptides described herein using genetic engineering techniques that are well known to practitioners of the art.
  • the polypeptide(s) may include one, and more preferably six, consecutive histidine residues at either the amino or carboxy terminus of the protein. Such consecutive histidine residues are commonly referred to as a histidine tag. Terminal consecutive histidine residues can facilitate detection and/or purification of expressed recombinant proteins, and generally do not interfere with the function/activity/structure of the protein. The consecutive histidine residues can be incorporated into the protein coding gene by primers that carry the 5′-CAT-3° triplets.
  • Consecutive histidine residues at either terminus serve as convenient aids for purification of proteins with immobilized metal affinity chromatography, which exploits the ability of the amino acid histidine to bind chelated transition metal ions such as nickel (Ni 2+ ), zinc (Zn 2+ ) and copper (Cu 2+ ).
  • other techniques include, but are not limited to, epitopes for polyclonal or monoclonal antibodies including but not limited to the T7 epitope, the myc epitope, and the V5a epitope; and fusion of the polypeptides described herein to suitable protein partners including but not limited to glutathione-S-transferase or maltose binding protein.
  • the amino add sequence comprises an affinity tag allowing for, e.g., isolation and purification of the protein, such as, for example, a GST tag, a His tag, a FLAG® tag, or an XPRESSTTM tag; in certain preferred embodiments, the affinity tag comprises a His tag (i.e., one or more, and preferably six histidine residues) (see, e.g., SEQ ID NO: 3 or SEQ. ID NO: 4), one or more copies of the FLAG® octapeptide (DYKDDDDK) (see, e.g., SEQ ID NO: 5), or the XPRESSTM octapeptide (DLYDDDK).
  • His tag i.e., one or more, and preferably six histidine residues
  • DYKDDDDK FLAG® octapeptide
  • SEQ ID NO: 5 see, e.g., SEQ ID NO: 5
  • DLYDDDK XPRESSTM oc
  • the chimeric molecule may comprise a fusion of the polypeptide with an immunoglobulin or a particular region of an immunoglobulin.
  • an immunoglobulin also referred to as an “immunoadhesin”
  • a fusion could be to the Fc region of an IgG molecule.
  • the Ig fusions preferably include the substitution of a soluble (transmembrane domain deleted or inactivated) form of a polypeptide in place of at least one variable region within an Ig molecule.
  • the immunoglobulin fusion includes the hinge, CH2 and CH3, or the hinge, CH1, CH2 and CH3 regions of an IgG1 molecule.
  • Full-length polypeptides may be prepared by any of a number of conventional techniques.
  • the polypeptides of the invention may be prepared, in general, by culturing host cells transformed or transfected with a vector containing polynucleotides encoding the desired polypeptide.
  • the vector is selected from a plasmid, a virus, and a bacteriophage; more preferably in this embodiment, the vector is a bacteriophage (see, e.g., Example 2). Methods of preparing vectors, and in particular phage, for the production of polypeptides are well known in the art.
  • host cells such as bacteria
  • host cells are transfected or transformed with expression or cloning vectors described herein for polypeptide production and cultured in conventional nutrient media modified as appropriate for inducing promoters, selecting transformants, or amplifying the genes encoding the desired sequences.
  • the culture conditions such as media, temperature, pH and the like, can be selected by the skilled artisan without undue experimentation. In general, principles, protocols, and practical techniques for maximizing the productivity of cell cultures can be found in Mammalian Cell Biotechnology: a Practical Approach, M. Butler, ed. (IRL Press, 1991) and Sambrook et al., supra.
  • Methods of eukaryotic cell transfection and prokaryotic cell transformation are known to the ordinarily skilled artisan, for example, CaCl 2 , CaPO 4 , liposome-mediated, and electroporation. Depending on the host cell used, transformation is performed using standard techniques appropriate to such cells.
  • the calcium treatment employing calcium chloride, as described in Sambrook et al., supra, or electroporation, for example, is generally used for prokaryotes.
  • Infection with Agrobacterium tumefaciens is used for transformation of certain plant cells, as described by Shaw et al., Gene, 23:315 (1983) and PCT International Pub. No. WO 89/05859.
  • DNA into cells such as by nuclear microinjection, electroporation, bacterial protoplast fusion with intact cells, or polycations, e.g., polybrene, polyornithine, may also be used.
  • polycations e.g., polybrene, polyornithine.
  • Suitable host cells for cloning or expressing the DNA in the vectors herein include prokaryote, yeast, or higher eukaryote cells.
  • Suitable prokaryotes include but are not limited Enterobacteriaceae such as Escherichia , e.g., E. coli, Enterobacter, Erwinia, Klebsiella, Proteus, Salmonella , e.g., Salmonella typhimurium, Serratia , e.g., Serratia marcescans , and Shigella , as well as Bacilli such as B. subtilis and B. licheniformis (e.g., B.
  • the host cell secretes minimal amounts of proteolytic enzymes.
  • the strain may be modified to effect a genetic mutation in the genes encoding proteins endogenous to the host (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,946,783).
  • in vitro methods of cloning e.g., PCR or other nucleic acid polymerase reactions, are suitable.
  • Preferred host cells for producing polypeptides of the invention are prokaryotes, and more preferably bacteria, including eubacteria and archaebacteria. Preferred of these are eubacteria, including gram-positive and gram-negative bacteria. More preferred are gram-negative bacteria.
  • bacteria including eubacteria and archaebacteria.
  • eubacteria including gram-positive and gram-negative bacteria. More preferred are gram-negative bacteria.
  • One preferred type of bacteria is Enterobacteriaceae. Examples of bacteria belonging to Enterobacteriaceae include Escherichia, Enterobacter, Erwinia, Klebsiella, Proteus, Salmonella, Serratia , and Shigella .
  • Other types of suitable bacteria include Azotobacter, Pseudomonas, Rhizobia, Vitreoscilla , and Paracoccus. E. coli is particularly preferred herein.
  • Prokaryotic cells used to produce the polypeptides of the invention are grown in media known in the art and suitable for culture of the selected host cells, including the media generally described by Sambrook et al., supra.
  • Media that are suitable for bacteria include, but are not limited to, AP5 medium, nutrient broth, Luria-Bertani (LB) broth, Neidhardt's minimal medium, and C.R.A.P. minimal or complete medium (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 6,828,121), plus necessary nutrient supplements.
  • the media may also contains a selection agent, chosen based on the construction of the expression vector, to selectively permit growth of prokaryotic cells containing the expression vector.
  • ampicillin is added to media for growth of cells expressing ampicillin resistant gene.
  • Any necessary supplements besides carbon, nitrogen, and inorganic phosphate sources may also be included at appropriate concentrations introduced alone or as a mixture with another supplement or medium such as a complex nitrogen source.
  • the culture medium may also optionally contain one or more reducing agents selected from the group consisting of glutathione, cysteine, cystamine, thioglycollate, dithioerythritol, and dithiothreitol.
  • the prokaryotic host cells are cultured at suitable temperatures. For E. coli growth, for example, the preferred temperature ranges from about 20° C. to about 39° C., more preferably from about 25° C.
  • the pH of the medium may be any pH from about 5.9, depending mainly on the host organism.
  • the pH is preferably from about 6.8 to about 7.4, and more preferably about 7.0.
  • eukaryotic microbes such as filamentous fungi or yeast are suitable cloning or expression hosts for polypeptide-encoding vectors.
  • Saccharomyces cerevisiae is a commonly used lower eukaryotic host microorganism.
  • Other conventional host microorganisms include filamentous fungi such as, e.g., Neurospora, Penicillium, Tolypocladium (WO 91/00357), and Aspergillus hosts such as A. nidulans (Ballance et al., Biochem. Biophys. Res.
  • K. fragilis ATCC 12,424)
  • K. bulgaricus ATCC 16,045)
  • K. wickeramii ATCC 24,178
  • K. waltii ATCC 56,500
  • K. drosophilarum ATCC 36,906; Van den Berg et al., Bio/Technology, 8:135 (1990)
  • K. thermotolerans and K. marxianus
  • yarrowia EP 0 402 226
  • Pichia pastoris EP 0 183 070; Sreekrishna et al., J.
  • Methylotropic yeasts are also suitable and include, but are not limited to, yeast capable of growth on methanol selected from the genera consisting of Hansenula, Candida, Kloeckera, Pichia, Saccharomyces, Torulopsis , and Rhodotorula . Representative species that are exemplary of this class of yeasts may be found in C. Anthony, The Biochemistry of Methylotrophs, 269 (1982).
  • Suitable host cells for the expression of glycosylated polypeptides are generally derived from multicellular organisms.
  • invertebrate cells include insect cells such as Drosophila S2 and Spodoptera Sf9, as well as plant cells.
  • useful mammalian host cell lines include Chinese hamster ovary (CHO) and COS cells. More specific examples include Chinese hamster ovary cells/ ⁇ DHFR(CHO, Urlaub and Chasin, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 77:4216 (1980)); human embryonic kidney line (293 or 293 cells subcloned for growth in suspension culture, Graham et al., J.
  • human liver cells Hep G2, HB 8065
  • human lung cells W138, ATCC CCL 75
  • COS-7 monkey kidney CV1 line transformed by SV40
  • TM4 mouse sertoli cells
  • MMT 060562 mouse mammary tumor
  • the nucleic acid encoding the target polypeptide may be inserted into a replicable vector for cloning (amplification of the DNA) or for expression, and various vectors are publicly available.
  • the vector may, for example, be in the form of a cosmid, plasmid, phage, or viral particle. Many vectors are available for this purpose, and selection of the appropriate vector will depend mainly on the size of the nucleic acid to be inserted into the vector and the particular host cell to be transformed with the vector.
  • the appropriate nucleic acid sequence (such as described below may be inserted into the vector by a variety of procedures.
  • Vector components generally include, but are not limited to, one or more of a signal sequence, an origin of replication, one or more marker genes, an enhancer element, a promoter, and a transcription termination sequence. Construction of suitable vectors containing one or more of these components employs standard ligation techniques which are known to the skilled artisan.
  • the polypeptide may be produced recombinantly not only directly, but also as a fusion polypeptide with a heterologous polypeptide, which may be a signal sequence or other polypeptide having a specific cleavage site at the N-terminus of the mature protein or polypeptide.
  • a heterologous polypeptide which may be a signal sequence or other polypeptide having a specific cleavage site at the N-terminus of the mature protein or polypeptide.
  • the signal sequence may be a component of the vector, or it may be a part of the polypeptide-encoding DNA that is inserted into the vector.
  • the signal sequence may be a prokaryotic signal sequence selected, for example, from the group of the alkaline phosphatase, penicillinase, Ipp, or heat-stable enterotoxin II leaders.
  • the signal sequence may be, e.g., the yeast invertase leader, alpha factor leader (including Saccharomyces and Kluyveromyces ⁇ -factor leaders, the latter described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,010,182), or acid phosphatase leader, the C. albicans glucoamylase leader (EP 0 362 179), or the signal described in PCT International Pub. No. WO 90/13646.
  • mammalian signal sequences may be used to direct secretion of the protein, such as signal sequences from secreted polypeptides of the same or related species, as well as viral secretory leaders.
  • Both expression and cloning vectors contain a nucleic acid sequence that enables the vector to replicate in one or more selected host cells. Such sequences are well known for a variety of bacteria, yeast, and viruses.
  • the origin of replication from the plasmid pBR322 is suitable for most Gram-negative bacteria, the 2 ⁇ plasmid origin is suitable for yeast, and various viral origins (SV40, polyoma, adenovirus, VSV or BPV) are useful for cloning vectors in mammalian cells.
  • Selection genes may also contain a selection gene, also referred to in the art as a selectable marker.
  • Typical selection genes encode proteins that: (a) complement auxotrophic deficiencies; (b) confer resistance to antibiotics or other drugs or toxins, e.g., ampicillin, G418, hygromycin, neomycin, methotrexate, or tetracycline; or (c) supply critical nutrients not available from complex media, e.g., the gene encoding D-alanine racemase for Bacilli.
  • selectable markers for mammalian cells are those that enable the identification of cells competent to take up the colanic acid-degrading polypeptide-encoding nucleic acid, such as DHFR or thymidine kinase.
  • An appropriate host cell when wild-type DHFR is employed is the CHO cell line deficient in DHFR activity, prepared and propagated as described by Urlaub et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 77:4216 (1980).
  • a suitable selection gene for use in yeast is the trp1 gene present in the yeast plasmid YRp7 (see, e.g., Stinchcomb et al., Nature, 282:39 (1979); Kingsman et al., Gene, 7:141 (1979); Tschemper et al., Gene, 10:157 (1980).
  • the trp1 gene provides a selection marker for a mutant strain of yeast lacking the ability to grow in tryptophan, for example, ATCC No. 44076 or PEP4-1 (see, e.g., Jones, Genetics, 85:12 (1977)).
  • Expression and cloning vectors usually contain a promoter operably linked to the polypeptide-encoding nucleic acid sequence to direct mRNA synthesis. Promoters recognized by a variety of potential host cells are well known. Promoters suitable for use with prokaryotic hosts include alkaline phosphatase, a tryptophan (trp) promoter system (e.g., Goeddel, Nucleic Acids Res., 8:4057 (1980); EP 0 036 776); the ⁇ -lactamase and lactose promoter systems (e.g., Chang et al., Nature, 275:615 (1978); Goeddel et al., Nature, 281:544 (1979)); and hybrid promoters such as the tac promoter (see, e.g., deBoer et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 80:21 25 (1983)). Promoters for use in bacterial systems may also contain a Shine-Dal
  • Suitable promoting sequences for use with yeast hosts include the promoters for 3-phosphoglycerate kinase (Hitzeman et al., J. Biol. Chem., 255:2073 (1980)) or other glycolytic enzymes (Hess et al., J. Adv.
  • yeast promoters which are inducible promoters having the additional advantage of transcription controlled by growth conditions, are the promoter regions for acid phosphatase, alcohol dehydrogenase 2, degradative enzymes associated with nitrogen metabolism, enzymes responsible for maltose and galactose utilization, glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase, isocytochrome C, and metallothionein. Suitable vectors and promoters for use in yeast expression are further described in EP 0 073 657.
  • Target polypeptide transcription from vectors in mammalian host cells is controlled, for example, by promoters obtained from the genomes of viruses such as adenovirus (such as Adenovirus 2), avian sarcoma virus, bovine papilloma virus, cytomegalovirus, fowlpox virus (see, e.g., UK 2,211,504), hepatitis-B virus, polyoma virus, a retrovirus, and Simian Virus 40 (SV40), or from heterologous mammalian promoters (e.g., the actin promoter or an immunoglobulin promoter), and/or from heat-shock promoters, provided such promoters are compatible with the host cell systems.
  • viruses such as adenovirus (such as Adenovirus 2), avian sarcoma virus, bovine papilloma virus, cytomegalovirus, fowlpox virus (see, e.g., UK 2,211,504)
  • Enhancers are cis-acting elements of DNA, typically about from 10 to 300 bp, that act on a promoter to increase its transcription. Numerous enhancer sequences are known from mammalian genes (albumin, ⁇ -fetoprotein, elastase, globin, and insulin). Typically, an enhancer from a eukaryotic cell virus will be used.
  • Non-limiting examples include the SV40 enhancer on the late side of the replication origin (bp 100 270), the cytomegalovirus early promoter enhancer, the polyoma enhancer on the late side of the replication origin, and adenovirus enhancers.
  • the enhancer may be spliced into the vector at a position 5′ or 3′ to the polypeptide coding sequence, typically located at a site 5′ from the promoter.
  • Expression vectors used in prokaryotic e.g., bacteria
  • eukaryotic host cells yeast, fungi, insect, plant, animal, human, or nucleated cells from other multicellular organisms
  • sequences are commonly available from the 5′ and, occasionally 3′, untranslated regions of prokaryotic, eukaryotic, or viral DNAs or cDNAs. These regions contain nucleotide segments transcribed as polyadenylated fragments in the untranslated portion of the mRNA encoding the polypeptide of interest.
  • Gene amplification and/or expression may be measured in a sample directly, for example, by conventional Southern blotting, Northern blotting to quantitate the transcription of mRNA (see, e.g., Thomas, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 77:5201 5205 (1980)), dot blotting (DNA analysis), or in situ hybridization, using an appropriately labeled probe, based on the sequences provided herein.
  • antibodies may be employed that can recognize specific duplexes, including DNA duplexes, RNA duplexes, and DNA-RNA hybrid duplexes or DNA-protein duplexes.
  • the antibodies in turn may be labeled and the assay may be carried out where the duplex is bound to a surface, so that upon the formation of duplex on the surface, the presence of antibody bound to the duplex can be detected.
  • Gene expression may be measured by immunological methods, such as immunohistochemical staining of cells or tissue sections and assay of cell culture or body fluids, to quantitate directly the expression of gene product.
  • Antibodies useful for immunohistochemical staining and/or assay of sample fluids may be either monoclonal or polyclonal, and may be prepared in any mammal. Conveniently, the antibodies may be prepared against a full-length sequence polypeptide or against a truncated or fragment peptide based on the DNA sequences provided herein or against exogenous sequence fused to CAE DNA and encoding a specific antibody epitope.
  • polypeptide may be recovered from culture medium or from host cell lysates. If membrane-bound, it can be released from the membrane using a suitable detergent solution (e.g. Triton-X 100) or by enzymatic cleavage. Cells employed in expression of polypeptides can be disrupted by various physical or chemical means, such as freeze-thaw cycling, sonication, mechanical disruption, or cell lysing agents. It may be desired to purify the polypeptide(s) from recombinant cell proteins or polypeptides.
  • a suitable detergent solution e.g. Triton-X 100
  • Cells employed in expression of polypeptides can be disrupted by various physical or chemical means, such as freeze-thaw cycling, sonication, mechanical disruption, or cell lysing agents. It may be desired to purify the polypeptide(s) from recombinant cell proteins or polypeptides.
  • Exemplary of suitable purification procedures are ammonium sulfate precipitation; chromatofocusing; chromatography on silica or on a cation-exchange resin such as DEAE; ethanol precipitation; fractionation on an ion-exchange column; gel filtration using, for example, Sephadex G-75; metal chelating columns to bind epitope-tagged forms of the polypeptide; protein A Sepharose columns to remove contaminants such as IgG; reverse phase HPLC; and SDS-PAGE.
  • Various methods of protein purification may be employed and such methods are known in the art and described for example in Deutscher, Methods in Enzymology, 182 (1990); Scopes, Protein Purification: Principles and Practice, Springer-Verlag, New York (1982).
  • the purification step(s) performed will depend, for example, on the nature of the production process, the particular polypeptide produced, and the downstream use(s) of the polypeptide.
  • desired peptides and fragments thereof may be chemically synthesized, or may be extracted from a natural source organism(s).
  • Another alternative approach involves generating polypeptides and fragments thereof by enzymatic digestion, e.g., by treating the protein with an enzyme known to cleave proteins at sites defined by particular amino acid residues, or by digesting the DNA with suitable restriction enzymes and isolating the desired fragment.
  • Yet another suitable technique involves isolating and amplifying a DNA sequence or fragment encoding a desired polypeptide or polypeptide fragment, by polymerase chain reaction (PCR). Oligonucleotides that define the desired termini of the DNA are employed at the 5′ and 3′ primers in the PCR.
  • polypeptide is a polypeptide fragment
  • the polypeptide fragment preferably shares at least one biological and/or immunological activity with the native (i.e., full-length) polypeptide disclosed herein.
  • the polypeptide fragment may have greater activity than the full-length polypeptide, or may otherwise be optimized or improved relative to the full-length polypeptide.
  • polypeptide sequence may be produced by direct peptide synthesis using solid-phase techniques (see, e.g., Stewart et al., Solid-Phase Peptide Synthesis, W.H. Freeman Co., San Francisco, Calif. (1969); Merrifield, J. Am. Chem. Soc., 85:2149 2154 (1963)).
  • In vitro protein synthesis may be performed using automation, or by manual techniques. Automated synthesis may be accomplished, for instance, using an Applied Biosystems Peptide Synthesizer (Foster City, Calif.) in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions.
  • Various portions of the polypeptides described herein may be chemically synthesized separately and combined using chemical or enzymatic methods to produce the full-length, truncated, or other variant polypeptides.
  • polynucleotides and fragments thereof, and partial or complete complements thereof, mRNA, and/or coding sequences preferably in isolated form, including polynucleotides encoding a polypeptide or enzyme having colanic acid-degrading (CAE) activity and/or a CAE-related protein and fragments thereof (as described above), DNA, RNA, DNA/RNA hybrid, and related molecules, polynucleotides or oligonucleotides complementary to the polynucleotides described herein or mRNA sequence or a part thereof, and polynucleotides or oligonucleotides that hybridize to a CAE-encoding polynucleotide or mRNA of the same.
  • CAE colanic acid-degrading
  • the polynucleotide comprises a nucleic acid sequence generally corresponding to SEQ ID NO: 7, and the complement thereof. In certain other embodiments, the polynucleotide comprises a nucleic acid sequence generally corresponding to SEQ ID NO: 8.
  • the polynucleotide is an isolated polynucleotide. In other embodiments, the polynucleotide is a recombinant polynucleotide.
  • Polynucleotide variants are also provided herein. Polynucleotide variants may contain one or more substitutions, additions, deletions, and/or insertions such that the activity of the polynucleotide is not substantially diminished, as described above. The effect on the activity of the polynucleotide may generally be assessed as described herein, or using conventional methods. Generally, polynucleotide variants have at least about 80% nucleic acid sequence identity with a nucleotide acid sequence encoding a full-length or truncated polypeptide having colanic acid-degrading activity, as disclosed herein or any other fragment of a full-length or truncated polypeptide sequence as disclosed herein.
  • Variants preferably exhibit at least about 85%, 87%, 88% or 89% identity and more preferably at least about 90%, 92%, 95%, 96%, or 97% identity to a portion of a polynucleotide sequence that encodes a polypeptide having endotoxin-degrading capabilities.
  • the percent identity may be readily determined by comparing sequences of the polynucleotides to the corresponding portion of the target polynucleotide, using any method including using computer algorithms well known to those having ordinary skill in the art, such as Align or the BLAST algorithms (see, e.g., Altschul, J. Mol. Biol. 219:555-565, 1991; Henikoff and Henikoff, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 89:10915-10919, 1992), which is available at the NCBI website, and which are described elsewhere herein. Default parameters may be used.
  • a variant polynucleotide will have at least about 80% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 81% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 82% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 83% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 84% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 85% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 86% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 87% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 88% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 89% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 90% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 91% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 92% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 93% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 94% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 95% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 96% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about at least
  • the polynucleotide variant will ordinarily have at least about 80% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 81% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 82% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 83% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 84% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 85% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 86% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 87% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 88% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 89% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 90% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 91% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 92% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 93% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 94% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 95% nucleic acid sequence identity
  • the nucleic acid molecule shares at least 90% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 7.
  • the nucleic acid molecule may share at least 95% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 7, or may share at least 98% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 7.
  • the nucleic acid molecule has the sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 7; that is, the nucleic acid molecule exhibits 100% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 7.
  • the nucleic acid molecule shares at least 90% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 8.
  • the nucleic acid molecule may share at least 95% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 8, or may share at least 98% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 8.
  • the nucleic acid molecule has the sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 8; that is, the nucleic acid molecule exhibits 100% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 8.
  • polynucleotide and variants thereof are substantially homologous to a portion of a native gene that encodes a desired target polypeptide.
  • Single-stranded nucleic acids derived (e.g., by thermal denaturation) from such polynucleotides and variants are capable of hybridizing under moderately stringent conditions to a naturally occurring DNA or RNA sequence encoding a native target polypeptide.
  • a polynucleotide that detectably hybridizes under moderately stringent conditions may have a nucleotide sequence that includes at least 10 consecutive nucleotides, for example, at least 50, at least 100, at least 150, at least 200, at least 250, and least 300, at least 350, at least 400, at least 450, at least 500, or more consecutive nucleotides that are complementary to a particular target polynucleotide.
  • a sequence (or its complement) will be unique to a single particular target polypeptide for which interference with expression is desired, and in certain other embodiments the sequence (or its complement) may be shared by two or more related target polypeptides for which interference with polypeptide expression is desired.
  • Sequence specific polynucleotides of the present invention may be designed using one or more of several criteria. For example, to design a polynucleotide that has 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, 100, 200, 300, 400, 500, 600, or more, consecutive nucleotides identical to a sequence encoding a polypeptide of interest (e.g., a polypeptide having colanic acid-degrading activity, such as those described herein), the open reading frame of the polynucleotide sequence may be scanned for sequences that have one or more of the following characteristics: (1) an A+T/G+C ratio of approximately 1:1 but no greater than 2:1 or 1:2; (2) an AA dinucleotide or a CA dinucleotide at the 5′ end; (3) an internal hairpin loop melting temperature less than 55° C.; (4) a homodimer melting temperature of less than 37° C.
  • a polypeptide of interest e.g., a polypeptide having cola
  • melting temperature calculations as described in (3) and (4) can be determined using computer software known to those skilled in the art); (5) a sequence of at least 10-20 consecutive nucleotides not identified as being present in any other known polynucleotide sequence (such an evaluation can be readily determined using computer programs available to a skilled artisan such as BLAST to search publicly available databases).
  • a polynucleotide sequence may be designed and chosen using a computer software available commercially from various vendors (e.g., OligoEngineTM (Seattle, Wash.); Dharmacon, Inc. (Lafayette, Colo.); Ambion Inc. (Austin, Tex.); and QIAGEN, Inc. (Valencia, Calif.)).
  • polynucleotides of interest may then be tested for their ability to encode target polypeptides, to hybridize to other polynucleotides of interest, or to interfere with the expression of the target polypeptide according to methods known in the art, and the determination of the effectiveness of a particular polynucleotide based on these tests will be evident to one of skill in the art.
  • nucleotide sequences may encode a polypeptide as described herein. That is, an amino acid may be encoded by one of several different codons and a person skilled in the art can readily determine that while one particular nucleotide sequence may differ from another (which may be determined by alignment methods disclosed herein and known in the art), the sequences may encode polypeptides with identical amino acid sequences.
  • the amino acid leucine in a polypeptide may be encoded by one of six different codons (TTA, TTG, CTT, CTC, CTA, and CTG) as can serine (TCT, TCC, TCA, TCG, AGT, and AGC).
  • Other amino acids, such as proline, alanine, and valine may be encoded by any one of four different codons (CCT, CCC, CCA, CCG for proline; GCT, GCC, GCA, GCG for alanine; and GTT, GTC, GTA, GTG for valine).
  • Some of these polynucleotides bear minimal homology to the nucleotide sequence of any native gene. Nonetheless, polynucleotides that vary due to differences in codon usage are specifically contemplated by the present invention.
  • the polynucleotide may also comprise a codon optimized sequence; that is, a nucleotide sequence that has been optimized for a particular host species by replacing any codons having a usage frequency of less than about 20%.
  • Nucleotide sequences that have been optimized for expression in a given host species by elimination of spurious polyadenylation sequences, elimination of exon/intron splicing signals, elimination of transposon-like repeats and/or optimization of GC content in addition to codon optimization may be generally referred to in the art as expression enhanced sequences.
  • the polynucleotides may also be labeled with reagents that facilitate their detection.
  • the agents may be combined with fluorescent labels (e.g., Prober et al., Science 238:336-340 (1987); Albarella et al., EP 144914); chemical labels (e.g., Sheldon et al., U.S. Pat. No. 4,582,789; Albarella et al., U.S. Pat. No. 4,563,417); and/or modified bases (e.g., Miyoshi et al., EP 0 119 448) (each of which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entirety).
  • fluorescent labels e.g., Prober et al., Science 238:336-340 (1987); Albarella et al., EP 144914
  • chemical labels e.g., Sheldon et al., U.S. Pat. No. 4,582,789; Albarella et al
  • Polynucleotides or fragments thereof of the present invention are also generally capable of specifically hybridizing to other nucleic acid molecules under certain circumstances.
  • two nucleic acid molecules are said to be capable of specifically hybridizing to one another if the two molecules are capable of forming an anti-parallel, double-stranded nucleic acid structure.
  • a nucleic acid molecule or polynucleotide is said to be the complement of another nucleic acid molecule or polynucleotide if they exhibit complete complementarity.
  • Molecules are said to exhibit complete complementarity when every nucleotide of one of the molecules is complementary to a nucleotide of the other.
  • Two molecules are said to be minimally complementary if they can hybridize to one another with sufficient stability to permit them to remain annealed to one another under at least conventional low-stringency conditions. Similarly, the molecules are said to be complementary if they can hybridize to one another with sufficient stability to permit them to remain annealed to one another under conventional high-stringency conditions.
  • Conventional stringency conditions are described elsewhere herein and by Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning, A Laboratory Manual, 2nd Ed., Cold Spring Harbor Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y. (1989) and by Haymes et al., Nucleic Acid Hybridization, A Practical Approach, IRL Press, Washington, D.C. (1985), each of which is herein incorporated by reference.
  • nucleic acid molecule in order for a nucleic acid molecule to serve as a primer or probe it need only be sufficiently complementary in sequence to be able to form a stable double-stranded structure under the particular solvent and salt concentrations employed.
  • a polynucleotide of the present invention will specifically hybridize to one or more of SEQ ID NO: 7 and SEQ ID NO: 8, or complements thereof, under moderately stringent conditions.
  • Polynucleotides including polynucleotides encoding polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading activity, may be prepared using any of a variety of techniques, which will be useful for the preparation of specifically desired polynucleotides and for the identification and selection of desirable sequences to be used in polynucleotides.
  • a polynucleotide may be amplified from cDNA prepared from a suitable bacteria, cell, or tissue type.
  • Such polynucleotides may be amplified via polymerase chain reaction (PCR).
  • sequence-specific primers may be designed based on the sequences provided herein and may be purchased or synthesized.
  • An amplified portion may be used to isolate a full-length gene, or a desired portion thereof, from a suitable library using well known techniques.
  • a library cDNA or genomic
  • a library is screened using one or more polynucleotide probes or primers suitable for amplification.
  • a library is size-selected to include larger molecules.
  • Random primed libraries may also be preferred for identifying 5′ and upstream regions of genes.
  • Genomic libraries are preferred for obtaining introns and extending 5′ sequences.
  • Suitable sequences for a polynucleotide contemplated by the present invention may also be selected from a library of polynucleotide sequences.
  • a partial sequence may be labeled (e.g., by nick-translation or end-labeling with 32 P) using well known techniques.
  • a bacterial or bacteriophage library may then be screened by hybridizing filters containing denatured bacterial colonies (or lawns containing phage plaques) with the labeled probe (see, e.g., Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratories, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., 2001). Hybridizing colonies or plaques are selected and expanded, and the DNA is isolated for further analysis. Clones may be analyzed to determine the amount of additional sequence by, for example, PCR using a primer from the partial sequence and a primer from the vector. Restriction maps and partial sequences may be generated to identify one or more overlapping clones.
  • a full-length cDNA molecule can be generated by ligating suitable fragments, using well known techniques.
  • amplification techniques are known in the art for obtaining a full-length coding sequence from a partial cDNA sequence.
  • amplification is generally performed via PCR.
  • One such technique is known as rapid amplification of cDNA ends or RACE.
  • RACE rapid amplification of cDNA ends
  • This technique involves the use of an internal primer and an external primer, which hybridizes to a polyA region or vector sequence, to identify sequences that are 5′ and 3′ of a known sequence.
  • Any of a variety of commercially available kits may be used to perform the amplification step.
  • Primers may be designed using, for example, software well known in the art.
  • Primers are preferably 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31 or 32 nucleotides in length, have a GC content of at least 40% and anneal to the target sequence at temperatures of about 54° C. to 72° C.
  • the amplified region may be sequenced as described above, and overlapping sequences assembled into a contiguous sequence.
  • oligonucleotides contemplated by the present invention may, for some preferred embodiments, have lengths of 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33-35, 35-40, 41-45, 46-50, 56-60, 61-70, 71-80, 81-90, or more, nucleotides.
  • Nucleotide sequences as described herein may be joined to a variety of other nucleotide sequences using established recombinant DNA techniques.
  • a polynucleotide may be cloned into any of a variety of cloning vectors, including plasmids, phagemids, lambda phage derivatives, and cosmids.
  • Vectors of particular interest include expression vectors, replication vectors, probe generation vectors, and sequencing vectors.
  • a suitable vector contains an origin of replication functional in at least one organism, convenient restriction endonuclease sites, and one or more selectable markers. (See, e.g., PCT International Pub. No. WO 01/96584; PCT International Pub. No.
  • the invention contemplates the use of polynucleotide sequences in the preparation of recombinant nucleic acid constructs including vectors for the expression of a desired target polypeptide such as a CAE polypeptide; the invention also contemplates the generation of transgenic animals and cells (e.g., cells, cell clones, lines or lineages, or organisms in which expression of one or more desired polypeptides (e.g., a target polypeptide) is facilitated).
  • polynucleotides may be formulated so as to permit entry into a cell of a mammal, and expression therein. Such formulations are particularly useful for therapeutic purposes, as described below.
  • a polynucleotide may be incorporated into a viral vector using well known techniques (see also, e.g., U.S. Pub. App. No. 2003/0068821 (hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety)).
  • a viral vector may additionally transfer or incorporate a gene for a selectable marker (to aid in the identification or selection of transduced cells) and/or a targeting moiety, such as a gene that encodes a ligand for a receptor on a specific target cell, to render the vector target specific. Targeting may also be accomplished using an antibody, by methods known to those having ordinary skill in the art.
  • one or more promoters may be identified, isolated and/or incorporated into recombinant nucleic acid constructs of the present invention, using standard techniques.
  • the present invention provides nucleic acid molecules comprising such a promoter sequence or one or more cis- or trans-acting regulatory elements thereof. Such regulatory elements may enhance expression of a polynucleotide or polypeptide described herein.
  • a 5′ flanking region may be generated using standard techniques, based on the genomic sequence provided herein. If necessary, additional 5′ sequences may be generated using PCR-based or other standard methods. The 5′ region may be subcloned and sequenced using standard methods. Primer extension and/or RNase protection analyses may be used to verify the transcriptional start site deduced from the cDNA.
  • putative promoter inserts of varying sizes may be subcloned into a heterologous expression system containing a suitable reporter gene without a promoter or enhancer.
  • suitable reporter genes may include genes encoding beta-galactosidase, chloramphenicol acetyl transferase, luciferase, secreted alkaline phosphatase, or the Green Fluorescent Protein (GFP) gene (see, e.g., Ui-Tei et al., FEBS Lett. 479:79-82 (2000)).
  • GFP Green Fluorescent Protein
  • Internal deletion constructs may be generated using unique internal restriction sites or by partial digestion of non-unique restriction sites. Constructs may then be transfected into cells that display high levels of polynucleotide and/or polypeptide expression. In general, the construct with the minimal 5′ flanking region showing the highest level of expression of reporter gene is identified as the promoter. Such promoter regions may be linked to a reporter gene and used to evaluate agents for the ability to modulate promoter-driven transcription.
  • Cis-acting sequences may generally be identified based on homology to previously characterized transcriptional motifs. Point mutations may then be generated within the identified sequences to evaluate the regulatory role of such sequences. Such mutations may be generated using site-specific mutagenesis techniques or a PCR-based strategy. The altered promoter is then cloned into a reporter gene expression vector, as described above, and the effect of the mutation on reporter gene expression is evaluated.
  • One aspect of the present invention concerns antibodies, single-chain antigen binding molecules, or other proteins that specifically bind to one or more of the polypeptides of the present invention and their homologues, fusions or fragments. Such antibodies may be used to quantitatively or qualitatively detect the polypeptides of the present invention. In general, an antibody or peptide is said to specifically bind to a protein or peptide molecule of the present invention if such binding is not competitively inhibited by the presence of non-related molecules.
  • Polynucleotides that encode all or part of the polypeptide of the present invention can be expressed, via recombinant means, to yield protein or peptides that can in turn be used to elicit antibodies that are capable of binding the expressed protein or peptide. Such antibodies may be used, for example, in immunoassays for that protein.
  • Such protein-encoding molecules, or their fragments may be a fusion molecule (i.e., a part of a larger nucleic acid molecule) such that, upon expression, a fusion protein is produced. It is understood that any of the nucleic acid molecules of the present invention may be expressed, via recombinant means, to yield proteins or peptides encoded by these nucleic acid molecules.
  • the antibodies that specifically bind polypeptides and fragments thereof may be polyclonal or monoclonal and may comprise intact immunoglobulins, or antigen binding portions of immunoglobulins fragments (such as (F(ab′), F(ab′).sub.2), or single-chain immunoglobulins producible, for example, via recombinant means. It is understood that practitioners are familiar with the standard resource materials which describe specific conditions and procedures for the construction, manipulation and isolation of antibodies (see, for example, Harlow and Lane, In: Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y. (1988), the entirety of which is herein incorporated by reference).
  • such antibody molecules or their fragments may be used for diagnostic purposes.
  • the antibodies may be desirable to derivatize them, for example with a ligand group (such as biotin) or a detectable marker group (such as a fluorescent group, a radioisotope or an enzyme).
  • a ligand group such as biotin
  • a detectable marker group such as a fluorescent group, a radioisotope or an enzyme.
  • the ability to produce antibodies that bind the protein or peptide molecules of the present invention permits the identification of mimetic compounds of those molecules.
  • mimetic compounds are compounds that is not the particular compound of interest, or a fragment of that compound, but which nonetheless exhibits an ability to specifically bind to antibodies directed against that compound.
  • the antibody is a rabbit polyclonal antibody.
  • kits useful in carrying out the processes described herein are directed to kits useful in carrying out the processes described herein.
  • the kits for practice of the methods of the invention preferably have somewhat different forms depending on their intended functions
  • kits will typically be packaged and include vessels containing reagents, the solution volumes of which will vary based on the amount of preparations for which the kit is rated.
  • the vessels will generally include one or more reagents useful in carrying out the processes described herein.
  • the kit is a compartmentalized kit; that is, the kit includes reagents contained in the same or separate vessels.
  • vessels include, but are not limited to, small glass containers, plastic containers, or strips of plastic or paper.
  • Such containers can include a container which will accept the test sample, a container which contains the polypeptide or polynucleotide of the disclosure, a container which contains host cells or other materials for producing the polypeptides described herein (e.g., a vector, virus, or bacteriophage), containers which contain chromatography materials (such as one or more of the ion exchange, affinity, and hydrophobic interaction chromatography resins described above), containers which contain wash reagents (such as phosphate buffered saline, Tris-buffers, and the like), and/or containers which contain reagents useful in the detection of polysaccharides such as colanic acid (such as those described in the assays detailed below in Example 16).
  • the kit can include sources and concentrations of the CAE polypeptides described herein. For larger scale applications, the kits will generally include similar reagents and solutions, but in larger quantity.
  • the kit may include a suitable bacterial expression vector for cloning the CAE polynucleotides described herein.
  • the kit may include the polynucleotides and/or polypeptides themselves.
  • the kit may also include cells, such as competent cells, for transforming recombinant clones into expression vectors.
  • the kit may also include media (such as broth) for bacterial expression of the polypeptides of the invention.
  • the kits may also include a set of three common alkaline lysis buffers as described in the Qiagen product manual and in Sambrook et al.
  • Solutions I, II, and III i.e., 25 mM Tris HCl with 10 mM EDTA at pH 8.0, 1% SDS and 0.2 N NaOH, and 3 M potassium acetate at pH 5.5 respectively
  • a resuspension solution e.g., 10 mM Tris HCl at pH 8.0.
  • centrifuge-based spin filters or disc filters can be included.
  • One model spin filter that works for this application is a Millipore Durapore centrifuge filter (Millipore Corporation, Billerica, Mass.).
  • filters can be included that have a packed steel wool, cellulose or polymer/plastic material in a centrifuge or other filter mechanism (e.g., a disc).
  • Ceramic filters can also be included. Filter aids, such as a diatomaceous earth or similar compound, may also be included.
  • a tangential-flow filter can be provided.
  • the kit includes one or more of the polypeptides described herein.
  • the polypeptide included in the kit may be a purified polypeptide comprising an amino acid sequence having at least 90%, 98%, 99%, or 100% homology to SEQ ID NO: 1, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof.
  • the polypeptide may have the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1.
  • the polypeptide included in the kit may be a purified polypeptide comprising an amino acid sequence having at least 90%, 98%, 99%, or 100% homology to SEQ ID NO: 2, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof.
  • the polypeptide may have the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 2.
  • the polypeptide included in the kit may also include a tag for isolation or purification (e.g., a His-tag or a FLAG®-tag); thus, the polypeptide included in the kit correspond to SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 6.
  • the kit may include reagents and compositions that may be used to form such tagged polypeptides, along with the polypeptides of SEQ ID NO: 1 or SEQ ID NO: 2, and variants thereof.
  • kits will also typically include instructions for use.
  • the instructions will generally be suitable to enable an end user to carry out the desired preparation or assay.
  • the instructions will generally be in a tangible expression, e.g., describing the reagent concentration for at least one preparation or assay, parameters such as the relative amount of reagent and sample to be admixed, maintenance or incubation time periods for reagent/sample admixtures, temperature requirements or preferences, and the like.
  • the instructions may be printed on the outer or inner packaging of the kit, in a brochure, card, or other paper within the kit, and/or on the outer surface of the containers or vessels included in the kit.
  • Colanic acid is present at significant levels in all plasmid DNA preparations, including clinical grade (cGMP) preparations.
  • Colanic Acid comprises about 25% of the bacterial cell wall of gram negative bacteria. Colanic acid must be removed in order to provide the greatest safety, especially when mixed with cationic carriers for delivery in animals and in humans. Removal of colanic acid also increases gene expression from each plasmid because colanic acid is an inhibitor of RNA polymerase activity.
  • a range of 2.2 to 4.4-fold increased reporter gene expression (CAT, chloramphenicol acetyltransferase) in the organs of Balb/c mice post-intravenous (iv) injection of BIV DNA-liposome complexes has been observed. Because colanic acid is often extremely large and branched-chain, it typically must be degraded in order to be effectively removed.
  • colanic acid degrading enzyme A specific enzyme, referred to hereafter as colanic acid degrading enzyme (CAE), had been reported to be produced by specific lytic bacteriophages (Hughes, K. A. et al. 1998 . J. Appl. Microbiol. 85:583-590).
  • the colanic acid degrading enzyme (CAE) had only been partially purified by researchers. Therefore, in order to develop a method for removal of colanic acid using a CAE, the enzyme must be purified, sequenced and expressed.
  • NST1 A bacteriophage (NST1) was identified that has the ability to lyse the E. coli strain SC12078, a strain that overproduces colanic acid.
  • the NST1 bacteriophage was isolated and used as a source to isolate a purified CAE. It has been shown that polysaccharide viscosity decreases after incubation with a specific polysaccharide degrading enzyme (Sutherland, I. W. 1967 . Biochem. J. 104:278-285). Thus, the protein samples containing CAE were identified by their ability to affect viscosity of samples containing colanic acid. It was found that the purified CAE isolated from NST1 had high levels of CAE activity as demonstrated by its ability to decrease the viscosity of colanic acid.
  • the purified CAE was isolated, as identified by bioassay of the ability to decrease sample viscosity, it was subjected to mass spectrometry and Edman degradation. Using Edman degradation, 15 amino acids were identified. By mass spectrometry, 8 additional protein fragments were sequenced, with each fragment containing between 6 to 16 amino acids. Screening of publicly available protein databases, including bacteriophage databases, did not reveal a single match with any of the peptide fragments.
  • a set of degenerate oligonucleotides was prepared based on the peptide sequences. These oligonucleotides were used to sequence the Colanic Acid Degrading Enzyme from the genomic DNA purified from the NST1 bacteriophage.
  • the open reading frame (ORF) of the CAE was determined.
  • the nucleotide CAE ORF was sequenced and the amino acid sequence of CAE determined using the universal genetic code. These sequences are shown in FIG. 1 .
  • PCR primers made to the beginning and end of the CAE ORF were used to amplify the ORF sequences from the NST1 bacteriophage genomic DNA by PCR for subsequent cloning into a yeast expression vector.
  • a naturally occurring colanic acid degrading enzyme has been produced from bacteriophage that is a newly identified protein; generally, only small amounts are produced, approximately 110 ug from a 4.5 L phage+bacterial growth.
  • a rabbit polyclonal antibody to this protein has also been produced that is a peptide generated antibody. This antibody is highly active and can be used for any purpose including Western blotting, ELISA assay, etc.
  • CAE a recombinant form of CAE was created for use in further purifying plasmid DNA preparations.
  • Prior attempts to produce full-length recombinant CAE in yeast, baculovirus, and bacteria were generally unsuccessful, believed to be due to improper protein folding.
  • 107 amino acids could be removed from the amino terminus (N-terminus) of the CAE protein without loss of activity.
  • Chymotrypsin was the only protease that cleaved the natural full-length protein at this one location, amino acids 106-107.
  • the recombinant CAE protein is not cleaved by any protease and is extremely stable (>2 years).
  • the truncated protein is produced in Escherichia coli , BL21(DE3) grown at 16° C. overnight and then purified. About 10 mg of CAE recombinant protein from 1 L of growth can be produced.
  • Any plasmid DNA preparation can then be digested with recombinant CAE and further purified. Briefly, plasmid DNA is digested with CAE for 3 hours at 37° C. and then at 50° C. for 21 hours. Protein is removed, and the DNA is first purified by boronic acid chromatography. The plasmid DNA flows through and does not bind the column. Most polysaccharides except for extremely small fragments bind to the column. To remove the smallest, digested polysaccharides, the DNA suspension is finally purified by a Macrosep 100 Centrifugal Concentrator unit in the presence of zwittergent. The zwittergent is generally preferred because colanic acid appears to bind tightly to the plasmid DNA.
  • recombinant CAE can also be placed on a solid support that can be regenerated and reused multiple times.
  • Colanic acid was prepared using SC12078 bacteria, a bacterial strain that is known to overproduce colanic acid. A few colonies of SC12078 bacteria were picked from a plate and inoculated into 2 liters of LB broth with 0.4% glycerol containing chloramphenicol (10 ug/ml). The bacteria were allowed to grow at 37° C. in a shaker incubator at 230 rpm overnight. The growth was stopped when the cultures reached an optical density (OD) 600 between about 4.5 to about 4.7.
  • OD 600 optical density 600 between about 4.5 to about 4.7.
  • the flasks of bacteria Prior to removing the bacteria by centrifugation, the flasks of bacteria were briefly shaken to increase the amount of colanic acid released into the culture medium. The bacteria were pelleted by centrifugation at 6,000 ⁇ g for 15 min at 4° C. The bacterial pellet was discarded and the supernatant saved and concentrated using an Amicon filter apparatus with a YM30 membrane.
  • the colanic acid was precipitated from the concentrated supernatant by adding 3 volumes of ice cold ethanol to one volume of supernatant and letting the mixture sit on ice for 15 min.
  • the precipitate was collected by centrifuging the mixture at 10,000 ⁇ g for at least 15 min at 0° C., or until the supernatant is clear.
  • the precipitate was dissolved in a minimal amount of sterile water and dialyzed overnight against at least three changes of water.
  • the dialyzed solution was lyophilized to dryness, being sure to weigh the tube that the solution was to be dried in before adding the solution in order to determine the weight of the sample after freeze drying. Once the sample was totally dried, water was added to the sample to make a 2% solution of the lyophilized sample.
  • Solid ammonium sulfate was added to the 2% solution of the lyophilized sample to achieve a 90% ammonium sulfate saturated solution.
  • the 90% ammonium sulfate saturated solution precipitated the 0 antigen and the colanic acid.
  • the precipitated polysaccharides were collected by centrifugation at 10,000 ⁇ g for at least 15 min at 0° C., or until the supernatant was clear.
  • the pelleted precipitate was dissolved in a minimal amount of water, dialyzed overnight against at least three changes of water, and lyophilized to dryness.
  • the lyophilate was dissolved in 150 ml of 0.1 M sodium phosphate pH 7.2.
  • the colanic acid was precipitated from the lyophilate solution by adding 37.5 ml of hexa-decyl-trimethyl-ammonium bromide (also called cetavlon or cetrimide).
  • the colanic acid precipitate was collected by centrifugation at 10,000 ⁇ g for at least 15 min at 0° C., or until the supernatant was clear.
  • the pelleted precipitate was dissolved in 100 ml of 1M NaCl.
  • the colanic acid is reprecipitated by adding 3 volumes of ice cold ethanol to the 1M NaCl solution and letting the mixture sit on ice for 15 min.
  • the colanic acid precipitate was collected by centrifuging the mixture at 10,000 ⁇ g for at least 15 min at 0° C., or until the supernatant was clear.
  • the colanic acid precipitate was dissolved in a minimal amount of sterile water and dialyzed in a cold room overnight against at least three changes of water.
  • the dialyzed solution was lyophilized to dryness, being sure to weigh the tube that the solution was to be dried in before adding the solution in order to determine the weight of the sample after freeze drying. Once the sample was totally dried, the colanic acid was dissolved in a minimal amount of water, aliquoted into sterile tubes, and stored at ⁇ 25° C.
  • the NST1 bacteriophage was identified as a good source of CAE by its ability to lyse E. coli strain SC12078, a strain that overproduces colanic acid.
  • the NST1 bacteriophage was isolated and used as a source to isolate a purified CAE.
  • the overnight growth (200 ul) is mixed with 1 ul of phage stock to make the 10 7 concentration of phage. Additional dilutions are made containing 180 ul of overnight bacterial growth mixed with 20 ul of the next higher concentration of phage. The highest concentrations containing 107 through 103 particles are discarded.
  • the lower 5 dilutions were plated by quickly mixing each into 3 ml of LB+glycerol top agar (agarose at 0.7%, kept at 55° C.). The mixture was quickly poured onto LB+Chloramphenicol (10 ug/ml) plates. The mixing and pouring is preferably done quickly to avoid solidification of the top agar. The plates were then incubated upside down at 37° C. for 5 hours. After incubation, plates were wrapped with parafilm and stored at 4° C. Plates that do not contain plaques are discarded.
  • the bacterial strain SC12078 (a strain overproducing colanic acid) was maintained on LB-containing chloramphenicol (10 ug/ml) agar plates and stored at 4° C.
  • LB-containing chloramphenicol (10 ug/ml) agar plates were maintained on LB-containing chloramphenicol (10 ug/ml) agar plates and stored at 4° C.
  • Several plates of NST1 phage, as described in Example 2 were maintained on LB-glycerol top agar (agarose 0.7%), layered on top of LB-chloramphenicol (10 mg/ml) agar plates stored at 4° C. The plates were not stored for more than one month as NST1 loses viability and its ability to infect bacteria with longer storage time periods.
  • Phage supernatant was prepared as described in Example 3. Phenyl methyl sulfonyl fluoride (PMSF) was added to the phage supernatant to a final concentration of 0.1 mM PMSF to prepare the starting solution and then stored at 4° C.
  • PMSF Phenyl methyl sulfonyl fluoride
  • the starting solution for CAE purification was centrifuged in the table-top centrifuged at about 4200 rpm for 20 min at 4° C. The resulting supernatant was removed and saved and the pellet discarded. Using an Amicon filter apparatus and a YM30 membrane, the supernatant volume was reduced from 4 liters to a 4 ml sample. The 4 ml sample was further centrifuged in a polycarbonate centrifuge tube at 40,000 ⁇ g in an SS34 rotor for 60 minutes at 4° C. The sample was dialyzed overnight in the cold room against at least 3 changes of 10 mM Tris HCl, pH 7.5, containing 0.1 mM PMSF.
  • a Q Sepharose Fast Flow column (10 cm high, 1.5 cm diameter) was equilibrated with 10 mM Tris HCl, pH 7.5, 0.1 mM PMSF until the pH of the fluid eluting from the column was 7.5.
  • the dialyzed supernatant was loaded onto the equilibrated column and the column washed with 2 column volumes (about 30 ml) of 10 mM Tris HCl, pH 7.5, 0.1 mM PMSF.
  • the column was eluted using a linear gradient from 10 mM Tris HCl, pH 7.5, 0.1 mM PMSF (150 ml) to 200 mM Tris HCl, pH 6.5, 0.1 mM PMSF (150 ml) collecting 4 ml fractions (75 fractions total) at a flow rate of 7 ml per hour.
  • the fractions collected were tested for colanic acid degrading activity using a viscometer test, described below in Example 5, and those fractions containing CAE activity were pooled.
  • the pooled CAE active fractions were then concentrated on a disposable Amicon filter by centrifugation.
  • the protein concentration of the resulting concentrate was determined and a sample of the concentrate was electrophoresed on a gradient polyacrylamide gel (4-12%).
  • the electrophoresed sample contained five protein bands.
  • the protein concentrate was then separated by size on a 120 cm column containing Toyopearl HW-50F resin equilibrated with phosphate buffered saline (PBS), pH 7.3-7.4, containing 0.1 mM PMSF.
  • PBS phosphate buffered saline
  • the column eluate was collected in 1 ml fractions. Each fraction was tested for CAE activity and the active fractions were pooled.
  • the pooled fractions were concentrated on a disposable Amicon filter by centrifugation.
  • the protein concentration of the concentrate was determined and a sample of the concentrate was electrophoresed on a gradient polyacrylamide gel (4-12%). A single protein band was obtained that had a molecular weight of about 84,000 Daltons.
  • the protein band was prepared by standard procedures and submitted for mass spectrometric analysis and Edman degradation.
  • the CAE protein was purified as described previously.
  • the purified CAE protein was subjected to mass spectrometry using the Applied Biosystems Procise Sequencer PROCISE-cLC for 17 cycles and Edman degradation. Using Edman degradation, 15 amino acids of the N-terminus were identified as set forth below:
  • LLEQGTGEALTDGVLR (SEQ ID NO: 10) VPNSEVSLNALPNVQR (SEQ ID NO: 11) LADYEFTSAPSNSK (SEQ ID NO: 12) YSDLSTLN (SEQ ID NO: 13) QLLFDTAPLA (SEQ ID: 14) APYQVDDNL (SEQ ID NO: 15) FGAYLPDD (SEQ ID NO: 16) LGTLGG (SEQ ID NO: 17)
  • the amino acid leucine (L) may actually be either leucine (L) or isoleucine (I)
  • the amino acid aspartic acid (D) may actually be aspartic acid (D) or asparagine (N)
  • the amino acid glutamine (Q) may actually be glutamine (Q) or lysine (K)
  • the amino acid phenylalanine (F) may actually be phenylalanine (F) or oxidized methionine.
  • Degenerate oligonucleotide primers are prepared using degenerate codons of the amino acid sequences from the protein fragments of the CAE protein described above.
  • the genomic DNA of the Bacteriophage NST1 was purified using standard DNA purification methods.
  • the degenerate oligonucleotide primers were used to hybridize with the bacteriophage genomic DNA to identify the CAE gene as described below.
  • Sequencing of the CAE ORF was performed directly on the NST1 bacteriophage genomic DNA starting with the degenerate primers and then using primers based on known sequences for subsequent rounds of sequencing.
  • the CAE ORF was fully sequenced on both strands of the NST1 bacteriophage genomic DNA.
  • the nucleotide sequence of the CAE was determined as set out in FIG. 9 :
  • the amino acid sequence was determined using the universal genetic code and is shown in alignment with the nucleotide sequence in FIG. 1 .
  • the amino terminus of the CAE matched the Edman degradation results, except the Edman degradation did not detect the terminal methionine.
  • the molecular weight for the CAE was determined to be 84,354 and corresponded to the molecular weight of the protein band sequenced as determined by its position on polyacrylamide gels.
  • a plasmid DNA sample is tested for the presence of colanic acid. If colanic acid is present in the plasmid DNA sample then the sample of plasmid DNA is incubated with the recombinant colanic acid degrading enzyme of the present invention.
  • the CAE will digest the colanic acid into a number of smaller polysaccharides that can be separated from the plasmid DNA by a variety of methods known in the art.
  • the plasmid DNA sample will then be separated from the CAE and further purified as described herein.
  • This construct was transformed and grown in expression host BL21 (DE3) in Hyper Broth medium containing 50 mg/liter kanamycin. The large-scale culture was grown at 37° C. with shaking at 225 rpm until OD 600 reached 0.5 (about 2 to 4 hours). The temperature was changed to 16° C., and growth was continued for 30 min.
  • IPTG was added to a final concentration of 0.015 mM, and growth continued for an additional 20 hours.
  • the recombinant CAE is then purified on a Ni-NTA column that selectively binds the 6 histidines at the N-terminus.
  • the bound protein is then eluted, concentrated, reconstituted in storage buffer, and stored in the refrigerator at 4° C.
  • boronic acid affinity resins bind compounds containing cis-diol groups.
  • a preferred boronic acid affinity column can be acquired from Pierce, Rockford, Il. This boronic acid column has a coupled m-aminophenylboronic acid to polyacrylamide spherical beads at 100 mmoles of boronate/ml of gel.
  • the boronic acid column was equilibrated in 0.2 M ammonium acetate, pH 8.8.
  • the plasmid DNA samples were precipitated in ethanol and the precipitate washed with 70% ethanol.
  • the washed pellet of DNA was dissolved in 0.2 M ammonium acetate, pH 8.8.
  • the DNA solution was then loaded onto a boronic acid column at approximately 10 mg DNA per 2 ml of boronate column material.
  • the column was then washed with 0.2 M ammonium acetate, pH 8.8.
  • the column wash was collected in fractions and the optical density (O.D.) of each fraction at 260 nm was measured.
  • the fractions having the highest O.D. 260 nm were pooled and loaded onto a second boronic acid column.
  • the second column was washed with 0.2 M ammonium acetate, pH 8.8. Fractions from the column wash were collected and each of their O.D. 260 nm measured. The fractions having the highest O.D. 260 nm were pooled and the DNA precipitated with ethanol. The precipitate was washed with 70% ethanol and resuspended in 10 mM Tris buffer, pH 8.0. The DNA sample was filter sterilized and stored at ⁇ 20° C. until it was used.
  • Plasmid DNA did not bind to the boronate column and flowed through the boronate column with the wash buffer.
  • the polysaccharide contaminants, RNA, and LPS bound or adsorbed onto the boronate column. Eluting the polysaccharide fractions with 0.1 M formic acid regenerated the boronic acid columns. The boronic acid columns were then washed and stored in 0.1 M sodium chloride and 0.02% sodium azide.
  • the purified DNA sample was then subjected to the methods of detection and quantification for polysaccharides of the present invention.
  • Each purified sample was subjected to one or more polysaccharide detection method (i.e., the uronic acid detection method, the fucose detection method, and/or the fluorescence labeling method).
  • the results of the polysaccharide detection methods consistently demonstrated that the use of boronate chromatography produced DNA samples with polysaccharide contents that were reduced to undetectable levels.
  • E. coli expresses several major classes of polysaccharides, including O- and K-antigen associated polysaccharides, colanic acid, and enterobacterial common antigen (ECA). Colanic acid exists in both high and low molecular weight forms, whereas ECA is typically in a low molecular weight form.
  • the O- and K-antigen associated polysaccharides have variants that are associated with Lipid A and other variants that are not associated with Lipid A.
  • the Lipid A associated polysaccharides may be either covalently linked, or non-covalently linked.
  • the Lipid A associated polysaccharides are characteristically low molecular weight variants.
  • the O- and K-antigen associated polysaccharides that are not associated with Lipid A exist as high and low molecular weight variants.
  • E. coli capsular polysaccharides particularly the long-chain and branched polysaccharides found in plasmid DNA preparations, contains uronic acid.
  • colanic acid is approximately 11 weight % uronic acid.
  • Enterobacterial common antigen (ECA) consists of about 33 weight % uronic acid and the O- and K-antigen associated polysaccharides have about 25 weight % uronic acid.
  • Heparin sulfate resembles the polysaccharide contaminants from E. coli , because uronic acid comprises about 25% of the total weight of heparin sulfate. Heparin sulfate consists of 50% sugars by weight. Half of these sugars are glucosamine and the other half of the sugars are iduronic acid and glucuronic acid. The rest of the heparin sulfate is contributed by modifications of the sugars including sulfates and acetylamides. Alternatively, glucuronic acid can be used to create a standard curve for the direct measurement of uronic acid.
  • Standard curves are generated using 0.1 ml of heparin or glucuronic acid standards containing 0.0, 0.05, 0.1, 0.2, or 0.5 mg of the standard per milliliter of solution.
  • the standard solution (0.1 ml) is placed is a glass test tube with 3 ml of a borate/sulfuric acid solution (i.e., 0.025 M sodium tetraborate 10-hydrate dissolved in sulfuric acid having a specific gravity of 1.84) and mixed well.
  • a 0.1 ml of a 0.125% solution of carbazole in absolute ethanol is added to the mixture and the entire mixture is vortexed.
  • the top of each test tube is covered and the tubes are immersed in boiling water for 10 min.
  • the tubes are allowed to cool and the absorbance of the solution at 530 nm is read in a spectrophotometer.
  • the absorbance values obtained for the standards are plotted against the concentration of the standards.
  • the uronic acid content of plasmid DNA samples can be extrapolated from its absorbance value at 530 nm when the DNA sample has undergone the same reaction.
  • the polysaccharide content of the plasmid DNA sample can then be extrapolated by multiplying the amount of uronic acid by a number ranging from 3.3 to 9.1 (depending on the prevalence of colanic acid, ECA and the O- and K-antigens in the sample).
  • the uronic acid content of plasmid DNA samples was calculated from standard curves generated with heparin and glucuronic acid standards. The results generated from the two standard curves were substantially equivalent.
  • plasmid DNA preparations were also subjected to an assay for colanic acid.
  • the colanic acid assay was based on the amount of fucose present per mg of DNA.
  • Colanic acid consists of 22% fucose in the ratio of 2:2:1:1:3 (fucose:galactose: glucose: uronic acid:other modifications), whereas the other polysaccharide contaminants do not contain fucose, or only small amounts of fucose.
  • the fucose assay allowed for identification of the amount of colanic acid contamination in a purified plasmid DNA preparation.
  • plasmid DNA preparation containing about 0.7 mg polysaccharide per mg of DNA, as estimated by the uronic acid assay, had 0.14 mg of fucose per mg of DNA or about 0.64 mg of colanic acid. It was generally found that the primary polysaccharide contaminant in plasmid DNA preparations was colanic acid.
  • DNA samples to be assayed (450 ug) are transferred to 3 ml vials and lyophilized.
  • 200 ul of 5.5 M trifluoroacetic acid is added and the reaction vials are sealed with a Teflon-lined cap.
  • Hydrolysis is accomplished by heating the samples for 4 hours at 100° C.
  • the trifluoroacetic acid is removed with a stream of argon gas under a fume hood. The remaining residue is then redissolved in 212 ul of sterile water. Only 200 ul of the resulting sample, which corresponds to 425 ug of the initial DNA sample, is used in the fucose assay.
  • the tubes are placed on ice and 50 ul of a 1 mg/ml fucose dehydrogenase solution is added, followed by 50 ul of 200 uM NAD+.
  • the tubes are mixed and incubated for 3 hours at 4° C.
  • 50 ul of 1 N NaOH is added to each tube, mixed, and incubated for 10 minutes at 60° C.
  • the tubes are then cooled on ice and the samples are mixed with 50 ul of 1 M hydrochloric to neutralize the samples.
  • cycling reagent 200 mM Tris pH 8.4; 50 mM ammonium acetate; 0.5 mM ADP; 100 mM lactate; 5 mM alpha-ketoglutarate; 20 units/ml lactate dehydrogenase; 20 units/ml glutamate dehydrogenase
  • 500 mM Tris pH 8.4; 50 mM ammonium acetate; 0.5 mM ADP; 100 mM lactate; 5 mM alpha-ketoglutarate; 20 units/ml lactate dehydrogenase; 20 units/ml glutamate dehydrogenase is added, the solution is mixed, and incubated for 1 hour at room temperature. Heating each tube for 2 minutes in boiling water stops the enzymatic reaction of the cycling reagent.
  • the tubes are cooled on ice and then 250 ul of pyruvate reagent (800 mM imidazole buffer, pH 6.2; 0.45 mM NADH; 0.06 units/ml lactate dehydrogenase) is added and the tubes mixed.
  • pyruvate reagent 800 mM imidazole buffer, pH 6.2; 0.45 mM NADH; 0.06 units/ml lactate dehydrogenase
  • the tubes are then warmed for 1 to 2 minutes at room temperature in a water bath before placement in an incubator at 30° C. for 20 minutes.
  • the pyruvate reaction is stopped by adding 200 ul of 1.5 M HCl to each sample and mixing the solution.
  • each tube is then transferred to a 15 ml capped tube and 2.5 ml of 6 N NaOH is added and mixed.
  • the tubes are then incubated for 10 minutes at 60° C. After cooling the samples to room temperature, 4 ml of sterile water is added to each tube, the tubes inverted and then subjected to fluorescence measurement.
  • each sample 300 ul is aliquoted into a well of a 96-well microtiter plate. Three to five wells are filled with sterile water and used as blanks.
  • the fluorometer is set using a 360 nm excitation filter and a 465 nm emission filter. The fluorescence of the standards and samples is read and the fluorescence of the blanks subtracted out. The fluorescence readings of the standards are graphed as a standard curve and the amount of fucose in the plasmid DNA samples is determined by interpolation from the standard curve.
  • a visual method developed for the detection of polysaccharides in plasmid DNA samples involved labeling of the samples with a substance capable of selectively labeling polysaccharides in a plasmid DNA sample.
  • a substance capable of selectively labeling polysaccharides in a plasmid DNA sample is DTAF, (4,6-dichlorotriazinyl) aminofluorescein (Molecular Probes, Eugene, Oreg.).
  • DTAF specifically labels all polysaccharides whether or not they contain uronic acid.
  • This fluorescence probe reacts with hydroxyl groups found in polysaccharides or carbohydrates and is therefore a probe with application beyond the assay method using uronic acid detection.
  • DTAF does not label DNA, since DNA does not have free hydroxyl groups available. All of the available hydroxyl groups in DNA are phosphorylated. This specificity makes DTAF the preferred label for distinguishing DNA from its polysaccharide contaminants. Although DTAF was used in the method of the present invention, one of skill would understand that any fluorescence label that provides for specificity of labeling between polysaccharides and DNA would be useful in the method of the present invention.
  • DNA and polysaccharide can be visualized in parallel samples run on one gel.
  • DNA is pretreated with ethidium bromide (EtBr) before adding the samples to the gel.
  • Polysaccharides are labeled with DTAF.
  • a plasmid DNA sample can be run in two lanes on one gel with the sample in one lane stained with EtBr and the sample in the other lane stained with DTAF; thereby, allowing one to visualize the polysaccharide and DNA content of a plasmid DNA sample.
  • DNA and polysaccharide standards (40 ul of a 2 mg/ml solution) were precipitated by the addition of 10 ul of 3M sodium acetate, pH 5.2, followed by 200 ul of cold ethanol. The samples were incubated for 30 minutes at ⁇ 20° C., then centrifuged 4 minutes at 10,000 rpm in an Eppendorf microfuge. The precipitates were then suspended in 10 ul sodium acetate plus 200 ul ethanol and recentrifuged. The precipitates were then resuspended in 200 ul ethanol, recentrifuged and dissolved in 50 ul 0.1 M sodium carbonate, pH 10.5.
  • a fresh DTAF suspension is prepared by suspending 60 mg/ml DTAF in carbonate buffer. Since not all of the DTAF will go into solution, the resulting suspension is vortexed before its addition to each sample.
  • a 5 ul sample of the fresh DTAF suspension (which has been kept dark and cold) is added to the dissolved sample at timed intervals of 0 minutes, 45 minutes, and 90 minutes.
  • the reaction mixture is vortexed and placed at room temperature in the dark.
  • the reaction is terminated after 2.5 hours by precipitating each sample with the addition of 10 ul sodium acetate and 325 ul ethanol. Incubating these samples for 45 minutes at ⁇ 20° C. encourages the precipitation.
  • the samples are then centrifuged and the precipitates washed 3 times with 25 ul sodium acetate and 500 ul ethanol.
  • the samples are finally washed with 500 ul ethanol and then dried for 20 minutes at room temperature in the dark.
  • the washed samples are dissolved in 40 ul Tris Acetate EDTA (TAE) buffer and 2.5 ul to 20 ul of the sample are applied to the gel.
  • DNA samples that were not reacted with DTAF were added to other lanes in the gel in the presence of EtBr.
  • Lambda DNA-Hind III Digest and PhiX174 DNA-HaeIII Digest are run as gel markers.
  • the gel is a 1% agarose Tris Acetate EDTA gel, pH 8.3. Neither the gel nor the running buffer contain ethidium bromide. The gel is electrophoresed for 45 minutes at 90 volts. It is important to note that the sample buffer must be free of bromophenol blue, which will quench the DTAF fluorescence, except in the Lambda Hind III marker lane.
  • FIG. 2 shows a gel where several different DNA plasmid samples were tested using this gel electrophoretic method for polysaccharide visualization and quantification.
  • LPS Sigma Chemical Company, St. Louis, Mo.
  • detoxified LPS where the fatty acid portions of the Lipid A have been removed
  • Lanes 1-4 and 12 illustrate the DTAF staining of plasmid DNA samples for which the uronic acid content is given in Table 1.
  • Lane 5, 7, 9, 11 and 13 have no sample loaded.
  • Lane 6 illustrates the DTAF staining of a Qiagen endotoxin free DNA sample (currently considered the gold standard for purified plasmid DNA).
  • Lanes 14 through 20 of the gel illustrated in FIG. 2 show the results of EtBr staining of different DNA samples.
  • Lanes 14-17 are the same DNA samples stained with EtBr that are stained with DTAF in Lanes 1-4.
  • Lane 18 is the DNA sample shown in Lane 12 stained with EtBr.
  • Lane 19 is the EtBr stain of the Qiagen endotoxin-free DNA sample, shown in Lane 6 stained with DTAF.
  • Lane 20 is a mixture of high and low DNA molecular weight markers labeled with EtBr.
  • mice To determine whether the levels of polysaccharide detected in plasmid DNA samples were clinically significant, acute toxicity studies of the samples were performed in animals. Balb/c mice, six weeks old, were injected intravenously with DNA-liposome complexes, where the liposomes were prepared according to published procedures (Nancy Smyth Templeton, et al. July 1997 . Nature Biotechnology 15:647-652). Twenty mice in each group were injected and followed for one week post-injection. The results are shown in Table 4.
  • Results showed that the intravenous injection of 100 ul of DNA containing 0.4 mg polysaccharide per mg DNA caused all of the mice to die within 18 hours post-injection. In contrast, the injection of 50 ul of the same DNA did not cause any of the animals to dies within a week after injection. Similar results were obtained using DNA samples from various sources.
  • Plasmid DNA containing levels of about 0.26 mg polysaccharide per mg DNA were found to reduce gene expression when 50 ug DNA were injected into immune compromised transgenic mice once a week for three months. When plasmid DNA preparations contained undetectable levels of polysaccharide per mg DNA ( ⁇ 0.03 mg), there were no adverse effects in the animals.
  • mice We also performed additional in vivo studies in mice to test our DNA purification procedure using the truncated CAE recombinant protein. These studies were performed in normal mice (Balb/c), and in SCID mice with or without pancreatic tumors. SCID mice are more sensitive to colanic acid and die at iv injections containing 40 ug of commercially produced plasmid DNA complexed to liposomes and other cationic carriers, whereas Balb/c mice die at levels just above 50 ug of plasmid DNA. In the tables show in FIGS. 12-14 , we showed that a total of 120 mice survived high doses of DNA-BIV liposomal complexes post-iv injections, purified according to the processes of the invention.
  • Colanic Acid Enzyme (6 ⁇ His-CAE) and other carbohydrases increase the reducing ends when degrading their substrates.
  • the miniaturized highly sensitive bicinchoninic acid (BCA) reducing value assay presented in this protocol detects reducing ends of sugars. This assay can be used for the detection of all carbohydrases degrading any polysaccharide; enzymes with either an exo- or endo-type of mechanisms. However caution should be exercised to reduce background absorbance caused by culture medium, proteins and substrates.
  • Bovine Serum Albumin (BSA): 0.5 ⁇ g/ ⁇ l in 0.05 M potassium phosphate buffer pH 6.5
  • Buffer 0.05 M potassium phosphate buffer pH 6.5
  • this assay uses a 96 well format, with each well contains a mixture of 2 ⁇ g of CAE (TEST) or BSA (BLANK), 100 ⁇ g CA, in a total volume of 110 ⁇ l of Buffer which is incubated at 37° C. for 3 hours, and later at 50° C. for 21 hours. Subsequently 100 ⁇ l of each reaction mix is transferred to a new 96 well plate, to which 100 ⁇ l of freshly prepared BCA reagent is added and allowed to incubate at 37° C. for 2 hours, cooled to RT for 15 min, and readings at 550 nm are taken using a multiplate reader.
  • Aliquot Blank total volume is 110 ⁇ l (i.e. Buffer+CA+BSA) in triplicates, i.e. add the following in the same sequence, 56 ⁇ l Buffer+50 ⁇ l of 2 ⁇ g/ ⁇ l CA+4 ⁇ l of 0.5 ⁇ g/ ⁇ l BSA.
  • Aliquot Test total volume is 110 ⁇ l (i.e. Buffer+CA+6 ⁇ His CAE) in triplicates, i.e. add the following in the sequence, 56 ⁇ l Buffer+50 ⁇ l of 2 ⁇ g/ ⁇ l CA+4 ⁇ l of 0.5 ⁇ g/ ⁇ l 6 ⁇ His-CAE.
  • BCA reagent by mixing the three reagents provided in the Micro BCA kit, i.e., MA+MB+MC in a ratio of 0.5:0.48:0.02 using enough to be sufficient for all the wells. Aliquot 100 ⁇ l of this freshly prepared BCA reagent to each of the well using a multichannel pipet, mixing gently by pipeting three times up and down. Put lid on 96 well plate, and incubate plate in 37° C. incubator for 2 hours. Let plate cool at room temp for 15 mins, and take reading at 550 nm using multiplate reader.
  • Colanic Acid is viscous, and there is a reduction of its viscosity when it is catalytically degraded by Colanic Acid Enzyme (6 ⁇ His-CAE). This drop in viscosity can be accurately measured using a viscometer and can be used to calculate activity of CAE by comparing it to the values obtained using a Control reaction i.e., containing CA but in the absence of the enzyme.
  • Colanic Acid Enzyme (6 ⁇ His-CAE) 1.0 ⁇ g/ ⁇ l in 0.05 M Potassium Phosphate Buffer pH 6.5
  • a bioassay measuring changes in the viscosity of colanic acid samples was used to detect CAE.
  • a decrease the viscosity of colanic acid samples was indicative of CAE activity.
  • the viscosity of the colanic acid samples, before and after incubation with an enzyme fraction, was measured using a Wells-Brookfield Cone Plate viscometer with a CPE-40 cone. This viscometer provided the most sensitive measurement of changes in viscosity in small volumes of about 500 ul. Viscometer accuracy was monitored by measuring the viscosity of a mineral oil standard and comparing the reading with the known viscosity for mineral oil.
  • the CAE assay utilized a 500 ul sample of a 1.5% colanic acid solution. Diluted enzyme samples or controls samples, between 50 to 100 ul, was added to the 1.5% colanic acid solution. Controls for the enzyme assays were prepared by adding the diluted enzyme samples to buffer and by adding non-proteinaceous samples to the 1.5% colanic acid solution. Each test sample (enzyme samples or control samples) was incubated for one hour at 37° C. After the one hour incubation, the test samples were allowed to adjust to room temperature for 10 minutes.
  • the viscosity of all test samples was taken at room temperature for 30 seconds at 100 rpm. All test samples having CAE activity, isolated and purified as described above, demonstrated a significant decrease in viscosity, as compared to the control samples that showed no change in viscosity.
  • the CAE test samples decreased the viscosity of the 1.5% colanic acid solution from 1.51 to 0.99, where 0.99 was the lowest viscometry reading obtainable using the Wells-Brookfield Cone Plate viscometer and was equal to the viscometry reading of the buffer controls.
  • the present invention provides both a method of detection and quantification of polysaccharides in plasmid DNA samples and a method for removing polysaccharide from plasmid DNA samples to levels of polysaccharides below levels that produce clinically significant toxicity.
  • compositions and methods disclosed and claimed herein can be made and executed without undue experimentation in light of the present disclosure. While the compositions and methods of this invention have been described in terms of preferred embodiments, it will be apparent to those of skill in the art that variations may be applied to the compositions and/or methods and in the steps or in the sequence of steps of the methods described herein without departing from the concept, spirit and scope of the invention. More specifically, it will be apparent that certain agents which are both chemically and physiologically related may be substituted for the agents described herein while the same or similar results would be achieved. All such similar substitutes and modifications apparent to those skilled in the art are deemed to be within the spirit, scope and concept of the invention as defined by the appended claims.

Landscapes

  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • Genetics & Genomics (AREA)
  • Biomedical Technology (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Zoology (AREA)
  • Wood Science & Technology (AREA)
  • Biotechnology (AREA)
  • General Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Analytical Chemistry (AREA)
  • Molecular Biology (AREA)
  • Biochemistry (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Microbiology (AREA)
  • Plant Pathology (AREA)
  • Biophysics (AREA)
  • Physics & Mathematics (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Crystallography & Structural Chemistry (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Peptides Or Proteins (AREA)
  • Micro-Organisms Or Cultivation Processes Thereof (AREA)
  • Preparation Of Compounds By Using Micro-Organisms (AREA)
  • Enzymes And Modification Thereof (AREA)
  • Medicines That Contain Protein Lipid Enzymes And Other Medicines (AREA)

Abstract

The present disclosure generally relates to highly pure plasmid compositions having low, or undetectable, levels of colanic acid and other contaminants. The compositions described herein have a range of uses, including diverse applications in the field of bioterrorism, environmental science, food science, forensics, molecular biology, and health and medicine.

Description

    CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
  • The present invention claims the benefit of U.S. Provisional Application Ser. No. 61/125,916, filed on Apr. 30, 2008; and Ser. No. 61/125,923, filed on Apr. 30, 2008, each of which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety.
  • FIELD OF THE INVENTION
  • The present invention generally relates to highly pure plasmid compositions having low, or undetectable, levels of colanic acid and other contaminants. The compositions described herein have a range of uses, including diverse applications in the field of bioterrorism, environmental science, food science, forensics, molecular biology, and health and medicine.
  • BACKGROUND
  • A key step for any application in which nucleic acid is introduced into an organism is the need to produce highly purified, often pharmaceutical grade, nucleic acid. Such purified nucleic acid must meet drug quality standards of safety, potency and efficacy. In addition, it is desirable to have a scaleable process that can be used to produce multi-gram quantities of DNA. Thus, it is desirable to have a process for producing highly pure nucleic acid that does not require toxic chemicals, mutagens, organic solvents, or other reagents that would compromise the safety or efficacy of the resulting nucleic acid, or make scale-up difficult or impractical. It is also desirable to prepare nucleic acids free from contaminating endotoxins, which if administered to a patient could elicit a toxic response. Removal of contaminating endotoxins is particularly important, for example, where plasmid DNA is purified from gram negative (−) bacterial sources that have high levels of endotoxins and colanic acid as an integral component of the outer cell membrane.
  • Plasmids are self-replicating genetic elements that reside and multiply in host bacteria. Basically, all molecular genetic methods involving the manipulation of specific DNA fragments utilize plasmid DNA to produce large amounts of the specific DNA fragment (or protein/RNA derived from said fragment).
  • The choice of bacterial hosts, or sources of the plasmids, generally reflects a historical perspective. Stanley Cohen and Herb Bayer chose Escherichia coli (E. coli) strain K-12 for their groundbreaking molecular genetic experiments in the early 1970s because it was easy to grow and amenable to metabolic studies. These same properties also made E. coli K-12 the primary microorganism for bacterial geneticists to study. Molecular geneticists now use this same strain of E. coli for routine procedures because it turned out to be an extremely good host for a variety of molecular genetic applications. Moreover, during the past 25 years, E. coli K-12 has proved to be an innocuous biological host for the propagation of recombinant DNA molecules. The attenuated E. coli K-12 strain does not thrive outside of the laboratory environment and it is unable to compete against the more genetically robust E. coli serotypes normally found in the human intestine.
  • Among other techniques, currently available methods for separation and purification of plasmid DNA utilize ion exchange chromatography (Duarte et al., Journal of Chromatography A, 606 (1998), 31-45) and size exclusion chromatography (Prazeres, D. M., Biotechnology Techniques Vol. 1, No. 6, June 1997, p 417-420), coupled with the use of additives such as polyethylene glycol (PEG), detergents, and other components such as hexamine cobalt, spermidine, and polyvinylpyrollidone (PVP). Additional methods of separating DNA from contaminants rely on size-exclusion chromatography, which involves separation of the nucleic acid from endotoxins and other contaminants based on the small difference in size. These methods are generally acceptable, but may be unable to provide an efficient and cost effective separation of nucleic acids (e.g., DNA, including supercoiled and/or nicked (or relaxed)) at the desired level of purity.
  • Also, plasmid DNA preparations, which are produced from bacterial preparations and often contain a mixture of relaxed and supercoiled plasmid DNA, frequently require endotoxin removal, as required by the FDA, as endotoxins produced by many bacterial hosts are known to cause inflammatory reactions, such as fever or sepsis, or in some cases death, in the host receiving the plasmid DNA. These endotoxins are generally lipopolysaccharides, or fragments thereof, that are components of the outer membrane of gram negative (−) bacteria, and are present in the DNA preparation of the host cells and host cell membranes or macromolecules. Hence, removal of endotoxins can be a key step in the purification of plasmid DNA for therapeutic or prophylactic use. Endotoxin removal from plasmid DNA solutions primarily uses the negatively charged structure of the endotoxins. Plasmid DNA, however, also is negatively charged and thus separation is frequently achieved with anion exchange resins which bind both these molecules and, under certain conditions, preferentially elute plasmid DNA while binding the endotoxins. Such a separation results in only partial removal as significant amounts of endotoxins elute with the plasmid DNA and/or a very poor recovery of plasmid DNA is achieved.
  • Small- and large-scale isolation and purification of plasmid DNA from small or large volume microbial fermentations thus requires the development of an improved plasmid preparation process. It is also desirable for plasmid-based research and therapy, that the nucleic acids can be separated and purified keeping the same structure in a reproducible manner, and in order to avoid the adverse effect of impurities on mammalian body, the nucleic acids are required to have been separated and purified up to high purity.
  • Plasmid DNA used for gene therapy is typically isolated from E. coli K-12. Endotoxins, also known as lipopolysaccharides (LPS), are known to be prominent cell membrane components of gram-negative bacteria such as E. coli. In fact, some reports suggest that the lipid portion of the outer membrane of E. coli is completely composed of endotoxin molecules. (Qiagen Plasmid Purification Handbook, July 1999).
  • LPS contains a hydrophobic lipid A moiety, a complex array of sugar residues and negatively charged phosphate groups. The lipid A moiety of LPS has demonstrated endotoxin activity and elicits a strong, potentially life-threatening inflammatory response in mammals. This inflammatory response is characterized by fever, decreased blood pressure, local inflammation, and septic shock. Lipid A induces this response by binding to serum lipopolysaccharide-binding protein (LBP) and triggering signaling through the CD14 receptor expressed on monocytes, endothelial cells, and polymorphonuclear leukocytes (Ingalls, R. R. et al. 1998. J. Immunol. 161:5413-5420). Endotoxin is extremely lethal when injected into mice, causing death within an hour of injection. Endotoxin is also known to drastically reduce transfection efficiencies in cells (Weber, M., et al. 1995. Biotechniques 19:930-940). Thus, the importance of using endotoxin-free plasmid DNA for gene therapy applications has long been emphasized.
  • A number of scientists have worked to remove LPS and other endotoxins from DNA samples in an effort to reduce the toxicity of DNA samples used in gene therapy. However, recent evidence has indicated that DNA samples with negligible amounts of LPS are still toxic when administered in significant quantities. Thus, additional toxic components of DNA samples must be identified and removed to ensure the safety of DNA preparations used clinically.
  • The chemical structure and properties of endotoxin molecules and their tendency to form micellar structures initially led to the copurification of LPS and plasmid DNA. For example, DNA is often copurified with LPS in CsCl ultracentrifugation procedures because the LPS and the plasmid DNA have a similar density in CsCl. In addition, micellar LPS separates on size exclusion resins with large DNA molecules. Likewise, the negative charges present on LPS molecules interacts with anion-exchange resins in a manner that leads to their copurification with DNA on anion-exchange resins.
  • Cell wall polysaccharides have been reported to contaminate DNA isolated from a variety of sources including bacteria, yeast, plants, blue-green algae, protozoa, fungi, insects, and mammals (Edelman, M. 1975. Anal. Biochem. 65:293-297; Do, N. and Adams, R. P. 1991. Biotechniques 10:162-166; Chan, J. W. and Goodwin, P. H. 1995. Biotechniques 18:419-422).
  • Plant polysaccharides that contaminate plant genomic DNA are reported to inhibit both restriction endonuclease treatments and the polymerase chain reaction (Robbins, M. et al. 1995. Benchmarks 18: 419-422). Furthermore, polysaccharides purified from the slime Physarum polycephalum have been reported to inhibit DNA polymerase activity (Shioda, M. and K. Murakami-Murofushi. 1987. Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun. 146:61-66) and the acid polysaccharides from sea urchin embryos are known to inhibit RNA polymerase activity (Aoki, Y. and H. Koshihara. 1972. Biochim. Biophys. Acta 272:33-43).
  • There are several methods for purifying plasmid DNA described in the literature, but these methods generally only remove a portion of the polysaccharides, if at all. For example, the Lipid A purification methods are based on the hydrophobic properties of Lipid A. Thus, these methods remove Lipid A and the polysaccharides that are covalently linked to Lipid A. However, since only a small fraction of the capsular polysaccharides of E. coli are covalently linked to Lipid A only a few of them are removed during the standard preparation and purification procedures of plasmid DNA (Jann, B. and K. Jann. 1990. Curr. Top. Microbiol. Immunol. 150:19-42; Wicken, A. J. 1985. In: Bacterial Adhesion, D. M. Pletcher (ed.), Plenum Press: New York, pp. 45-70). Some of the E. coli capsular polysaccharides have phosphatidic acid as a lipid moiety; however, the phosphatidic acid is typically hydrolyzed during the standard plasmid isolation procedures. Thus, these polysaccharides are not removed from DNA by the currently used methods that deplete endotoxin based on hydrophobicity (i.e., the presence of Lipid A binding).
  • Several methods have been developed to reduce levels of endotoxin-positive LPS in DNA isolated from E. coli (Neudecker, F. and S. Grimm. 2000. Biotechniques 28:107-110), including several commercially available kits (Qiagen, Inc., Valencia, Calif.; Sigma Chemical Co., Inc., St. Louis, Mo.). DNA purified using the Qiagen kit is generally considered to be the “gold standard” of clean plasmid DNA. Not only is the Qiagen kit designed to remove LPS, but it also includes RNase to digest the RNA in plasmid DNA preparations. In fact, most of the DNA purification methods include an RNase digestion step. However, one is limited to the amount of RNase that can be added to the plasmid DNA, since high quantities of RNase will begin to digest DNA.
  • It is difficult to separate polysaccharides from DNA using current standard purification procedures. Both DNA and polysaccharides are precipitated by organic solvents such as ethanol and polyethylene glycol (PEG). Since polysaccharides are anionic, the polysaccharides co-purify with DNA using anion exchange resins. Furthermore, the high molecular weight polysaccharides and plasmid DNA have a similar density in CsCl.
  • Affinity chromatography has been proposed for removal of polysaccharide contaminants from DNA. For example, an early paper reported purification of DNA from a variety of sources, including plants, insects, fungi, and algae using affinity chromatography where deproteinized DNA fractions are passed through a column of concanavalin A linked to Sepharose (Edelman, M. 1975. Anal. Biochem. 65:293-29). Unfortunately, E. coli polysaccharides generally do not contain the sugars that bind to concanavalin A. Similarly, lectin affinity chromatography has been reported to be useful for removing polysaccharide contaminants from DNA isolated from fungi and plants (Do, N. and R. P. Adams. 1991. Biotechniques 10:162-166); but the sugars recognized by lectin are not present in most polysaccharides from organisms such as E. coli.
  • A salt wash of gram-negative bacterial pellets has also been proposed as a method of purifying bacterial genomic DNA (Cahn, J. W. and P. H. Goodwin. 1995. Biotechniques 18:519-422). Salt washing was suggested as a way to improve purification of DNA because of the interference the polysaccharides present in DNA caused with restriction enzyme digestion. None of these methods, however, successfully removed all polysaccharides found in plasmid DNA.
  • WO 95/20594 and U.S. Pat. No. 5,969,129 describe a method for batch purification of genomic DNA, from corn and other plants. This purification process used polymer gels containing boronate groups to isolate DNA from DNA/polysaccharide mixtures.
  • Although, the entire emphasis of clinicians in preparing “clean” DNA for clinical use has centered on the removal of LPS, recent reports indicate that “LPS-free” DNA still exhibits toxicity in high dosages. For example, scientists have observed toxicity leading to the death of mice following intravenous injection of DNA-liposome complexes containing 50-300 mg of DNA and reduced quantities of LPS, whereas the injection of equal concentrations of liposomes has no toxic effect. It has also been observed that gene expression is reduced after transfection using DNA with reduced quantities of LPS. Recent reports further suggest that inflammation and significant immune responses are produced after the intramuscular injection of supposedly pure DNA (Fields, P. A. et al. 2000. Molec. Therap. 1:225-235). Therefore, even DNA that is thought to be pure, of clinical grade, and with low levels of LPS, produces toxic responses in animals.
  • SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • Among the various aspects of the present invention is the provision of highly pure plasmid compositions. The plasmid DNA compositions described herein have very low, or undetectable, levels of colanic acid and other contaminants.
  • Briefly, therefore, the present invention is directed to gram negative bacterial plasmid composition comprising gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA and less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. In one embodiment, for example, the composition comprises less than about 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. In another embodiment, the composition comprises no detectable colanic acid. In these and other embodiments, the composition may also comprise less than 0.1 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative plasmid DNA, and/or less than 0.1 mg of fucose per gm of gram negative plasmid DNA. In one embodiment, for example, the composition further comprises less than 0.05 mg uronic acid per mg of gram negative plasmid DNA. In another embodiment, the composition comprises less than 0.05 mg fucose per mg of gram negative plasmid DNA. In other embodiments, the composition comprises no detectable level of uronic acid and/or fucose.
  • Another aspect of the invention is directed to a gram negative bacterial plasmid composition comprising gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.1 mg uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • Another aspect of the invention is directed to a gram negative bacterial plasmid composition comprising gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, less than about 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.05 mg fucose acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. In one embodiment, the composition comprises no detectable colanic acid, fucose, uronic acid chromosomal or genomic DNA, RNA, protein, and/or endotoxin contaminants.
  • Other aspects and features will be in part apparent and in part pointed out hereinafter.
  • The foregoing has outlined rather broadly several aspects of the present invention in order that the detailed description of the invention that follows may be better understood. Additional features and advantages of the invention will be described hereinafter which form the subject of the claims of the invention. It should be appreciated by those skilled in the art that the conception and the specific embodiment disclosed might be readily utilized as a basis for modifying or redesigning the composition and method for carrying out the same purposes as the invention. It should be realized by those skilled in the art that such modified or redesigned compositions and methods do not depart from the spirit and scope of the invention as set forth in the appended claims
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
  • FIGS. 1A, 1B, 1C, and 1D shows the nucleotide and amino acid sequence of a colanic acid-degrading enzyme according to one embodiment.
  • FIG. 2 shows a gel where several different DNA plasmid samples were tested using this gel electrophoretic method for polysaccharide visualization and quantification.
  • FIGS. 3-8 show the polypeptide sequences of SEQ ID NOS: 1-6.
  • FIGS. 9-10 show the polynucleotide sequences of SEQ ID NO: 7 and SEQ ID NO: 8.
  • FIG. 11 shows the polypeptide sequences of SEQ ID NOS: 9-17.
  • FIGS. 12-14 show tables of results from post-iv injections of 120 mice with high doses of DNA-BIV liposomal complexes, purified according to the processes described herein.
  • ABBREVIATIONS AND DEFINITIONS
  • Unless otherwise defined, all terms of art, notations and other scientific terms or terminology used herein are intended to have the meanings commonly understood by those of skill in the art to which this invention pertains. In some cases, terms with commonly understood meanings are defined herein for clarity and/or for ready reference, and the inclusion of such definitions herein should not necessarily be construed to represent a substantial difference over what is generally understood in the art. Many of the techniques and procedures described or referenced herein are well understood and commonly employed using conventional methodology by those skilled in the art, such as, for example, the widely utilized molecular cloning methodologies described in Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual 2nd. edition (1989) Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y. As appropriate, procedures involving the use of commercially available kits and reagents are generally carried out in accordance with manufacturer defined protocols and/or parameters unless otherwise noted.
  • The term “analog” refers to a molecule which is structurally similar or shares similar or corresponding attributes with another molecule (e.g. a CAE-related protein). For example an analog of a CAE protein can be specifically bound by an antibody or T cell that specifically binds to CAE.
  • The term “antibody” is used in the broadest sense. Therefore an “antibody” can be naturally occurring or man-made such as monoclonal antibodies produced by conventional hybridoma technology. Anti-CAE antibodies comprise monoclonal and polyclonal antibodies as well as fragments containing the antigen-binding domain and/or one or more complementarity determining regions of these antibodies. An “antibody fragment” is defined as at least a portion of the variable region of the immunoglobulin molecule that binds to its target, i.e., the antigen-binding region. In one embodiment it specifically covers single anti-CAE antibodies and clones thereof (including agonist, antagonist and neutralizing antibodies) and anti-CAE antibody compositions with polyepitopic specificity.
  • The term “homolog” refers to a molecule which exhibits homology to another molecule, by for example, having sequences of chemical residues that are the same or similar at corresponding positions.
  • The terms “hybridize”, “hybridizing”, “hybridizes” and the like, used in the context of nucleic acids, are meant to refer to conventional hybridization conditions, preferably such as hybridization in 50% formamide/6×SSC/0.1% SDS/100 μg/ml ssDNA, in which temperatures for hybridization are above 37° C. and temperatures for washing in 0.1×SSC/0.1% SDS are above 55° C.
  • The phrases “isolated” or “biologically pure” refer to material which is substantially or essentially free from components which normally accompany the material as it is found in its native state. Thus, isolated peptides in accordance with the invention preferably do not contain materials normally associated with the peptides in their in situ environment. For example, a nucleic acid or polynucleotide is said to be “isolated” when it is substantially separated from contaminant polynucleotides that correspond or are complementary to genes other than the target genes or that encode polypeptides other than the target gene product or fragments thereof. A skilled artisan can readily employ nucleic acid isolation procedures to obtain an isolated polynucleotide. A protein is said to be “isolated,” for example, when physical, mechanical or chemical methods are employed to remove the target proteins or polypeptides from cellular constituents that are normally associated with the protein. A skilled artisan can readily employ standard purification methods to obtain an isolated protein. Alternatively, an isolated protein can be prepared by chemical means.
  • The term “mammal” refers to any organism classified as a mammal, including mice, rats, rabbits, dogs, cats, cows, horses and humans. In one embodiment of the invention, the mammal is a mouse. In another embodiment of the invention, the mammal is a human.
  • The term “monoclonal antibody” refers to a collection of antibodies encoded by the same nucleic acid molecule which are optionally produced by a single hybridoma or other cell line, or by a transgenic mammal such that each monoclonal antibody will typically recognize the same epitope on the antigen. The term “monoclonal” is not limited to any particular method for making the antibody, nor is the term limited to antibodies produced in a particular species, e.g., mouse, rat, etc. The term “polyclonal antibody” refers to a heterogeneous mixture of antibodies that recognize and bind to different epitopes on the same antigen. Polyclonal antibodies may be obtained, for example, from crude serum preparations or may be purified using, for example, antigen affinity chromatography, or Protein A/Protein G affinity chromatography.
  • The terms “percent (%) amino acid sequence identity” with respect to the polypeptide sequences identified herein, is defined as the percentage of amino acid residues in a candidate sequence that are identical with the amino acid residues in a specific polypeptide sequence, after aligning the sequences and introducing gaps, if necessary, to achieve the maximum percent sequence identity, and not considering any conservative substitutions as part of the sequence identity. Alignment for purposes of determining percent amino acid sequence identity can be achieved in various ways that are within the skill in the art, for instance, using publicly available computer software such as BLAST, BLAST-2, ALIGN, ALIGN-2, or Megalign (DNASTAR) software. Persons of ordinary skill in the art can determine appropriate parameters for measuring alignment, including any algorithms needed to achieve maximal alignment over the full length of the sequences being compared. For instance, percent amino acid sequence identity may be determined using the sequence comparison program NCBI-BLAST2 (Altschul et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 25:3389 3402 (1997)). The NCBI-BLAST2 sequence comparison program may be obtained from the National Institute of Health, Bethesda, Md. NCBI-BLAST2 uses several search parameters, wherein all of those search parameters are set to default values including, for example, unmask=yes, strand=all, expected occurrences=10, minimum low complexity length=15/5, multi-pass e-value=0.01, constant for multi-pass=25, dropoff for final gapped alignment=25 and scoring matrix=BLOSUM62.
  • The terms “percent (%) nucleic acid sequence identity” with respect to polypeptide-encoding nucleic acid sequences identified herein is defined as the percentage of nucleotides in a candidate sequence that are identical with the nucleotides in the polypeptide nucleic acid sequence of interest, after aligning the sequences and introducing gaps, if necessary, to achieve the maximum percent sequence identity. Alignment for purposes of determining percent nucleic acid sequence identity can be achieved in various ways that are within the skill in the art, for instance, using publicly available computer software such as BLAST, BLAST-2, ALIGN, ALIGN-2, or Megalign (DNASTAR) software. Persons of ordinary skill in the art can determine appropriate parameters for measuring alignment, including any algorithms needed to achieve maximal alignment over the full length of the sequences being compared. For instance, percent nucleic acid sequence identity may also be determined using the sequence comparison program NCBI-BLAST2 (Altschul et al., Nucleic Acids Res. 25:3389 3402 (1997)). The NCBI-BLAST2 sequence comparison program may be obtained from the National Institute of Health, Bethesda, Md. NCBI-BLAST2 uses several search parameters, wherein all of those search parameters are set to default values including, for example, unmask=yes, strand=all, expected occurrences=10, minimum low complexity length=15/5, multi-pass e-value=0.01, constant for multi-pass=25, dropoff for final gapped alignment=25 and scoring matrix=BLOSUM62.
  • The term “polynucleotide” means a polymeric form of nucleotides of at least 10 bases or base pairs in length, either ribonucleotides or deoxynucleotides or a modified form of either type of nucleotide, and is meant to include single and double stranded forms of DNA and/or RNA. In the art, this term if often used interchangeably with “oligonucleotide.” A polynucleotide can comprise a nucleotide sequence disclosed herein wherein thymidine (T) can also be uracil (U); this definition pertains to the differences between the chemical structures of DNA and RNA, in particular the observation that one of the four major bases in RNA is uracil (U) instead of thymidine (T).
  • The term “polypeptide” means a polymer of at least about 4, 5, 6, 7, or 8 amino acids. Throughout the specification, standard three letter or single letter designations for amino acids are used. In the art, this term is often used interchangeably with “peptide” or “protein”.
  • A “recombinant” polynucleotide (e.g., DNA or RNA molecule) or “recombinant” polypeptide is a polynucleotide or polypeptide that has been subjected to molecular manipulation in vitro.
  • “Stringency” of hybridization reactions is readily determinable by one of ordinary skill in the art, and generally is an empirical calculation dependent upon probe length, washing temperature, and salt concentration. In general, longer probes require higher temperatures for proper annealing, while shorter probes need lower temperatures. Hybridization generally depends on the ability of denatured nucleic acid sequences to reanneal when complementary strands are present in an environment below their melting temperature. The higher the degree of desired homology between the probe and hybridizable sequence, the higher the relative temperature that can be used. As a result, it follows that higher relative temperatures would tend to make the reaction conditions more stringent, while lower temperatures less so. For additional details and explanation of stringency of hybridization reactions, see Ausubel et al., Current Protocols in Molecular Biology, Wiley Interscience Publishers, (1995).
  • “Stringent conditions” or “high stringency conditions”, as defined herein, are identified by, but not limited to, those that: (1) employ low ionic strength and high temperature for washing, for example 0.015 M sodium chloride/0.0015 M sodium citrate/0.1% sodium dodecyl sulfate at 50° C.; (2) employ during hybridization a denaturing agent, such as formamide, for example, 50% (v/v) formamide with 0.1% bovine serum albumin/0.1% Ficoll/0.1% polyvinylpyrrolidone/50 mM sodium phosphate buffer at pH 6.5 with 750 mM sodium chloride, 75 mM sodium citrate at 42° C.; or (3) employ 50% formamide, 5×SSC (0.75 M NaCl, 0.075 M sodium citrate), 50 mM sodium phosphate (pH 6.8), 0.1% sodium pyrophosphate, 5×Denhardt's solution, sonicated salmon sperm DNA (50 μg/ml), 0.1% SDS, and 10% dextran sulfate at 42° C., with washes at 42° C. in 0.2×SSC (sodium chloride/sodium citrate) and 50% formamide at 55° C., followed by a high-stringency wash consisting of 0.1×SSC containing EDTA at 55° C. “Moderately stringent conditions” are described by, but not limited to, those in Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, New York: Cold Spring Harbor Press, 1989, and include the use of washing solution and hybridization conditions (e.g., temperature, ionic strength and % SDS) less stringent than those described above. An example of moderately stringent conditions is overnight incubation at 37° C. in a solution comprising: 20% formamide, 5×SSC (150 mM NaCl, 15 mM trisodium citrate), 50 mM sodium phosphate (pH 7.6), 5×Denhardt's solution, 10% dextran sulfate, and 20 mg/mL denatured sheared salmon sperm DNA, followed by washing the filters in 1×SSC at about 37-50° C. The skilled artisan will recognize how to adjust the temperature, ionic strength, etc. as necessary to accommodate factors such as probe length and the like.
  • The term “variant” refers to a molecule that exhibits a variation from a described type or norm, such as a protein that has one or more different amino acid residues in the corresponding position(s) of a specifically described protein (e.g. the CAE-protein shown in FIG. 1 or FIG. 2). An analog is an example of a variant protein. Splice isoforms and single nucleotides polymorphisms (SNPs) are further examples of variants.
  • The polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading (CAE) activity of the invention include those specifically identified herein, as well as allelic variants, conservative substitution variants, analogs and homologs that can be isolated/generated and characterized without undue experimentation following the methods outlined herein or readily available in the art. Fusion proteins that combine parts of different CAE proteins or fragments thereof, as well as fusion proteins of a CAE protein and a heterologous polypeptide are also included. Such CAE proteins are collectively referred to as the CAE-related proteins, the proteins of the invention, or CAE. The term “CAE-related protein” refers to a polypeptide fragment or a CAE protein sequence of at least 10, 15, 25, 50, 100, 150, 200, 250, 300, 350, 400, 450, 500, 550, 600, 650, 700, or more than 700 amino acids.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION
  • The present disclosure generally relates to “superclean” plasmid DNA preparations, processes for their preparation, and enzymes useful in these processes. Polysaccharides, particularly colanic acid, have been found to contaminate purportedly “clean” preparations of plasmid DNA that induce toxic effects in humans and mammals when used, e.g., for gene therapy. The components that are believed to induce these toxic effects have not been identified in the literature. Other applications that can be adversely affected by the presence of polysaccharide contaminants in DNA preparations include clinical diagnostics, forensics, and other biotechnology methodologies, such as chips and microarrays including nucleic acids thereon, and in molecular studies (e.g., building chromosomes, analyses of transcriptional start sites, X-ray crystallography, and DNA structural studies, among others). An urgent need exists to remove such contaminant molecules from DNA preparations.
  • Among other things, therefore, the present invention provides isolated, purified, and recombinant polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading activity, and processes involving their use. The invention also provides isolated polynucleotides encoding such polypeptides. The polypeptides described herein have a range of uses, and enable processes for digesting colanic acid in a biological material, and processes for removing endotoxins from compositions including biological macromolecules. Significantly, the polypeptides also enable the preparation of plasmid DNA preparations, preferably gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, comprising less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of plasmid DNA, and more preferably less than about 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of plasmid DNA. In certain preferred embodiments, no detectable colanic acid can be found in the plasmid compositions prepared by the processes described herein. The plasmid compositions may also have very low levels, or undetectable levels, of other polysaccharide contaminants, such as uronic acid and fucose.
  • The disclosure relates, in part, to the discovery that the polypeptide compounds of the invention are capable of digesting colanic acid (also known as M-antigen), an exopolysaccharide produced by a range of enterobacteria, including the majority of Escherichia coli strains. Depending on the bacteria, for example, colanic acid may be comprised of fucose, glucose, galactose, and glucuronic acid, together with acetate and pyruvate, in various ratios (see, e.g., Sutherland, Biochem. J. 115, 935-945 (1969). As noted above, endotoxins and polysaccharides, and in particular colanic acid, have been found to contaminate preparations of nucleic acids, e.g., for therapeutic uses, and it is difficult to separate endotoxins and polysaccharides such as colanic acid from nucleic acids using current standard purification procedures.
  • Accordingly, the polypeptides described herein may be generally used in the digestion of colanic acid in a material. In general, any material including colanic acid may be treated with the polypeptides described herein; typically, the material is a biological material. The biological material may be derived from, or a part of, microbes, tissues from humans and animals, and environmental samples such as archaeological remains, compost or other decomposing matter, peat bogs, plant matter, sediment, sludge, soil, and wastewater, e.g., that are terrestrial or subterranean in origin. In certain embodiments, the biological material is a biological slime. In accordance with these embodiments, for example, the colanic acid may be present in the cellular membrane of the intact bacteria. In other embodiments, the biological material may be a crude bacterial lysate, a partially purified bacterial lysate, or an aqueous solution comprising extracted bacterial nucleic acid. In another embodiment, the biological material may be a biofilm. In another embodiment, the biological material may be pulp or pulp derivative (e.g., such as those mechanically or chemically prepared from wood or fiber sources). As noted above, in accordance with other aspects of the invention, the polypeptides described herein may be used in processes for the removal of endotoxins from aqueous compositions comprising bacterial macromolecues (e.g., plasmid DNA). In certain preferred aspects, the polypeptides are used in processes for the purification of plasmid DNA, typically gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • Plasmid DNA Compositions
  • One key aspect of the present disclosure is highly purified plasmid compositions and pharmaceutical grade plasmid DNA compositions. These compositions, for example, may generally be produced by the colanic acid enzymatic digestion processes described herein, which may or may not be combined with conventional purification techniques, such as one or more combinations of chromatography and filtration steps. Thus, the invention encompasses, or in addition comprises, a process of producing and isolating highly purified plasmid compositions that are essentially free of polysaccharides including colanic acid, fucose, and uronic acid, and other contaminants, and thus is pharmaceutical grade DNA. In addition to having very low, and preferably undetectable, levels of colanic acid and other polysaccharides, the plasmid DNA produced and isolated by the processes described herein includes very low levels of endotoxin generally, including one or more of contaminating chromosomal DNA, RNA, protein, and endotoxins, and preferably contains mostly closed circular form plasmid DNA. The plasmid DNA produced according to the processes described herein is of sufficient purity for use research and plasmid-based therapy.
  • The plasmid compositions of the present invention may include any types of vectors with any sizes. For instance, the size range of plasmid DNA that may be purified by the processes described herein may be from approximately 0.3 kbp (mini-circle or minimal transcription unit) to approximately 50 kbp, typically 3 kbp to 20 kbp, or larger (e.g., 5 to 100 kbp, or larger, such as phage-derived shuttle vectors, HACs, YACs, MACS, and episomes derived from EBV or other non-integrating viruses). In certain embodiments, the DNA includes a vector backbone of approximately 0.3 kbp, 0.5 kbp, 0.75 kbp, 1 kbp, 3 kbp, 5 kbp, 10 kbp, 15 kbp, or 20 kbp, a therapeutic gene, and associated regulatory sequences. This may also apply to single stranded DNA (i.e., 0.3 kb to 50 kb, etc., such as those derived from M13). Thus, for example, a vector backbone may be capable of carrying inserts of approximately 1-50 kbp, or larger (e.g., 3-20 kbp), or approximately 1-50 kb, or larger (e.g., 3-20 kb). The insert will generally depend on application in which the plasmid composition is to be used. For gene therapy or vaccine-based applications, for example, the insert may include DNA from any organism, but will typically be of mammalian origin, and may include, in addition to a gene encoding a therapeutic protein, regulatory sequences such as promoters, poly adenylation sequences, enhancers, locus control regions, etc. The gene encoding a therapeutic protein may be of genomic origin, and therefore contain exons and introns as reflected in its genomic organization, or it may be derived from complementary DNA. Such vectors may include for example vector backbone replicatable with high copy number replication, having a polylinker for insertion of a therapeutic gene, a gene encoding a selectable marker, e.g., the tetracycline or kanamycin resistance gene, and is physically small and stable. The vector backbone of the plasmid advantageously permits inserts of fragments of mammalian, other eukaryotic, prokaryotic or viral DNA, and the resulting plasmid may be purified as described herein and used in vivo or ex vivo plasmid-based therapy, or other use. The plasmid compositions can also comprise other pharmaceutically acceptable components, buffers, stabilizers, or compounds for improving gene transfer and particularly plasmid DNA transfer into a cell or organism.
  • In general, “superclean” plasmid DNA compositions are provided herein. Typically, the plasmid DNA composition is a gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition. As described herein, an efficient enzymatically-based process has been developed that allows for the removal of colanic acid contamination from a variety of bacterial materials, such as plasmid DNA samples. In various embodiments, the first step in the process may involve detection of colanic acid as a source of contamination (e.g., plasmid DNA contamination). This may be directly or indirectly accomplished, for example, by assaying for the presence of fucose in the sample (described below), since fucose is known to make up about 22% of colanic acid.
  • In one embodiment, the plasmid DNA composition is a gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition comprising gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA and less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. More preferably in this embodiment, the composition comprises less than about 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. In one particularly preferred embodiment, the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition comprises no detectable colanic acid.
  • As noted elsewhere herein, the plasmid DNA compositions of the invention also preferably include low or undetectable levels or other polysaccharide contaminants, such as uronic acid or fucose. Thus, in one embodiment, the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition comprises less than 0.1 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. More preferably in this embodiment, the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition comprises less than 0.05 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. Preferably, no detectable uronic acid can be found in the plasmid DNA composition.
  • In these and other embodiments, the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition preferably comprises less than 0.1 mg of fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. More preferably in this embodiment, the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition comprises less than 0.05 mg of fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. Preferably, no detectable fucose can be found in the plasmid DNA composition.
  • In combination, the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition may comprise less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.1 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. For instance, the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition may comprise 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.05 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. Preferably, no detectable colanic acid and no detectable uronic acid is present in the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition.
  • By way of another combination, the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition may comprise less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.1 mg of fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. For instance, the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition may comprise 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.05 mg of fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. Preferably, no detectable colanic acid and no detectable fucose is present in the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition.
  • In yet another combination, the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition may comprise less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, less than about 0.1 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.1 mg of fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. For instance, the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition may comprise 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, less than about 0.05 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than 0.05 mg of fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. Preferably, no detectable colanic acid, no detectable uronic acid, and no detectable fucose is present in the gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition.
  • In addition to the reduced levels of colanic acid, uronic acid, and/or fucose discussed above, the plasmid compositions described herein may also include, for example, less than 0.01 mg chromosomal or genomic DNA, RNA, protein, and/or endotoxin contaminants per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA; more preferably, the composition includes less than 0.001 mg, less than 0.0001 mg, or less than 0.00001 mg chromosomal or genomic DNA, RNA, protein, and/or endotoxin contaminants per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. In one embodiment, for example, the plasmid compositions may comprise less than 0.1 mg (more preferably, less than 0.05 mg; still more preferably, no detectable amount) of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than 0.01 mg (more preferably, less than 0.001 mg; still more preferably, 0.0001 mg) host cell chromosomal DNA or genomic DNA contaminants per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA. The plasmid composition may also comprise less than 0.1 mg (more preferably, less than 0.05 mg; still more preferably, no detectable amount) of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA composition, and less than 0.01 mg (more preferably, less than 0.001 mg; still more preferably, 0.0001 mg) host cell protein contaminants per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
  • Assays for detecting levels of colanic acid, uronic acid, fucose, and other polysaccharides are generally known in the art (or are described herein); methods of detecting chromosomal or genomic DNA, RNA, protein, and/or endotoxin that may be present in the plasmid compositions are also generally known in the art.
  • In one embodiment, for example, the plasmid composition of the present invention may include, less than 0.1 mg, preferably less than 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative plasmid DNA (e.g., 0.04, 0.03, 0.02, or 0.01 mg), and more preferably no detectable colanic acid, as measured by a bicinchoninic acid (BCA) assay. Suitable BCA assays are described, for example, in Meeuwsen et al., Biosci. Bioeng. 89, 107-109 (2000); and Verhoef et al., Carbohyd. Res. 340(11), 1780-1788 (2005). An exemplary BCA assay for measuring colanic acid levels is found in Example 16.
  • In another embodiment, the plasmid composition may include colanic acid at the levels recited in the previous paragraph, and further comprise less than about 0.1 mg, preferably less than about 0.05 mg of uronic acid per mg of gram negative plasmid DNA (e.g., 0.04, 0.03, 0.02, or 0.01 mg), and more preferably no detectable uronic acid, as measured by a uronic acid assay. In general, the uronic acid content of a plasmid DNA sample is measured using standard curves generated with heparin sulfate or glucuronic acid as standards. For instance, heparin sulfate resembles the polysaccharide contaminants from E. coli, because uronic acid comprises about 25% of the total weight of heparin sulfate. Heparin sulfate consists of 50% sugars by weight. Half of these sugars are glucosamine and the other half of the sugars are iduronic acid and glucuronic acid; the rest of the heparin sulfate is contributed by modifications of the sugars including sulfates and acetylamides. Alternatively, glucuronic acid can be used to create a standard curve for the direct measurement of uronic acid. The standard solution is placed is a glass test tube with a borate/sulfuric acid solution (e.g., 0.025 M sodium tetraborate 10-hydrate dissolved in sulfuric acid having a specific gravity of 1.84) and mixed. A solution of carbazole in absolute ethanol is added to the mixture and the entire mixture is vortexed and immersed in boiling water. The tubes are allowed to cool and the absorbance of the solution at 530 nm is read in a spectrophotometer. The absorbance values obtained for the standards are plotted against the concentration of the standards. The uronic acid content of plasmid DNA samples can be extrapolated from its absorbance value at 530 nm when the DNA sample has undergone the same reaction. The polysaccharide content of the plasmid DNA sample can then be extrapolated by multiplying the amount of uronic acid by a number ranging from 3.3 to 9.1 (depending on the prevalence of colanic acid, ECA and the O- and K-antigens in the sample). An exemplary uronic acid assay for measuring uronic acid levels is found in Example 16.
  • In another embodiment, the plasmid composition may include colanic acid and/or uronic acid at the levels recited in the previous paragraphs, and further comprise less than about 0.1 mg, preferably less than about 0.05 mg of fucose per mg of gram negative plasmid DNA (e.g., 0.04, 0.03, 0.02, or 0.01 mg), and more preferably no detectable fucose, as measured by a fucose assay. The basic procedures for assay of fucose content in samples can be found in Morris, Anal. Biochem. 121, 129-134 (1982). Detailed descriptions of the solution preparation and storage conditions for solutions and samples for this assay have also been published (Passonneau, J. V. and O. H. Lowry. 1974. In: Methods of Enzymatic Analysis, U. H. Bergmeyer (ed.), 2nd edition, Academic Press: New York, volume 4, pp. 2059-2072). Using this method, the fucose levels of plasmid DNA samples were determined and the concentration of colanic acid levels calculated. As described elsewhere herein, colanic acid was found to be the primary contaminant in plasmid DNA from a variety of sources, even GMP grade plasmid DNA. An exemplary fucose assay for measuring fucose levels is found in Example 16.
  • In these and other embodiments, the gram negative plasmid composition preferably comprises no visually detectable polysaccharides when combined with a polysaccharide-selective labeling agent. In general, polysaccharide visualization assays involve labeling polysaccharides with a fluorescent agent and detecting their presence, e.g., on a electrophoretic medium. Preferably, no polysaccharides are detectable using such agents in combination with the plasmid compositions described herein. In one embodiment, the polysaccharide-selective labeling agent is (4,6-dichlorotriazinyl)aminofluorescein (DTAF). Other polysaccharide-selective labeling agents are known or will be evident to those skilled in the art. An exemplary assay utilizing a polysaccharide-selective labeling agent is found in Example 16.
  • In addition, viscosity of plasmid DNA compositions are reduced as a result of the colanic acid degradation processes described herein. Accordingly, the presence of colanic acid may be detected by comparing the viscosity of a treated plasmid DNA composition with the viscosity of an untreated plasmid DNA sample. An exemplary assay utilizing viscosity levels of plasmid DNA is described in Example 16.
  • In general, as the levels of colanic acid (and/or the levels of uronic acid, fucose, or other polysaccharide or other contaminant) present in the plasmid composition are reduced, the LD50 (the dose lethal to 50% of the test population) of the plasmid composition is increased. For instance, by reducing the level of colanic acid to less than 0.1 mg per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, in one embodiment the corresponding LD50 of the plasmid composition is increased by at least 25%; more preferably in this embodiment, by at least 50%. By further reductions in the levels of colanic acid (and other polysaccharides), and optionally similar reductions in the levels of other contaminants such as chromosomal or genomic DNA, RNA, protein, and/of endotoxin, the corresponding LD50 of the plasmid composition may be increased by at least 50%, by at least 75%, or by at least 100%. By way of another example, by reducing the level of colanic acid to less than 0.05 mg per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA and the level of chromosomal or genomic DNA, RNA, protein, and/or endotoxin contaminants to less than 0.01 mg per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, the corresponding LD50 of the plasmid composition may be increased by at least 50%; more preferably in this embodiment, at least 100%.
  • In general, the plasmid compositions of the present invention may be utilized in a wide range of applications, including those in fields of bioterrorism (agent detection and analysis), environmental science (e.g., agriculture, horticulture, and forestry), food science, forensics, molecular biology, health and medicine (e.g., gene therapy, diagnostics, recombinant protein expression), and space science, to name a few. The highly pure plasmid compositions described herein may be employed in vivo or ex vivo, for example, in gene therapy and vaccine-based applications (i.e., the plasmid compositions may be administered to mammals, including humans). Additionally or alternatively, the plasmid compositions may be used in conventional diagnostics and forensics techniques, for example, to improve the stability, specificity, reproducibility, and/or sensitivity of such methodologies. This may include, for example, the analysis, detection, or examination of samples from the environment, e.g. from public water supplies, samples from foodstuffs, and from other biological or clinical samples, such as blood, saliva, sputum, semen, buccal smears, urine or fecal waste, cell and tissue biopsies and micro dissections, amniotic fluid, or tissue homogenates of plants, animals, or human patients, and the like. Other examples of uses for the plasmid compositions described herein include genotyping microorganisms, DNA fingerprinting of plants and animals, detecting pathogens and beneficial microorganisms in soils, water, plants and animals, forensic identification of biological samples and environmental samples contaminated with different biological entities, and molecular studies such as, for instance, building chromosomes, analyses of transcriptional information, X-ray crystallography, and DNA structural studies. The plasmid compositions may also be used in conjunction or in combination with solid substrate chip formats that detect, among other things, genes, mutations or mRNA expression levels such as nucleic acid microarrays and molecular detection chips employing, for example, fluorescence, radioactivity, optical interferometry, Raman spectrometry, semi-conductor, or other electronics (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 7,098,286; U.S. Pat. No. 6,924,094; and U.S. Pat. No. 6,824,866 (each of which is hereby incorporated by reference herein)).
  • Processes
  • As described elsewhere herein, the polypeptides of the present invention can be utilized in a wide range of processes, particularly those which involve, require, or otherwise benefit from digestion or degradation of colanic acid, typically in a biological material, such as a bacterial sample, or compositions (such as aqueous compositions) comprising bacterial macromolecules. In general, biological material including undesirable colanic acid may be treated with the polypeptides described herein, including biofilms (i.e., structured communities of microorganisms encapsulated within self-developed polymeric matrices, either adherent to a living or inert surface, or on its own), bacterial lysates, plasmid DNA, and the like.
  • The processes described herein generally involve the digestion of colanic acid in a biological material, or otherwise in a composition comprising a biological material. In general, the processes employ the polypeptides described herein to digest or degrade colanic acid that may be present in the material. One embodiment of the processes described herein involves, for example, the digestion of colanic acid from a biological material. Alternatively, the processes may involve the digestion of colanic acid in an aqueous composition containing bacterial macromolecules. By way of another alternative, the processes may involve treating an aqueous composition containing plasmid DNA with a polypeptide to digest colanic acid.
  • A polypeptide is used to digest colanic acid present in the sample; thus, the polynucleotide has colanic acid-degrading activity, or is otherwise a colanic acid-degrading enzyme. In one particular embodiment, the process involves digesting in a biological material and the process comprises contacting the biological material with a polypeptide capable of digesting colanic acid. The biological material may be, for example, a crude bacterial lysate, a partially purified bacterial lysate, and an aqueous solution containing extracted bacterial nucleic acid (such as gram negative plasmid DNA). Alternatively, the biological material may be a bacterial slime. By way of another alternative, the biological material may be a biofilm comprising gram negative bacteria. In another alternative embodiment, the bacterial material may be present in a pulp (e.g., wood or fiber pulp) composition, solution, or mixture. In another embodiment, the process involves the removal of endotoxin from an aqueous composition containing bacterial macromolecules and the process comprises digesting colanic acid in the aqueous composition and thereafter combining the aqueous composition with a chromatographic material to separate endotoxin from the bacterial macromolecule. In one preferred embodiment, the process involves purification of plasmid DNA, such as gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and the process comprises treating an aqueous composition containing plasmid DNA with a polypeptide to digest colanic acid and separating the plasmid DNA from the treated aqueous composition using, for example, conventional chromatography techniques. The polypeptide may also be employed in a range of industrial processes described below.
  • In a particular aspect, a process for removal of contaminating polysaccharides from plasmid DNA samples has been developed that allows for the removal of polysaccharides, including those other than LPS, from plasmid DNA samples. In addition, RNA and LPS are also removed from the plasmid DNA samples. Therefore, the method of the present invention results in purified plasmid DNA that contains extremely low, and in many cases undetectable, levels of polysaccharides as described below. Unlike previous methods, which were unable to identify the levels of contaminating polysaccharides, the certain steps may be performed to quantify the polysaccharide levels in DNA samples, allowing the investigator to assure the removal of polysaccharides from the DNA sample.
  • In general, any of the polypeptides described herein may be employed. For example, the polypeptide may comprise an amino acid sequence having at least 90% homology to SEQ ID NO: 1, or the polypeptide may comprise an amino acid sequence having at least 90% homology to SEQ ID NO: 2. In one particular embodiment, the polypeptide has the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1. In another particular embodiment, the polypeptide has the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 2.
  • The starting material for certain of the processes described herein is a mass of bacterial material, or an aqueous composition comprising such biological material, such as bacterial cells or other biological matter prepared by, e.g., fermentation or cell culture, isolated from the environment, or derived from tissues or other organisms (e.g., fungi, bacteria, etc.). In one embodiment, the biological material comprises bacterial cells derived from enterobacteria, such as E. coli. In another embodiment, the biological material is a bacterial slime; according to this embodiment, for example, colanic acid is present in the cellular membrane of the bacteria. In a preferred embodiment, the biological material is a gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA material.
  • A variety of cell types can be used as feed for the processes described herein, such as bacteria (e.g., gram (−), gram (+), and Archaea), yeast, and other prokaryotic and eukaryotic cells, including mammalian cells and recombinant cells. Among these and other cell types, bacterial cells, and in particular gram positive (+) and gram negative (−) bacterial cells, such as E. coli, Salmonella, or Bacillus, are preferred, with gram negative (−) bacterial cells being most preferred. In a particular embodiment, the bacteria is a gram negative (−) bacteria; more preferably in this embodiment, the bacteria is E. coli. A wide selection of well-established E. coli host strains are useful according to the processes described herein, and are available from Stratagene (La Jolla, Calif.), Qiagen (Valencia, Calif.), New England BioLabs (Ipswich, Mass.), and Promega (Madison, Wis.), among other commercial sources.
  • Typically, the biological material is a bacterial lysate, or a derivative thereof. Thus, bacterial starting material (e.g., bacterial cells, etc.) must be lysed or disrupted to form the lysate. In general, the bacterial lysis step involves any conventional method for breaking open bacterial cells, thus liberating nucleic acids and other cell components therefrom. The lysis procedure may involve the use of mechanical methods, lysing agents or solutions, or combinations thereof.
  • For biological material derived from fermentation or cell culture, the cells are disrupted by chemical or mechanical techniques as described below, forming a crude lysate. For example, where bacterial cultures are employed, the bacterial cells are lysed to form a crude bacterial lysate. In doing so, the cellular components, including DNA, RNA, proteins, colanic acid, and other polysaccharides, are released from the cells. In certain embodiments, the lysate may undergo pre-treatment steps, such as purification steps to remove cell contaminants and endotoxins, thus forming a partially purified (e.g., bacterial) lysate.
  • Where a lysing agent is employed, the lysing agent is used to break down cell membranes, thus releasing DNA, RNA and proteins from the cells. One preferred lysing agent comprises an alkaline solution. A variety of bases may be employed in conventional alkaline lysis procedures, including, for example, hydroxide salts, such as potassium hydroxide (KOH), lithium hydroxide (LiOH), or sodium hydroxide (NaOH). Typically, the base is sodium hydroxide. Often, detergents are employed in lysing solutions, either alone or in combination with the alkaline solution. In general, and depending on the application, the detergent may be an cationic, anionic, non-ionic, or zwitterionic detergent, or a combination thereof. One exemplary anionic detergent is sodium dodecyl sulfate (SDS). One exemplary zwitterionic or non-ionic detergent is Tween 20.
  • Mechanical methods for lysing bacterial cells, for use either alone or in combination with lysis solutions and agents, include agitation, sonication, centrifugation, freeze/thawing, French cell press, and the like.
  • Alkaline lysis and mechanical techniques for lysing bacterial cells to release and extract proteins and nucleic acids are generally well known, and are described, for example, in Sambrook et al., supra.
  • In some embodiments, it may be desirable to form a cleared lysate preparation, in which the chromosomal DNA, proteins, and membrane portions of the host cells have been at least partially removed, such as by chemical treatment or centrifugation of the lysate, thereby leaving a solution containing plasmid DNA. RNAse can optionally be added at various points in the procedure to create a cleared lysate that is substantially free of RNA. As noted elsewhere herein, initial removal of many cellular and nucleic acid contaminants can improve colanic acid digestion and/or further purification of the plasmid DNA using conventional chromatographic techniques. Methods of creating cleared lysates are well-known in the art. For example, a cleared lysate can be produced by treating the host cells with sodium hydroxide or its equivalent (0.2N) and sodium dodecyl sulfate (SDS) (1%), centrifuging, and discarding the supernatant. This method of creating a cleared lysate is generally described, for example, in Burnboim et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 7, 1513 (1979); and Horowicz et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 9, 2989 (1981).
  • For many uses, e.g., therapeutic uses such as in gene therapy or the formation of vaccines, it may be desirable to further purify the nucleic acid obtained from the bacterial or other lysate, either before or after the sample is contacted with the colanic acid-degrading polypeptide.
  • After forming the bacterial lysate as described above, it is generally preferably to subject the crude lysate to separation techniques to eliminate at least part of the other nucleic acid, protein, and cell contaminants that are present, before attempting to digest colanic acid with the polypeptide. Thus, in one embodiment, for example, the material or composition comprising the biological matter is combined with an ion exchange chromatographic material prior to treatment with the polypeptide. Typically, the chromatographic material is a anion exchange chromatographic resin. In a preferred embodiment, the anion exchange chromatographic resin comprises diethylaminoethyl cellulose (DEAE). In general, conventional DNA, including plasmid DNA, cleaning techniques can be employed.
  • The biological material may also be combined with chromatographic material following treatment with the polypeptide. This generally involves affinity chromatography and/or hydrophobic interaction chromatography. In a particular embodiment, the biological material or aqueous composition is combined with an anion exchange chromatography resin, treated with the polypeptide, combined with an affinity chromatography resin, combined with a hydrophobic interaction chromatography resin, and subjected to filtration, in that order.
  • Once the biological material is lysed or otherwise prepared, the material is treated with the polypeptide described herein. Typically, treatment involves contacting or mixing the polypeptide with the biological material such that the polypeptide will have access to the colanic acid substrate present in the material or composition. Preferably, the biological material and the polypeptide are incubated to allow sufficient interaction between the enzyme and the colanic acid substrate. Typically, the duration of the incubation may be from 1 to 6 hours, 6 to 12 hours, 12 to 24 hours, or longer, depending on the size of the sample to be digested, the amount of polypeptide employed, and environmental factors, such as temperature, atmosphere, etc. The incubation is generally carried out at a temperature of between 0° C. and 100° C., more preferably between 25° C. and 75° C. (e.g., between 30° C. and 50° C.). In some embodiments, it may be desirable to vary the temperature during the incubation process, for example, starting the incubation at a cooler temperature, and then raising the temperature for the remainder of the incubation cycle, or vice versa.
  • As noted above, it will generally be desirable to purify the biological material or aqueous composition containing biological material, either before or after treatment with the polypeptides of the invention. In general, this may involve subjecting the material or composition to one or more chromatography methods or to filtration. In one embodiment, a combination of chromatographic separations are employed. Thus, for example, at various times during the process, the biological material or composition may be combined with a chromatographic material. Suitable chromatographic materials include, for example, ion exchange chromatography resins (such as anion exchange chromatography resins and cation exchange chromatography resins), hydrophobic interaction chromatography resins, and affinity chromatography resins, among a range of others. In one embodiment, the chromatographic material is selected from the group consisting of an anion exchange chromatography resin, a cation exchange chromatography resin, a hydrophobic interaction chromatography resin, and an affinity chromatography resin.
  • As noted above, the biological material or composition may be combined with the chromatographic material(s) prior to, or after, treatment with the polypeptide, or both before and after treatment with the polypeptide, with single or multiple chromatographic separations being employed. For example, the sample can be combined with a chromatography material, treated with the polypeptide as described herein, and subjected to a second (or third, fourth, fifth, etc.) chromatography step. In addition, the sample can be subjected to conventional filtration techniques to further purify or remove contaminants from the sample. The filtration steps may occur relatively early in the process, e.g., prior to treatment with the enzyme, or later in the process, e.g., as final filtration steps prior to storage or use of the end product.
  • In another aspect, therefore, the processes of the invention comprise the use of an polypeptide capable of degrading colanic acid present in a bacterial lysate sample, which is preceded by or followed by at least one additional chromatography technique. The additional chromatography step may exist optionally or typically as one or more of the final purification steps or at least at the end or near the end of the sample or plasmid purification scheme, or prior to the colanic acid digestion step. In combination with the colanic acid degradation step, therefore, is preferably one or more of ion exchange chromatography, affinity chromatography (e.g., boronate affinity chromatography), hydrophobic interaction chromatography, and filtration. Other techniques may include gel permeation or size exclusion chromatography, hydroxyapatite (type I and II) chromatography, and reversed phase chromatography. In general, any available chromatography protocol involving nucleic acid separation can be adapted for use. In addition, any one or more of the steps or techniques can employ high performance chromatography techniques or systems. Thus, the method of the invention comprises an colanic acid digestion step with one or more step of ion exchange chromatography and further may include affinity chromatography, hydrophobic interaction chromatography or gel permeation chromatography, and/or filtration (such as tangential flow filtration (TFF) or size exclusion filtration). The step of ion exchange chromatography, for example, may be both in fluidized bed ion exchange chromatography and axial and/or radial high resolution anion exchange chromatography. In one preferred embodiment, ion exchange chromatography is performed prior to the colanic acid degradation step, in order to remove particles that may hinder the ability of the enzyme to interact with the substrate.
  • Processes of the invention described herein, e.g., for purifying plasmid DNA, are scalable and thus amenable to scale-up to large-scale manufacture.
  • In some embodiments of the invention, colanic acid degradation step may be combined with additional purification steps to result in a high purity product containing plasmid DNA. It may, for example, be combined with at least one of flocculate removal (such as lysate filtration, settling, or centrifugation), ion exchange chromatography (such as cation or anion exchange), and hydrophobic interaction chromatography. In one embodiment, the colanic acid degradation step is preceded by ion exchange chromatography. In these and other embodiments, the colanic acid degradation step is followed by hydrophobic interaction chromatography. In a preferred embodiment, bacterial lysis is followed by ion exchange chromatography, ion exchange chromatography is followed by affinity chromatography (e.g., using boronates or other vicinial- or cis-diol specific compounds), which is followed by hydrophobic interaction chromatography. After or between one or more of these steps, the sample can be subjected to filtration, such as tangential flow filtration. These steps allow for a truly scaleable plasmid manufacturing process, which can produce large quantities of plasmid DNA with high levels of purity. Host cell DNA and RNA, proteins, endotoxins, and colanic acid contaminants are preferably undetectable.
  • As noted above, the method of the present invention may also use further steps of size exclusion chromatography (SEC), reversed-phase chromatography, hydroxyapatite chromatography, and/or other available chromatography techniques, methods, or systems in combination with the steps described herein in accordance with the present application.
  • A flocculate removal step may also be employed to provide higher purity to the resulting plasmid DNA product. This step may be used to remove a large portion of precipitated material (flocculate). One mechanism of performing flocculate removal is through a lysate filtration step, such as through a 1 to 5 mm, and preferably a 3.5 mm grid filter, followed by a depth filtration as a polishing filtration step. Other methods of performing flocculate removal are through centrifugation or settling. Alternatively, the flocculate may be removed by ion exchange chromatography.
  • At various times in the endotoxin removal and/or plasmid DNA purification process, therefore, the sample may be subjected to one or more of ion exchange chromatography (e.g., anion or cation exchange chromatography), affinity chromatography, hydrophobic interaction chromatography, and filtration (e.g., filtered through a 0.2 μm and/or 0.45 μm filter), and, optionally, filtered or subjected to chromatography methods a second, third, or fourth time, or more.
  • Thus, for example, the sample can be subjected to a first chromatography material, treated with the polypeptide, subjected to a second chromatography material, and subjected to a third chromatography material. The sample may also be filtered at various times in the sequence, such as after the first chromatographic separation, or after the third chromatographic separation. It will be understood that subjecting the sample to a chromatographic material also involves eluting the desired portion of the sample (such as that portion containing purified plasmid DNA) from the chromatographic material, and discarding undesired portions of the sample. Depending on the nature of the chromatographic material, the desired portions may be retained within the chromatographic material and eluted in a separate step while the undesired materials flow through the material, or the undesired materials may be retained in the chromatographic material while the desired portions flow through the chromatographic material.
  • At a variety of places in the above protocol, analytical determination of nucleic acid yield and purity are advantageously performed. Typically, such assays are performed before and after each purification step, as well as to each nucleic acid-containing fraction from, e.g., preparative ion exchange chromatography or filtration. Representative means for performing these analytical determinations include HPLC analysis of purity, spectrophotometric estimation of yield, silver staining and SDS-PAGE for protein analysis, and agarose gel electrophoresis and Southern blotting for DNA analysis. In certain embodiments, the processes described herein yields a purified concentrate with a plasmid DNA concentration (including, for example, predominantly supercoiled or other plasmid DNA) of around 70%, 75%, 80%, 85%, 90%, 95%, and preferably 99%, or greater.
  • Additionally, it is also generally desirable to analytically determine the presence of polysaccharides such as colanic acid, uronic acid, and/or fucose in the intermediate or end products. Suitable assays for the detection of colanic acid and other polysaccharides are described elsewhere herein (e.g., in Example 16).
  • Particular chromatographic and filtration techniques are described in further detail below.
  • Ion Exchange Chromatography
  • As noted above, ion exchange chromatography can be employed to purify the biological sample prior to treatment with the polypeptide, or thereafter. This process generally separates nucleic acid, e.g., plasmid DNA, in the bacterial lysate or lysate derivative from contaminating endotoxin, trace proteins, and residual cellular contaminants. Cation or anion exchange may be selected depending on the properties of the contaminants and the pH of the solution. Anion exchange chromatography, for example, functions by binding negatively charged (or acidic) molecules to a support which is positively charged. The use of ion-exchange chromatography, then, allows molecules to be separated based upon their charge. Families of molecules (acidics, basics and neutrals) can be easily separated by this technique. Stepwise elution schemes may be used, with many contaminants eluting in the early fractions and the plasmid DNA eluted in the later fractions. Ion exchange chromatography is a relatively common method for removing proteins and endotoxin from plasmid DNA preparations. The ion exchange chromatography or any one or more of the other chromatography steps or techniques used can employ stationary phases, displacement chromatography methods, simulated moving bed technology, and/or continuous bed columns or systems.
  • The ion exchange columns that can be utilized in the processes of the present invention include both cationic and anionic ion exchange columns. In more preferred embodiments, the ion exchange chromatography material is anion exchange chromatography resin. For example, the anion exchange chromatography material resin may comprise diethylaminoethyl cellulose (DEAE), trimethylaminoethyl (TMAE), quaternary amino ethyl (QAE), or polyethyl imide (PEI) resins. In one embodiment, the anion exchange chromatography resin comprises DEAE. In another embodiment, the anion exchange chromatography resin comprises a quaternary ammonium resin. For instance, a chromatography column may be packed with one or more an anion exchange chromatography resins described herein. The optimal capacity of the column will be determined empirically based on the resin used and the size of nucleic acid to be purified. For many plasmid DNAs, preferred resins are those with no pore or with a large pore size, e.g., greater than 1000 Å, preferably around 3000 Å to 4000 Å; with a medium bead size, e.g., about 20 to 500 μm diameter; that does not leach matrix components. Ideally, the resin is also washable, e.g., with sodium hydroxide, to allow repeated use.
  • Relatively weak cationic and strong cationic ion exchange columns can also be used. Relatively strong cationic exchange columns typically have a surface coated with a polyhydroxylated polymer and functionalized with sulfopropyl, a dextran matrix functionalized with a sulfopropyl group, or a surface coated with a polyhydroxylated polymer functionalized with sulfoethyl. Examples of strong cationic ion exchange columns using each of these materials include, respectively, a POROS HS™, a POROS S™, and a SP-Sephadex™ column, among others. Relatively weak cationic exchange columns typically have a dextran matrix functionalized by carboxymethyl or an acrylic matrix functionalized by a carboxylic group. Examples of weak cationic exchange columns using each of these materials include, respectively, CM-Sephadex™ and Bio-Rex 70™.
  • Relatively weak anionic and strong anionic ion exchange columns can also be used in the methods of the present invention. Weak anionic ion exchange columns typically have a surface coated with polyethyleneimine that is capable of surface ionization up to a pH of about 9, a styrene-divinylbenzene copolymer containing sulfonic acid groups or a dextran matrix functionalized by diethylaminoethyl. Examples of weak anionic exchange columns using each of these materials include, respectively, a POROS PI™ column, a Dowex 50™ column and a DEAE-Sephadex™. Relatively strong anionic exchange columns typically have a surface coated with quaternized polyethyleneimine with a surface ionization over a pH range of about 1 to about 14. An example of a such a strong anionic ion exchange column is a POROS HQ™ column, or a SOURCE™ column. The resins for the columns listed above can be obtained from Amersham/Pharmacia (Piscataway, N.J.), PerSeptive Biosystems (Foster City, Calif.), Toso Haas (Montgomeryville, Pa.), GE Healthcare (Piscataway, N.J.), and other suppliers.
  • Typically, the sample is combined with an ion exchange chromatography resin that is present in a column. The column can be a 0.5 ml column, a 1.5 ml column, a 10 ml column, a 20 ml column, a 30 ml column, a 50 ml column, a 100 ml column, a 200 ml column, a 300 ml column, a 400 ml column, a 500 ml column, a 600 ml column, a 700 ml column, an 800 ml column, a 900 ml column, a 1000 ml (10 column a 2000 ml (2 L) a 10 L column, a 20 L column, a 30 L column, a 40 L column, a 50 L column, a 60 L column, a 70 L column, an 80 L column a 90 L column, a 100 L column, or a column with a capacity greater than 100 L, as well as any other column with a capacity between the volumes listed above.
  • Typically, the ion exchange chromatography material is equilibrated prior to use at a pH ranging from about 6.0 to about 7.2 and at a salt concentration that can range from about 100 mM to 200 mM. Therefore, the column can be equilibrated at a pH of about 6.0, 6.1, 6.2, 6.3, 6.4, 6.5, 6.6, 6.7, 6.8, 6.9, 7.0, 7.1, 7.2 or any other pH in between these pH values and at a salt concentration of about 100 mM, 125 mM, 150 mM, 175 mM, 200 mM or any other concentration in between the salt concentration values listed above. Commonly used salts that can be utilized to equilibrate the chromatography material include NaCl, KCl or any other salt that can be adjusted to match the ionic strength of KCl.
  • For the ion exchange chromatography, packing material and method of preparing such material as well as process for preparing, polymerizing and functionalizing anion and cation exchange chromatography and eluting and separating plasmid DNA therethrough are well known in the art.
  • In addition, a chelating agent for bivalent metal ion may be used such as for example, ethylenediamine-tetraacetic acid (EDTA), for inhibiting the degradation of plasmids due to DNA-degrading enzymes in the lysate of Escherichia coli. The concentration of chelating agent for bivalent metal ion is preferably 0.1 to 100 mM.
  • When applying the protein of interest to an anion exchange matrix any suitable matrix can be employed including, but not limited to aminoethyl, diethylaminoethyl, quaternary aminomethyl, quaternary aminoethyl, diethyl-(2-hydroxypropyl)aminoethyl, triethylaminomethyl, triethylaminopropyl and polyethyleneimine exchangers, to achieve filtration of the protein of interest. Examples of commercially available anionic exchangers include the cellulose ion exchangers such as DE32 and DE52 (WHATMAN, Florham Park, N.J.), the dextran ion exchangers such as DEAE-SEPHADEX C-25, QAE-SEPHADEX C-25, DEAE-SEPHADEX C-50 and QAE-SEPHADEX C-50 (Pharmacia, Piscataway, N.J.), the agarose or cross-linked agarose such as DEAE BIO-GEL A (BIO-RAD, Hercules, Calif.), DEAE-SEPHAROSE CL-6B and Q-SEPHAROSE Fast Flow (Pharmacia), the synthetic organic polymers, such as MONO Q (Pharmacia), DEAE-5-PW and HRLC MA7P (BIO-RAD) and the coated silica matrices such as DEAE Si5500 and TEAP Si100. Desirably, the anion exchange matrix is equilibrated in very low salt concentrations and employed at an alkaline pH (e.g., pH 8.0 to 11.5) to facilitate binding of acid and mildly basic contaminants.
  • When applying the protein of interest to a cation exchange matrix, it is contemplated that any matrix functionalized with carboxymethyl, sulfonate, sulfoethyl or sulfopropyl groups can be employed. Desirably, the cation exchange matrix is equilibrated and employed at an acidic pH (e.g., pH 3.0 to 6.5) to facilitate binding of basic and mildly acidic contaminants. Examples of commercially available cationic exchangers are the cellulose-based CM 23, CM 32 and CM 52 (WHATMAN); the dextran based CM-SEPHADEX C-25, SP-SEPHADEX C-25, CM-SEPHADEX C-50 and SP-SEPHADEX C-50 (Pharmacia); the agarose or cross-linked agarose-based CM BIO-GEL A (B10-RAD), CM-SEPHAROSE Fast Flow and S-SEPHAROSE Fast Flow (Pharmacia); the synthetic organic polymer-based MONO S (Pharmacia), SP-5-PW and HRLC MA7C (BIO-RAD) and the coated silica matrices such as CM Si300 and SP Si100.
  • The sample (e.g., the lysate or derivative thereof, including the nucleic acid) is typically loaded onto the column in a loading buffer comprising a salt concentration below the concentration at which the nucleic acid would elute from the column. Generally, the salt concentration will be in certain embodiments from about 10 to 50 mS, depending on the resin used. In general, for weaker anion-exchange resins, a lower conductivity solution will be used, whereas for stronger anion-exchange resins, a higher conductivity solution will be used. The column will then be washed with several column volumes of buffer to remove those substances that bind weakly to the resin. Fractions are then eluted from the column using a shallow continuous saline gradient according to conventional methods, for example, using up to 1.5M NaCl in a Tris-HCl buffer. Sample fractions are collected from the column. For intermediate scale preparations (e.g., from about 100 mg to about 3 grams nucleic acid), fractions will typically be at least 50 ml to 2 liters where the nucleic acid peak is expected, with increases in volume in the fractions past the expected peak. Analytical determinations of nucleic acid yield and purity are performed on single or multiple fractions. In addition, Limulus ameobocyte lysate (LAL) assays (e.g., to detect the Lipid A portion of endotoxin) may be performed on each fraction to determine residual endotoxin and/or other assays described herein may be performed on each fraction to determine residual polysaccharide contaminant levels, such as colanic acid or related polysaccharides (as described below), in each fraction. Fractions containing high levels of nucleic acid and low endotoxin or low colanic acid may be pooled, or maintained as separate fractions. The resulting nucleic acid samples may again be filtered (e.g., through a 0.2 μm filter) or subjected to further chromatography techniques depending on the endotoxin and polysaccharide levels and the desired purity, as described below.
  • The support matrices for the ion exchange chromatographic materials disclosed herein are not critical, however, support matrices based on dextran, cellulose, cross-linked agarose, synthetic organic polymers, coated silica or agarose are conventional in the art and suitable for use herein.
  • Affinity Chromatography
  • As noted above, affinity chromatography can additionally or alternatively be employed to purify the biological sample. A particular aspect of the invention involves the colanic acid degradation process using the polypeptides described herein, and combining the digested material with an affinity chromatography material to selectively remove digested polysaccharides such as colanic acid. Particularly preferred affinity chromatography materials have an affinity for vicinal or cis-diols. In one particular embodiment, the affinity chromatography material is a boronate chromatography resin, such as a boronic acid- or boronate-based resin.
  • In basic respects, the affinity chromatography involves preparation of a selective adsorbent by covalent immobilization of a molecule, containing a recognizable region, for which the target sample to be separated is specific, to a suitable insoluble support. The immobilized compound is generally referred to as a ligand and it is recognized that coupling of the ligand to the support must be accomplished in a manner which does not interfere with its ability to be recognized by the target. Affinity between ligand and the target molecule to be purified can be accomplished by passing the sample containing a sample containing the target molecule through a column containing the selective adsorbent. Purification is thereafter accomplished by washing the column with a buffer used to free the adsorbent matrix of unwanted materials, followed by elution of the adsorbed target molecule. Washing is accomplished by passing a volume of physiological buffer, such as phosphate buffered saline, about pH 7.2, through the column. The volume of buffer used in the washing step should not be so great as to result in target molecule loss but, on the other hand, not so limited so as not to remove impurities. Elution is the step wherein the target molecule is removed from the column by using a solvent that reduces the affinity of the target molecule to the ligand or the affinity of the ligand-target molecule complex to the solid support. Elution of an antibody coupled to the antigen may be accomplished by either a salt gradient, to change the pH; buffered step-gradient, to change the ionic strength; or other methods.
  • The ideal solid support or matrix should possess several characteristics including, macroporosity, mechanical stability, ease of activation, hydrophilicity, and inertness, i.e., low nonspecific adsorption. No matrix is ideal in all of these respects; the matrix is often determined empirically. Affinity chromatography matrices commonly used by those skilled in the art include cross-linked dextran, agarose, polyacrylamide, cellulose, silica and poly(hydroxyethylmethacrylate). For immuno-adsorbents, beaded agarose is generally the preferred solid support by those skilled in the art due to its high adsorptive capacity for proteins, high porosity, hydrophilicity, chemical stability, lack of charge and relative inertness toward nonspecific adsorption.
  • Ligands may be physically adsorbed to matrices or covalently attached to polymeric matrices containing hydroxylic or amino groups by means of bifunctional reagents. Attachment usually requires two steps, activation of the matrix and coupling of the ligand to the activated matrix. Activated matrices are available commercially. The selection method for coupling the ligand to the matrix is dictated in part by the choice of matrix, and, in part, by the choice of ligand.
  • The specific buffering conditions used for equilibrating the affinity column in preparation for sample application should reflect the specific properties of the interacting system being used. The nature of the buffer used, including its pH and ionic strength, should be optimal for the ligand-target molecule system. The target sample applied to the column should preferably be contained in the same buffer used to equilibrate the column. After sample application and adsorption, the column may be washed with the starting buffer to remove any unbound sample and any impurities. It is also common to then wash the column with buffers different from the starting buffer in order to remove nonspecifically adsorbed substances.
  • Elution of the target molecule may be accomplished by a number of methods, including but not limited to these presented here. Typically, the conditions of the buffer may be changed such that the affinity of the binding complex falls sufficiently, thereby destroying effective binding to each other or to the solid support. This is achieved by altering the pH, or the ionic strength of the buffer or both, or by chaotropic ions, e.g., cyanates. Increased separation may be obtained by gradient elution. Suitable methods of elution include use of chaotropic agents such as KSCN; organic solvents, e.g., ethylene glycol, DMSO, or acetonitrile; denaturing agents, e.g., 8 M urea or 6 M guanine; electrophoretic elution; pressure induced elution and metal ion elution. Incomplete elution results in both loss of product and loss of column capacity. Ideally, the elution conditions should allow for complete elution of the product after one or two column volumes have passed through the column.
  • Detailed discussions of affinity chromatography can be found in Handbook of Affinity Chromatography, David S. Hage (ed.) CRC Press (2006), and Affinity Chromatography: A Practical Approach, edited by Dean P. D. G., Johnson, W. S., Middle, F. A., Affinity Chromatography, Principles and Methods, as published by Pharmacia, (Pharmacia LKB Biotechnology, Uppsala, Sweden), and Immunoaffinity Purification: Basic Principles and Operational Considerations, Yarmush, M. L, et al., (1992) Biotech Adv., 10:412-446.
  • Ligands used for affinity chromatography are structurally and biologically closely related to the target molecule to be purified. For the purposes of the present invention, any suitable affinity chromatography material and ligand thereof can be employed for binding and eluting the sample of interest (i.e., plasmid DNA). In general, this makes the selection of the ligand specific for each case.
  • Preferably, the ligand used in the affinity chromatography material has specificity for diol complexes, preferably vicinal or cis-diols. Polysaccharides, such as colanic acid, for example, contain vicinal diol complexes. In a particularly preferred embodiment, the affinity chromatography material is a boronate affinity chromatography material. Boronate affinity columns were first employed for the separation of sugars and nucleic acid components by Weith et al, Biochemistry 9, 4396-4401, 1970; since then, this technique has been employed in the separation of a wide range of cis-diol compounds, including nucleosides, nucleotides, carbohydrates, glycoproteins, and enzymes.
  • In general, the mechanism of action between boronic acids and cis-diols involves hydroxylation of the boronate under basic conditions; the boronate goes from a trigonal coplanar form to a tetrahedral boronate anion, which can then form esters with cis-diols. The resulting diester can by hydrolyzed under acidic conditions, thus reversing the reaction. Other methods for separation of vicinal diols are described by Barry et al., Australian J. Chem. 37, (1984); Gable, Organometallics 13(6), 2486-88 (1994); Liu, J. Microbial Methods 29, 85-95 (1997) Kinrade et al., DaltonTrans. 3713-3716 (2003); and Zhao et al., Analytical Sciences, 22(5), 747 (2006).
  • Suitable boronate ligands for use in the affinity chromatography material of the present processes include, for example, 3-aminophenylboronic acid (3aPBA), 2-(((4-boronophenyl)-methyl)-ethylammonio)ethyl, 2-(((4-boronophenyl)-methyl)-diethylammonio)ethyl, p-(ω-aminoethyl)phenyl-boronate, poly(p-vinylbenzeneboronic acid), N-(4-nitro-3-dihydroxyborylphenyl)succinamic acid, 4-(N-methyl)carboxamido-benzeneboronic acid), 3-nitro-4-carboxamidobenzeneboronic acid, 2-nitro-3-succinamido-benzeneboronic acid, and 3-succinamido-4-nitro-benzeneboronic acid, among others. One preferred boronate ligand is 3-aminophenylboronic acid (3aPBA).
  • A range of support matrices for the affinity chromatographic materials disclosed herein, including boronate affinity chromatographic materials, are not critical, however, support matrices based on dextran, cellulose, agarose, polyacrylamide, silica, polystyrene, and polymethacrylate are conventional in the art and suitable for use herein. Boronate affinity matrices are commercially available from a variety of vendors, including for example, Sigma-Aldrich Inc. (Boric acid gel; polymethacrylate support) (m-aminophenylboronic acid-acrylate; acrylic bead support); Bio-Rad (Affi-Gel 601; polyacrylamide support); Pierce (immobilized boronic acid gel; polyacrylamide support); and Tosoh (m-aminophenylboronic acid-agarose; agarose support) (TSKgel Boronate-5PW column; polymethacrylate support). Other companies supplying boronic acid and derivatives thereof include Denisco (Hyderabad, India) and Synthonix Corporation (Wake Forest, N.C.).
  • Polymer gels containing boronate groups described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,969,129 (hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety) may also be used.
  • The principles, theory and devices used for boronate affinity chromatography are also described in Boronate Affinity Chromatography, Chapter 8, pages 215-230, Handbook of Affinity Chromatography, David S. Hage (ed.) CRC Press (2006).
  • Hydrophobic Interaction Chromatography
  • In the embodiments in which hydrophobic interaction chromatography (HIC) materials and methods are employed, these chromatography methods generally employ hydrophobic moieties on a substrate to attract hydrophobic regions in molecules in the sample for purification. In general, HIC supports work by a clustering effect; typically, no covalent or ionic bonds are formed or shared when these molecules associate. Hydrophobic interaction chromatography is beneficial as it is at least partially removes open circular plasmid forms and other contaminants, such as genomic DNA, RNA, and endotoxin.
  • For the purposes of the present invention, any suitable hydrophobic interaction matrix can be employed for binding and eluting the sample of interest (e.g., plasmid DNA). Such hydrophobic interaction matrices include, but are not limited to, natural or artificial surfaces containing uncharged groups, such as methyl, ethyl, or other alkyl groups. These groups form hydrophobic bonds with proteins which are passed through the matrix and result in separation of polynucleotides and/or polypeptides based on the strength of interaction between the polynucleotides and/or polypeptides and matrix groups. The degree of hydrophobicity of the resin material may vary depending on the concentration of salt in the medium or the concentration of salt in the eluent. Hydrophobic interaction columns normally comprise a base matrix (e.g., cross-linked agarose or synthetic copolymer material) to which hydrophobic ligands (e.g., alkyl or aryl groups) are coupled. Preferred hydrophobic interaction chromatography resins generally include alkyl moieties of 2 to 20 carbon atoms in length (e.g., 4 to 18 carbon atoms, or 6 to 15 carbon atoms), which are typically unsubstituted.
  • The pore diameter of the base material for hydrophobic interaction chromatography is generally between 500 to 4000 Å, but it can be appropriately selected from said range depending on the molecular size of sample to be separated and the components thereof. In general, since the retention of nucleic acids on the packing material and the adsorption capacity may differ depending on the pore diameter, it may be preferable to use a base material with a relatively large pore diameter for nucleic acids with relatively large molecular size and a base material with relatively small pore diameter for nucleic acids with a relatively small molecular size.
  • Hydrophobic interaction chromatography can be performed at low or high pressures, wherein the column is equilibrated in the presence of aqueous buffers using relatively high salt concentrations (e.g., 1.2 to 1.7 M ammonium sulfate) and eluted in the presence of aqueous buffers using relatively low salt concentrations (e.g., a decreasing ammonium sulfate gradient from 1.2 M to 0.5 M). As such, polynucleotides and polypeptides are selectively eluted based on the differing strengths of hydrophobic interaction with the hydrophobic groups on the matrix, i.e., in order of increasing hydrophobicity of the protein. Examples of commercially available hydrophobic interaction matrices for relatively low pressure applications include phenyl-SEPHAROSE (Pharmacia) and butyl, phenyl and ether TOYOPEARL 650 series resins (Toso Haas). Other commercially available hydrophobic interaction chromatography resins include Phenyl SEPHAROSE 6 FAST FLOW™ column with low or high substitution (Pharmacia LKB Biotechnology, AB, Sweden); Phenyl SEPHAROSE™ High Performance column (Pharmacia LKB Biotechnology, AB, Sweden); Octyl SEPHAROSE™ High Performance column (Pharmacia LKB Biotechnology, AB, Sweden); FRACTOGEL™ EMD Propyl or FRACTOGEL™ EMD Phenyl columns (E. Merck, Germany); MACRO-PREP™ Methyl or MACRO-PREP™ t-Butyl Supports (Bio-Rad, California); and WP HI-Propyl (C 3)™ column (J. T. Baker, New Jersey). Still other commercially available hydrophobic interaction chromatography resins are available from Sigma-Aldrich, Inc (St. Louis, Mo.) (e.g., TSK-GEL® Butyl-NPR; TSK-GEL® Ether-5PW; TSK-GEL® Phenyl-5PW; each of which and others may have various particle sizes); GE Healthcare (Piscataway, N.J.) (e.g., HiScreen Phenyl FF (high or low sub); HiScreen Butyl FF; HiScreen Butyl-S FF; HiScreen Octyl FF).
  • Elution from the hydrophobic interaction matrix can be performed with a step-wise or linear gradient. Suitable elution buffers are well known in the art. Suitable column sizes are described above in connection with the ion exchange chromatography materials. Likewise, the support matrices for the hydrophobic interaction chromatographic materials disclosed herein are not critical, however, support matrices based on dextran, cellulose, cross-linked agarose, synthetic organic polymers, coated silica or agarose are conventional in the art and suitable for use herein.
  • Synthesis of base materials for hydrophobic interaction chromatography, as well as process for preparing, polymerizing and functionalizing hydrophobic interaction chromatography and eluting and separating samples such as plasmid DNA therethrough are well known in the art, and are inter alia described in U.S. Pat. No. 6,441,160 and U.S. Pat. No. 7,169,917 (each of which is hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety).
  • Filtration
  • According to certain preferred embodiments, one or more filtration, ultrafiltration, or diafiltration steps may also be performed, including tangential flow filtration. Filtration through size exclusion filters can be used to at least partially remove endotoxin and other contaminants while resulting in minimal nucleic acid loss. For many applications, for example, it will be desirable to further purify the sample (e.g., plasmid DNA), lower the salt concentration of the resulting sample, concentrate the sample, and/or exchange the buffer to a more suitable buffer for subsequent uses. For therapeutic uses, e.g. use in gene therapy, it may be desirable to further purify the nucleic acid obtained from the tangential flow filtration, or other, step.
  • One or more (initial or final) filtration, ultrafiltration, or diafiltration steps may be performed to generally achieve that result(s). If desired, a smaller MWCO ultrafiltration membrane may be used for subsequent or final diafiltration steps than used previously for initial purification, since the nucleic acid will typically be highly purified at later stages and predominantly small solute molecules will be passed through the membrane into the filtrate. For many plasmid DNAs, for example, a 10,000 to 100,000 MWCO membrane, or greater may be used. Hollow fiber devices with about a 100,000 MWCO membrane are commonly used, particularly when handling concentrated nucleic acid solutions, due to smaller hold-up volumes, increased flux, higher yields and shorter processing times. Standard, commercially available filtration and diafiltration materials are suitable for use in this process, according to standard techniques known in the art.
  • Filtration of fine particle size contaminants from fluids has been accomplished by the use of various porous filter media through which a contaminated composition is passed such that the filter retains the contaminant. Retention of the contaminant may occur by mechanical straining or electrokinetic particle capture and adsorption. In mechanical straining, a particle is retained by physical entrapment when it attempts to pass through a pore smaller than itself. In the case of electrokinetic capture mechanisms, the particle collides with a surface within the porous filter and is retained on the surface by short-range attractive forces. To achieve electrokinetic capture, charge-modifying systems can be used to alter the surface charge characteristics of a filter (see, e.g., WO 90/11814). For example, where the contaminant to be removed is anionic, a cationic charge modifier can be used to alter the charge characteristics of the filter such that the contaminant is retained by the filter.
  • In certain embodiments, either before or after filtration, the sample is treated with an aqueous solution comprising a zwitterionic detergent. Suitable zwittergents include, for example, EMPIGEN BB® (n-dodecyl-N,Ndimethylglycine), ZWITTERGENT® 3-08, ZWITTERGENT® 3-10, ZWITTERGENT® 3-12, ZWITTERGENT® 3-14, ZWITTERGENT® 3-16, CHAPS, CHAPSO, and others.
  • In one preferred embodiment, the sample is filtered using tangential flow filtration. The principles, theory and devices used for tangential flow filtration are described in Michaels, S. L. et al., “Tangential Flow Filtration” in Separations Technology, Pharmaceutical and Biotechnology Applications, W. P. Olson, ed., Interpharm Press, Inc., Buffalo Grove, Ill. (1995). To filter and concentrate a sample by tangential flow filtration, for example, a membrane is generally selected with a molecular weight cut off (MWCO) that is substantially lower than the molecular weight of the molecules to be retained. A general rule is to select a membrane with a molecular weight cut off that is 3 to 6 times lower than the molecular weight of the molecules to be retained. The membrane is installed, the tangential flow filtration system is initialized (typically flushed with water and tested for water filtrate flow rate and integrity), sample is added, a crossflow is established, feed and retentate pressures are set, and filtrate is collected. When the desired concentration or volume is reached, the process is stopped, and the sample is recovered.
  • One preferred filtration method is diafiltration using an ultrafiltration membrane having a molecular weight cutoff in the range of 30,000 to 500,000 MWCO, depending on the plasmid size. This step of diafiltration allows for buffer exchange, followed by concentration. The eluate is typically concentrated 3- to 4-fold by tangential flow filtration as described above using, for example, 30 kDa membrane cut-off, to a target concentration, and the concentrate is buffer exchanged by diafiltration at constant volume and adjusted to the target plasmid concentration. The resulting plasmid DNA solution may then be further filtered, e.g., through a 0.2 μm filter, and is typically divided into several aliquots, which are stored in containers at a relatively cold temperature (e.g., ˜0° C.) until further processing.
  • Additionally or alternatively, the filter may be one which binds nucleic acid while allowing endotoxins and other contaminants to pass through the filter. Once the undesirable materials have passed through the filter, the nucleic acid may be eluted from the filter and collected.
  • Suitable size exclusion filters are available from a variety of commercial sources including, e.g., Ambion (Austin, Tex.), GE Healthcare (Piscataway, N.J.), Gelman (Ann Arbor, Mich.), Pall-Filtron (East Hills, N.Y.), Roche (Basel, Switzerland), Sartorius (Edgewood, N.Y.), and Thermo Scientific Pierce (Rockford, Ill.). The filter used will be one that binds endotoxin and other contaminants while allowing nucleic acid to pass through. Pall Ultipor® N66® filters have been found to remove substantial endotoxin with high yield of nucleic acid. The lysate solution or lysate derivative containing the nucleic acid may also be pre-filtered (e.g., using a 0.45 μm filter) prior to one or more of the chromatography or filtration steps described herein.
  • Where DNA purified according to the above protocol is to be complexed with a lipid carrier for use in gene therapy, for example, it may also be desirable to exchange the DNA into a low conductivity buffer, preferably by diafiltration. A low-conductivity buffer is meant to include any buffer of less than about 10 mS, preferably less than about 1 mS.
  • In addition to the filtration techniques described above, conventional gel filtration methods (i.e., using a size exclusion chromatography material) may be employed. See, e.g., Gel Filtration Principles and Methods, Edition AI, Amersham Biosciences, 2002.
  • The polypeptides described herein may additionally or alternatively used in a variety of industrial processes requiring or benefiting from the digestion of colanic acid and other polysaccharides. In general, this may involve treating machinery, product and/or effluent pipelines, and the products, intermediates, or effluents themselves with the polypeptides described herein in order to, for instance, remove or prevent corrosion, fouling, or other build-up resulting from these industrial processes. One particular example is the removal or prevention of biofilms (e.g., those containing bacteria, such as gram negative bacterial) that may form during the processes or over time; biofilms and similar materials can constrict or block passageways and conduits, or increase wear-and-tear on machinery parts or systems. Representative industrial processes that may benefit from use of the polypeptides described herein include, for example, in paper and cellulose-making processes, membrane reconstitution and cleaning, recycling, waste-water treatments (e.g., digestions of aerobic solids and sludges), petrochemical refining and waste remediation, high purity water filtration and systems, water cooling systems/heat exchangers, and food processing. For paper or cellulose processing operations, for example, biofilms may form in intermediate processing streams, which can adversely influence downstream processing and/or affect the quality of the final product. The polypeptides described herein may benefit such processes by removing, minimizing, or preventing such biofilms.
  • Polypeptides
  • As noted above, the present invention relates to polypeptides that are capable of degrading colanic acid that may be found, for example, in biological materials. This may include, for example, biofilms or bacterial nucleic acid preparations derived from bacteria such as E. coli, Salmonella, or other enterobacteriaceae, such as plasmid DNA derived from E. coli. The polypeptides described herein also advantageously enable the preparation of highly pure gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA preparations.
  • In certain embodiments, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence generally corresponding to SEQ ID NO: 1, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. This polypeptide generally corresponds to a full-length colanic acid-degrading polypeptide having a molecular weight of about 84,354 Daltons. In general, the polypeptide is an isolated polypeptide. In certain embodiments, the polypeptide is isolated from a bacterial source organism and purified. Typically, the polypeptide has a purity of at least 70%, more preferably at least 80%, more preferably at least 90%, more preferably at least 95%, more preferably at least 98%, and more preferably at least 99%.
  • Polypeptide fragments are also provided herein. Such fragments may be truncated at the N-terminus or C-terminus, or may lack internal residues, for example, when compared with a full-length protein. For example, certain fragments lack amino acid residues that are not essential for a desired activity (e.g., biological or otherwise) of the polypeptide. In one particular, embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence generally corresponding to SEQ ID NO: 2, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. This polypeptide generally corresponds to a truncated version of the full-length polypeptide, wherein the first 106 amino acids of the full-length polypeptide (SEQ ID NO: 1) are absent.
  • In addition to the full-length and truncated polypeptides described herein, it is contemplated that polypeptide variants can be prepared, e.g., by introducing appropriate nucleotide changes to the polypeptide DNA, and/or by synthesis of the desired polypeptide, or by isolating and purifying a variant polypeptide having colanic acid-degrading activity. Those skilled in the art will appreciate that amino acid changes may alter certain post-translational processes of the polypeptide, such as changing the number or position of glycosylation sites or altering membrane anchoring characteristics.
  • Variations in the full-length and/or truncated sequences or in various domains of the polypeptides described herein, can be made, for example, using any of the techniques and guidelines for conservative and non-conservative mutations set forth in the literature (for example, U.S. Pat. No. 5,364,934 (hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety)). Variations may be a substitution, deletion or insertion of one or more codons encoding the polypeptide that results in a change in the amino acid sequence of the polypeptide as compared with the native sequence polypeptide. Optionally the variation is by substitution of at least one amino acid with any other amino acid in one or more of the domains of the polypeptide. Guidance in determining which amino acid residue may be inserted, substituted or deleted without adversely affecting the desired activity may be found by comparing the sequence of the polypeptide with that of homologous protein molecules and minimizing the number of amino acid sequence changes made in regions of high homology. Amino acid substitutions can be the result of replacing one amino acid with another amino acid having similar structural and/or chemical properties, such as the replacement of a leucine with a serine, i.e., conservative amino acid replacements. Insertions or deletions may optionally be in the range of about 1 to 5 amino acids, 5 to 10 amino acids, 10 to 25 amino acids, 25 to 50 amino acids, or more, such as 100 amino acids or more. The variation allowed may be determined by systematically making insertions, deletions or substitutions of amino acids in the sequence and testing the resulting variants for activity exhibited by the full-length or mature native sequence.
  • As noted above, the polypeptide may be a variant of the full-length or truncated polypeptide described herein. Ordinarily, a polypeptide variant will have at least about 80% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 81% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 82% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 83% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 84% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 85% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 86% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 87% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 88% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 89% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 90% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 91% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 92% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 93% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 94% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 95% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 96% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 97% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 98% amino acid sequence identity and alternatively at least about 99% amino acid sequence identity to a full-length polypeptide sequence as disclosed herein (e.g., SEQ ID NO: 1).
  • For truncated polypeptide variants, the polypeptide variant will ordinarily have at least about 80% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 81% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 82% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 83% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 84% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 85% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 86% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 87% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 88% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 89% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 90% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 91% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 92% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 93% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 94% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 95% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 96% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 97% amino acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 98% amino acid sequence identity and alternatively at least about 99% amino acid sequence identity to a truncated polypeptide sequence as disclosed herein (e.g., SEQ ID NO: 2).
  • In one embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 90% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 1, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. In another embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 95% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 1, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. In another embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 98% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 1, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. In another embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 99% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 1, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof.
  • In one embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 90% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 2, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. In another embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 95% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 2, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. In another embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 98% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 2, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. In another embodiment, the polypeptide comprises an amino acid sequence having at least about 99% amino acid sequence identity to SEQ ID NO: 2, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof.
  • In certain embodiments, exemplary conservative substitutions of interest are shown in Table 1. If such substitutions result in a change in biological activity, or a reduction in the desired activity, then more other changes, such as those described below in reference to amino acid classes, may be introduced and the products screened. It is understood that codons capable of coding for such conservative substitutions are known in the art.
  • TABLE 1
    Original Residue Conservative Substitutions
    Ala (A) Ser; Val; Leu; Ile
    Arg (R) Lys; Gln; Asn
    Asn (N) Gln; His; Lys; Arg
    Asp (D) Glu
    Cys (C) Ser; Ala
    Gln (Q) Asn
    Glu (E) Asp
    Gly (G) Pro; Ala
    His (H) Asn; Gln; Lys; Arg
    Ile (I) Leu; Val; Met; Ala; Phe; Norleucine
    Leu (L) Ile; Val; Met; Ala; Phe; Norleucine
    Lys (K) Arg; Gln; Glu; Asn
    Met (M) Leu; Ile; Phe
    Phe (F) Leu; Val; Ile; Ala; Met; Tyr
    Pro (P) Ala
    Ser (S) Thr
    Thr (T) Ser
    Trp (W) Tyr; Phe
    Tyr (Y) Trp; Phe; Thr; Ser
    Val (V) Ile; Leu; Met; Phe; Ala; Norleucine
  • Within the scope of the present invention is polypeptide analogs of the invention arrived at by amino acid substitutions based on the relative similarity of the amino acid side-chain substituents, for example, their hydrophobicity, hydrophilicity, charge, size, etc. One factor that can be considered in making amino acid substitutions is the hydropathic index of amino acids. The importance of the hydropathic amino acid index in conferring interactive biological function on a protein has been discussed by Kyte and Doolittle (J. Mol. Biol., 157: 105-132, 1982). It is accepted that the relative hydropathic character of amino acids contributes to the secondary structure of the resultant protein. This, in turn, affects the interaction of the protein with molecules such as enzymes, substrates, receptors, DNA, antibodies, antigens, etc.
  • Based on its hydrophobicity and charge characteristics, each amino acid has been assigned a hydropathic index as follows: isoleucine (+4.5); valine (+4.2); leucine (+3.8); phenylalanine (+2.8); cysteine/cystine (+2.5); methionine (+1.9); alanine (+1.8); glycine (−0.4); threonine (−0.7); serine (−0.8); tryptophan (−0.9); tyrosine (−1.3); proline (−1.6); histidine (−3.2); glutamate/glutamine/aspartate/asparagine (−3.5); lysine (−3.9); and arginine (−4.5).
  • As is known in the art, certain amino acids in a peptide or protein can be substituted for other amino acids having a similar hydropathic index or score and produce a resultant peptide or protein having similar biological activity, i.e., which still retains biological functionality. In making such changes, it is preferable that amino acids having hydropathic indices within ±2 are substituted for one another. More preferred substitutions are those wherein the amino acids have hydropathic indices within ±1. Most preferred substitutions are those wherein the amino acids have hydropathic indices within ±0.5.
  • Like amino acids can also be substituted on the basis of hydrophilicity. U.S. Pat. No. 4,554,101 discloses that the greatest local average hydrophilicity of a protein, as governed by the hydrophilicity of its adjacent amino acids, correlates with a biological property of the protein. The following hydrophilicity values have been assigned to amino acids: arginine/lysine (+3.0); aspartate/glutamate (+3.0±1); serine (+0.3); asparagine/glutamine (+0.2); glycine (0); threonine (−0.4); proline (−0.5±1); alanine/histidine (−0.5); cysteine (−1.0); methionine (−1.3); valine (−1.5); leucine/isoleucine (−1.8); tyrosine (−2.3); phenylalanine (−2.5); and tryptophan (−3.4). Thus, one amino acid in a peptide, polypeptide, or protein can be substituted by another amino acid having a similar hydrophilicity score and still produce a resultant protein having similar biological activity, i.e., still retaining correct biological function. In making such changes, amino acids having hydropathic indices within ±2 are preferably substituted for one another, those within ±1 are more preferred, and those within ±0.5 are most preferred.
  • Substantial or minor modifications in function or biological or other identity of the polypeptides of the invention are also accomplished by selecting substitutions that differ significantly in their effect on maintaining, among other things: (a) the structure of the polypeptide backbone in the area of the substitution, for example, as a sheet or helical conformation; (b) the charge or hydrophobicity of the molecule at the target site; or (c) the bulk of the side chain. Naturally occurring residues are divided into groups based on common side-chain properties: (1) hydrophobic: norleucine, met, ala, val, leu, ile; (2) neutral hydrophilic: cys, ser, thr; (3) acidic: asp, glu; (4) basic: asn, gln, his, lys, arg; (5) residues that influence chain orientation: gly, pro; and (6) aromatic: trp, tyr, phe.
  • Non-conservative substitutions will generally entail exchanging a member of one of these classes for another class. Such substituted residues also may be introduced into the conservative substitution sites or, more preferably, into the remaining (non-conserved) sites.
  • In one embodiment, for example, in the amino acid sequences described in SEQ ID NO: 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, and/or 6, the amino acid leucine (L) may alternatively be either leucine (L) or isoleucine (I), the amino acid aspartic acid (D) may alternatively be aspartic acid (D) or asparagine (N), the amino acid glutamine (Q) may alternatively be glutamine (Q) or lysine (K), and the amino acid phenylalanine (F) may alternatively be phenylalanine (F) or oxidized methionine.
  • The variations can be made using methods known in the art, such as alanine scanning, oligonucleotide-mediated (site-directed) mutagenesis, and PCR mutagenesis, among other known techniques. Site-directed mutagenesis, for example, (see, e.g., Carter et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 13:4331 (1986); Zoller et al., Nucl. Acids Res., 10:6487 (1987)), cassette mutagenesis (see, e.g., Wells et al., Gene, 34:315 (1985)), restriction selection mutagenesis (see, e.g., Wells et al., Philos. Trans. R. Soc. London SerA, 317:415 (1986)) or other known techniques can be performed on cloned DNA to produce the CAE variant DNA. Scanning amino acid analysis can also be employed to identify one or more amino acids along a contiguous sequence. Among the preferred scanning amino acids are relatively small, neutral amino acids. Such amino acids include alanine, glycine, serine, and cysteine. Alanine is typically a preferred scanning amino acid among this group because it eliminates the side-chain beyond the beta-carbon and is less likely to alter the main-chain conformation of the variant (see, e.g., Cunningham and Wells, Science, 244: 1081 1085 (1989)). Alanine is also typically preferred because it is the most common amino acid. Further, it is frequently found in both buried and exposed positions (see Creighton, The Proteins, (W.H. Freeman & Co., N.Y.); Chothia, J. Mol. Biol., 150:1 (1976)). If alanine substitution does not yield adequate amounts of variant, or the colanic acid-degrading ability of the resulting polypeptide is diminished or non-existent, another amino acid can be used.
  • Covalent modifications of the polypeptides described herein are also included within the scope of this invention. One type of covalent modification, for example, includes reacting targeted amino acid residues of a polypeptide with an organic derivatizing agent that is capable of reacting with selected side chains or the N- or C-terminal residues of the polypeptide. Derivatization with bifunctional agents is useful, for instance, for crosslinking the polypeptide(s) to a water-insoluble support matrix or surface for use in the method for purifying anti-CAE antibodies, and vice-versa. Commonly used crosslinking agents include, e.g., 1,1-bis(diazoacetyl)-2-phenylethane, glutaraldehyde, N-hydroxysuccinimide esters, for example, esters with 4-azidosalicylic acid, homobifunctional imidoesters, including disuccinimidyl esters such as 3,3′-dithiobis(succinimidylpropionate), bifunctional maleimides such as bis-N-maleimido-1,8-octane and agents such as methyl-3-[(p-azidophenyl)dithio]propioimidate. In one particular embodiment, the C-terminal isoleucine of certain polypeptides described herein can be removed or deleted to expose a terminal tyrosine which can be used, for example, to crosslink the polypeptide to an insoluble matrix, either directly or through a spacer, to form an affinity resin or immobilized resin.
  • Other modifications include, for instance, deamidation of glutaminyl and asparaginyl residues to the corresponding glutamyl and aspartyl residues, respectively, hydroxylation of proline and lysine, phosphorylation of hydroxyl groups of seryl or threonyl residues, methylation of the α-amino groups of lysine, arginine, and/or histidine side chains (see, e.g., T. E. Creighton, Proteins: Structure and Molecular Properties, W.H. Freeman & Co., San Francisco, pp. 79 86 (1983)), acetylation of the N-terminal amine, and amidation of any C-terminal carboxyl group.
  • Another type of covalent modification of the polypeptides described herein and included within the scope of this invention comprises altering the native glycosylation pattern of the polypeptide. In general, altering the native glycosylation pattern involves deleting one or more carbohydrate moieties found in the polypeptide (e.g., the full-length) sequence (either by removing the underlying glycosylation site or by deleting the glycosylation by chemical and/or enzymatic means), and/or adding one or more glycosylation sites that are not present in the polypeptide sequence. In addition, this may include qualitative changes in the glycosylation of the native proteins, involving a corresponding change in the nature and proportions of the various carbohydrate moieties that may be present.
  • Addition of glycosylation sites to the polypeptide of the invention may be accomplished by altering the amino acid sequence. The alteration may be made, for example, by the addition of, or substitution by, one or more serine or threonine residues to the polypeptide sequence (for O-linked glycosylation sites). The amino acid sequences described herein (e.g., SEQ ID NO. 1, SEQ ID NO. 2, etc.) may optionally be altered through changes at the DNA level, particularly by mutating the DNA encoding the polypeptide at preselected bases such that codons are generated that will translate into the desired amino acids.
  • Another means of increasing the number of carbohydrate moieties on the polypeptide is by chemical or enzymatic coupling of glycosides to the polypeptide. Such methods are generally described in the art, e.g., in PCT International Pub. No. WO 87/05330, and in Aplin and Wriston, CRC Crit. Rev. Biochem., pp. 259 306 (1981).
  • Removal of carbohydrate moieties present on the polypeptides described herein may be accomplished chemically or enzymatically or by mutational substitution of codons encoding for amino acid residues that serve as targets for glycosylation. Chemical deglycosylation techniques are known in the art and described, for instance, by Hakimuddin, et al., Arch. Biochem. Biophys., 259:52 (1987) and by Edge et al., Anal. Biochem., 118:131 (1981). Enzymatic cleavage of carbohydrate moieties on polypeptides can be achieved by the use of a variety of endo- and exo-glycosidases as described by Thotakura et al., Meth. Enzymol., 138:350 (1987).
  • Another type of covalent modification comprises linking the polypeptides described herein to one of a variety of nonproteinaceous polymers, e.g., polyethylene glycol (PEG), polypropylene glycol, or polyoxyalkylenes, in the manner set forth in U.S. Pat. No. 4,640,835; 4,496,689; 4,301,144; 4,670,417; 4,791,192 or 4,179,337 (each of which is hereby incorporated by reference herein).
  • Additionally or alternatively, the polypeptides of the present invention may also be modified in a way to form a chimeric molecule comprising the polypeptide fused to another, heterologous polypeptide or amino acid sequence. The polypeptides may also be labeled with reagents that facilitate their detection. For example, the agents may be combined with fluorescent labels (e.g., Prober et al., Science 238:336-340 (1987); Albarella et al., EP 0 144 914); chemical labels (e.g., Sheldon et al., U.S. Pat. No. 4,582,789; Albarella et al., U.S. Pat. No. 4,563,417); and/or modified bases (e.g., Miyoshi et al., EP 0 119 448) (each of which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entirety).
  • In one embodiment, such a chimeric molecule comprises a fusion of the polypeptide with a tag polypeptide which provides an epitope to which an anti-tag antibody can selectively bind. The epitope tag is generally placed at the amino- or carboxyl-terminus of the polypeptide amino acid sequence. The presence of such epitope-tagged forms of the polypeptide can be detected using an antibody against the tag polypeptide. Also, provision of the epitope tag enables the polypeptide to be readily purified by affinity purification using an anti-tag antibody or another type of affinity matrix that binds to the epitope tag. Various tag polypeptides and their respective antibodies are well known in the art. Examples include the c-myc tag and the 8F9, 3C7, 6E10, G4, B7 and 9E10 antibodies thereto (see, e.g., Evan et al., Molecular and Cellular Biology, 5:3610 3616 (1985)); the flu HA tag polypeptide and its antibody 12 CA5 (see, e.g., Field et al., Mol. Cell. Biol., 8:2159 2165 (1988)); the Herpes Simplex virus glycoprotein D (gD) tag and its antibody (see, e.g., Paborsky et al., Protein Engineering, 3(6):547 553 (1990)); and poly-histidine (poly-his) or poly-histidine-glycine (poly-his-gly) tags. Other tag polypeptides include an α-tubulin epitope peptide (see, e.g., Skinner et al., J. Biol. Chem., 266:15163 15166 (1991)); the FLAG®-peptide (Sigma-Aldrich, Inc. (St. Louis, Mo.); see also Hopp et al., BioTechnology, 6:1204 1210 (1988)); the KT3 epitope peptide (see, e.g., Martin et al., Science, 255:192 194 (1992)); and the T7 gene 10 protein peptide tag (Lutz-Freyermuth et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 87:6393 6397 (1990)).
  • To facilitate isolation and/or purification, for example, an amino acid tag can be added to the polypeptides described herein using genetic engineering techniques that are well known to practitioners of the art. In certain embodiments, for example, the polypeptide(s) may include one, and more preferably six, consecutive histidine residues at either the amino or carboxy terminus of the protein. Such consecutive histidine residues are commonly referred to as a histidine tag. Terminal consecutive histidine residues can facilitate detection and/or purification of expressed recombinant proteins, and generally do not interfere with the function/activity/structure of the protein. The consecutive histidine residues can be incorporated into the protein coding gene by primers that carry the 5′-CAT-3° triplets. Consecutive histidine residues at either terminus serve as convenient aids for purification of proteins with immobilized metal affinity chromatography, which exploits the ability of the amino acid histidine to bind chelated transition metal ions such as nickel (Ni2+), zinc (Zn2+) and copper (Cu2+). As noted above, other techniques include, but are not limited to, epitopes for polyclonal or monoclonal antibodies including but not limited to the T7 epitope, the myc epitope, and the V5a epitope; and fusion of the polypeptides described herein to suitable protein partners including but not limited to glutathione-S-transferase or maltose binding protein. In a particular embodiment, the amino add sequence comprises an affinity tag allowing for, e.g., isolation and purification of the protein, such as, for example, a GST tag, a His tag, a FLAG® tag, or an XPRESST™ tag; in certain preferred embodiments, the affinity tag comprises a His tag (i.e., one or more, and preferably six histidine residues) (see, e.g., SEQ ID NO: 3 or SEQ. ID NO: 4), one or more copies of the FLAG® octapeptide (DYKDDDDK) (see, e.g., SEQ ID NO: 5), or the XPRESS™ octapeptide (DLYDDDK). These additional amino add sequences can be added to the C-terminus of the polypeptides, as well as the N-terminus, or at intervening positions within the polypeptides.
  • In an alternative embodiment, the chimeric molecule may comprise a fusion of the polypeptide with an immunoglobulin or a particular region of an immunoglobulin. For a bivalent form of the chimeric molecule (also referred to as an “immunoadhesin”), such a fusion could be to the Fc region of an IgG molecule. The Ig fusions preferably include the substitution of a soluble (transmembrane domain deleted or inactivated) form of a polypeptide in place of at least one variable region within an Ig molecule. In a particular embodiment, the immunoglobulin fusion includes the hinge, CH2 and CH3, or the hinge, CH1, CH2 and CH3 regions of an IgG1 molecule. For the production of immunoglobulin fusions see also U.S. Pat. No. 5,428,130; U.S. Pat. No. 6,165,476; U.S. Pat. No. 6,444,792; U.S. Pat. No. 7,442,778; and U.S. Pat. No. 7,465,447 (each of which is hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety).
  • Preparation of Polypeptides
  • Full-length polypeptides (including, for example, the polypeptide comprising the amino acid sequence corresponding to SEQ ID NO: 1) and polypeptide fragments (including, for example, the truncated polypeptide comprising the amino acid sequence corresponding to SEQ ID NO: 2) may be prepared by any of a number of conventional techniques. The polypeptides of the invention may be prepared, in general, by culturing host cells transformed or transfected with a vector containing polynucleotides encoding the desired polypeptide. In certain embodiments, the vector is selected from a plasmid, a virus, and a bacteriophage; more preferably in this embodiment, the vector is a bacteriophage (see, e.g., Example 2). Methods of preparing vectors, and in particular phage, for the production of polypeptides are well known in the art.
  • Generally, host cells, such as bacteria, are transfected or transformed with expression or cloning vectors described herein for polypeptide production and cultured in conventional nutrient media modified as appropriate for inducing promoters, selecting transformants, or amplifying the genes encoding the desired sequences. The culture conditions, such as media, temperature, pH and the like, can be selected by the skilled artisan without undue experimentation. In general, principles, protocols, and practical techniques for maximizing the productivity of cell cultures can be found in Mammalian Cell Biotechnology: a Practical Approach, M. Butler, ed. (IRL Press, 1991) and Sambrook et al., supra.
  • Methods of eukaryotic cell transfection and prokaryotic cell transformation are known to the ordinarily skilled artisan, for example, CaCl2, CaPO4, liposome-mediated, and electroporation. Depending on the host cell used, transformation is performed using standard techniques appropriate to such cells. The calcium treatment employing calcium chloride, as described in Sambrook et al., supra, or electroporation, for example, is generally used for prokaryotes. Infection with Agrobacterium tumefaciens is used for transformation of certain plant cells, as described by Shaw et al., Gene, 23:315 (1983) and PCT International Pub. No. WO 89/05859. For mammalian cells without such cell walls, the calcium phosphate precipitation method of Graham and van der Eb, Virology, 52:456 457 (1978) can be employed. General aspects of mammalian cell host system transfections have likewise been described in U.S. Pat. No. 4,399,216 (hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety). Transformations into yeast are typically carried out according to the method of Van Solingen et al., J. Bact., 130:946 (1977) and Hsiao et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. (USA), 76:3829 (1979). However, other methods for introducing DNA into cells, such as by nuclear microinjection, electroporation, bacterial protoplast fusion with intact cells, or polycations, e.g., polybrene, polyornithine, may also be used. For various techniques for transforming mammalian cells, see Keown et al., Methods in Enzymology, 185:527 537 (1990) and Mansour et al., Nature, 336:348 352 (1988).
  • Suitable host cells for cloning or expressing the DNA in the vectors herein include prokaryote, yeast, or higher eukaryote cells. Suitable prokaryotes include but are not limited Enterobacteriaceae such as Escherichia, e.g., E. coli, Enterobacter, Erwinia, Klebsiella, Proteus, Salmonella, e.g., Salmonella typhimurium, Serratia, e.g., Serratia marcescans, and Shigella, as well as Bacilli such as B. subtilis and B. licheniformis (e.g., B. licheniformis 41 P disclosed in DD 266,710), Pseudomonas such as P. aeruginosa, and Streptomyces. Preferably, the host cell secretes minimal amounts of proteolytic enzymes. For example, the strain may be modified to effect a genetic mutation in the genes encoding proteins endogenous to the host (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 4,946,783). Alternatively, in vitro methods of cloning, e.g., PCR or other nucleic acid polymerase reactions, are suitable.
  • Preferred host cells for producing polypeptides of the invention are prokaryotes, and more preferably bacteria, including eubacteria and archaebacteria. Preferred of these are eubacteria, including gram-positive and gram-negative bacteria. More preferred are gram-negative bacteria. One preferred type of bacteria is Enterobacteriaceae. Examples of bacteria belonging to Enterobacteriaceae include Escherichia, Enterobacter, Erwinia, Klebsiella, Proteus, Salmonella, Serratia, and Shigella. Other types of suitable bacteria include Azotobacter, Pseudomonas, Rhizobia, Vitreoscilla, and Paracoccus. E. coli is particularly preferred herein.
  • Prokaryotic cells used to produce the polypeptides of the invention are grown in media known in the art and suitable for culture of the selected host cells, including the media generally described by Sambrook et al., supra. Media that are suitable for bacteria include, but are not limited to, AP5 medium, nutrient broth, Luria-Bertani (LB) broth, Neidhardt's minimal medium, and C.R.A.P. minimal or complete medium (see, e.g., U.S. Pat. No. 6,828,121), plus necessary nutrient supplements. The media may also contains a selection agent, chosen based on the construction of the expression vector, to selectively permit growth of prokaryotic cells containing the expression vector. For example, ampicillin is added to media for growth of cells expressing ampicillin resistant gene. Any necessary supplements besides carbon, nitrogen, and inorganic phosphate sources may also be included at appropriate concentrations introduced alone or as a mixture with another supplement or medium such as a complex nitrogen source. The culture medium may also optionally contain one or more reducing agents selected from the group consisting of glutathione, cysteine, cystamine, thioglycollate, dithioerythritol, and dithiothreitol. The prokaryotic host cells are cultured at suitable temperatures. For E. coli growth, for example, the preferred temperature ranges from about 20° C. to about 39° C., more preferably from about 25° C. to about 37° C., even more preferably at about 30° C. Any necessary supplements may also be included at appropriate concentrations that would be known to those skilled in the art, introduced alone or as a mixture with another supplement or medium such as a complex nitrogen source. The pH of the medium may be any pH from about 5.9, depending mainly on the host organism. For E. coli, the pH is preferably from about 6.8 to about 7.4, and more preferably about 7.0.
  • In addition to prokaryotes, eukaryotic microbes such as filamentous fungi or yeast are suitable cloning or expression hosts for polypeptide-encoding vectors. Saccharomyces cerevisiae is a commonly used lower eukaryotic host microorganism. Other conventional host microorganisms include filamentous fungi such as, e.g., Neurospora, Penicillium, Tolypocladium (WO 91/00357), and Aspergillus hosts such as A. nidulans (Ballance et al., Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun., 112:284 289 (1983); Tilburn et al., Gene, 26:205 221 (1983); Yelton et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 81: 1470 1474 (1984)) and A. niger (Kelly and Hynes, EMBO J., 4:475 479 (1985)); Kluyveromyces hosts (U.S. Pat. No. 4,943,529; Fleer et al., Bio/Technology, 9:968 975 (1991)) such as, e.g., K. lactis (MW98-8C, CBS683, CBS4574; Louvencourt et al., J. Bacteriol., 154(2):737 742 (1983)), K. fragilis (ATCC 12,424), K. bulgaricus (ATCC 16,045), K. wickeramii (ATCC 24,178), K. waltii (ATCC 56,500), K. drosophilarum (ATCC 36,906; Van den Berg et al., Bio/Technology, 8:135 (1990)), K. thermotolerans, and K. marxianus; yarrowia (EP 0 402 226); Pichia pastoris (EP 0 183 070; Sreekrishna et al., J. Basic Microbiol., 28:265 278 (1988)); Candida; Trichoderma reesia (EP 0 244 234); Neurospora crassa (Case et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 76:5259 5263 (1979)); Schizosaccharomyces pombe (Beach and Nurse, Nature, 290: 140 (1981); EP 0 139 383); and Schwanniomyces such as Schwanniomyces occidentalis (EP 0 394 538).
  • Methylotropic yeasts are also suitable and include, but are not limited to, yeast capable of growth on methanol selected from the genera consisting of Hansenula, Candida, Kloeckera, Pichia, Saccharomyces, Torulopsis, and Rhodotorula. Representative species that are exemplary of this class of yeasts may be found in C. Anthony, The Biochemistry of Methylotrophs, 269 (1982).
  • Suitable host cells for the expression of glycosylated polypeptides are generally derived from multicellular organisms. Examples of invertebrate cells include insect cells such as Drosophila S2 and Spodoptera Sf9, as well as plant cells. Examples of useful mammalian host cell lines include Chinese hamster ovary (CHO) and COS cells. More specific examples include Chinese hamster ovary cells/−DHFR(CHO, Urlaub and Chasin, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 77:4216 (1980)); human embryonic kidney line (293 or 293 cells subcloned for growth in suspension culture, Graham et al., J. Gen Virol., 36:59 (1977)); human liver cells (Hep G2, HB 8065); human lung cells (W138, ATCC CCL 75); monkey kidney CV1 line transformed by SV40 (COS-7, ATCC CRL 1651); mouse sertoli cells (TM4, Mather, Biol. Reprod., 23:243 251 (1980)); and mouse mammary tumor (MMT 060562, ATCC CCL51), among others. The selection of the appropriate host cell is deemed to be within the skill in the art.
  • Once identified, the nucleic acid (e.g., cDNA or genomic DNA) encoding the target polypeptide may be inserted into a replicable vector for cloning (amplification of the DNA) or for expression, and various vectors are publicly available. The vector may, for example, be in the form of a cosmid, plasmid, phage, or viral particle. Many vectors are available for this purpose, and selection of the appropriate vector will depend mainly on the size of the nucleic acid to be inserted into the vector and the particular host cell to be transformed with the vector. The appropriate nucleic acid sequence (such as described below may be inserted into the vector by a variety of procedures. In general, DNA is inserted into an appropriate restriction endonuclease site(s) using techniques known in the art. Vector components generally include, but are not limited to, one or more of a signal sequence, an origin of replication, one or more marker genes, an enhancer element, a promoter, and a transcription termination sequence. Construction of suitable vectors containing one or more of these components employs standard ligation techniques which are known to the skilled artisan.
  • The polypeptide may be produced recombinantly not only directly, but also as a fusion polypeptide with a heterologous polypeptide, which may be a signal sequence or other polypeptide having a specific cleavage site at the N-terminus of the mature protein or polypeptide. In general, the signal sequence may be a component of the vector, or it may be a part of the polypeptide-encoding DNA that is inserted into the vector. The signal sequence may be a prokaryotic signal sequence selected, for example, from the group of the alkaline phosphatase, penicillinase, Ipp, or heat-stable enterotoxin II leaders. For yeast secretion, for example, the signal sequence may be, e.g., the yeast invertase leader, alpha factor leader (including Saccharomyces and Kluyveromyces α-factor leaders, the latter described in U.S. Pat. No. 5,010,182), or acid phosphatase leader, the C. albicans glucoamylase leader (EP 0 362 179), or the signal described in PCT International Pub. No. WO 90/13646. In mammalian cell expression, mammalian signal sequences may be used to direct secretion of the protein, such as signal sequences from secreted polypeptides of the same or related species, as well as viral secretory leaders.
  • Both expression and cloning vectors contain a nucleic acid sequence that enables the vector to replicate in one or more selected host cells. Such sequences are well known for a variety of bacteria, yeast, and viruses. The origin of replication from the plasmid pBR322 is suitable for most Gram-negative bacteria, the 2μ plasmid origin is suitable for yeast, and various viral origins (SV40, polyoma, adenovirus, VSV or BPV) are useful for cloning vectors in mammalian cells.
  • Expression and cloning vectors may also contain a selection gene, also referred to in the art as a selectable marker. Typical selection genes encode proteins that: (a) complement auxotrophic deficiencies; (b) confer resistance to antibiotics or other drugs or toxins, e.g., ampicillin, G418, hygromycin, neomycin, methotrexate, or tetracycline; or (c) supply critical nutrients not available from complex media, e.g., the gene encoding D-alanine racemase for Bacilli.
  • One example of suitable selectable markers for mammalian cells are those that enable the identification of cells competent to take up the colanic acid-degrading polypeptide-encoding nucleic acid, such as DHFR or thymidine kinase. An appropriate host cell when wild-type DHFR is employed is the CHO cell line deficient in DHFR activity, prepared and propagated as described by Urlaub et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 77:4216 (1980). A suitable selection gene for use in yeast is the trp1 gene present in the yeast plasmid YRp7 (see, e.g., Stinchcomb et al., Nature, 282:39 (1979); Kingsman et al., Gene, 7:141 (1979); Tschemper et al., Gene, 10:157 (1980). The trp1 gene provides a selection marker for a mutant strain of yeast lacking the ability to grow in tryptophan, for example, ATCC No. 44076 or PEP4-1 (see, e.g., Jones, Genetics, 85:12 (1977)).
  • Expression and cloning vectors usually contain a promoter operably linked to the polypeptide-encoding nucleic acid sequence to direct mRNA synthesis. Promoters recognized by a variety of potential host cells are well known. Promoters suitable for use with prokaryotic hosts include alkaline phosphatase, a tryptophan (trp) promoter system (e.g., Goeddel, Nucleic Acids Res., 8:4057 (1980); EP 0 036 776); the β-lactamase and lactose promoter systems (e.g., Chang et al., Nature, 275:615 (1978); Goeddel et al., Nature, 281:544 (1979)); and hybrid promoters such as the tac promoter (see, e.g., deBoer et al., Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 80:21 25 (1983)). Promoters for use in bacterial systems may also contain a Shine-Dalgarno (S.D.) sequence operably linked to the DNA encoding the target polypeptide.
  • Examples of suitable promoting sequences for use with yeast hosts include the promoters for 3-phosphoglycerate kinase (Hitzeman et al., J. Biol. Chem., 255:2073 (1980)) or other glycolytic enzymes (Hess et al., J. Adv. Enzyme Reg., 7:149 (1968); Holland, Biochemistry, 17:4900 (1978)), such as enolase, hexokinase, glucokinase, glucose-6-phosphate isomerase, glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase, phosphofructokinase, phosphoglucose isomerase, 3-phosphoglycerate mutase, pyruvate decarboxylase, pyruvate kinase, and triosephosphate isomerase. Other yeast promoters, which are inducible promoters having the additional advantage of transcription controlled by growth conditions, are the promoter regions for acid phosphatase, alcohol dehydrogenase 2, degradative enzymes associated with nitrogen metabolism, enzymes responsible for maltose and galactose utilization, glyceraldehyde-3-phosphate dehydrogenase, isocytochrome C, and metallothionein. Suitable vectors and promoters for use in yeast expression are further described in EP 0 073 657.
  • Target polypeptide transcription from vectors in mammalian host cells is controlled, for example, by promoters obtained from the genomes of viruses such as adenovirus (such as Adenovirus 2), avian sarcoma virus, bovine papilloma virus, cytomegalovirus, fowlpox virus (see, e.g., UK 2,211,504), hepatitis-B virus, polyoma virus, a retrovirus, and Simian Virus 40 (SV40), or from heterologous mammalian promoters (e.g., the actin promoter or an immunoglobulin promoter), and/or from heat-shock promoters, provided such promoters are compatible with the host cell systems.
  • Transcription of a DNA encoding the target polypeptide by higher eukaryotes may be increased in many instances by inserting an enhancer sequence into the vector. Enhancers are cis-acting elements of DNA, typically about from 10 to 300 bp, that act on a promoter to increase its transcription. Numerous enhancer sequences are known from mammalian genes (albumin, α-fetoprotein, elastase, globin, and insulin). Typically, an enhancer from a eukaryotic cell virus will be used. Non-limiting examples include the SV40 enhancer on the late side of the replication origin (bp 100 270), the cytomegalovirus early promoter enhancer, the polyoma enhancer on the late side of the replication origin, and adenovirus enhancers. The enhancer may be spliced into the vector at a position 5′ or 3′ to the polypeptide coding sequence, typically located at a site 5′ from the promoter.
  • Expression vectors used in prokaryotic (e.g., bacteria) and/or eukaryotic host cells (yeast, fungi, insect, plant, animal, human, or nucleated cells from other multicellular organisms) will also contain sequences necessary for the termination of transcription and for stabilizing the mRNA. Such sequences are commonly available from the 5′ and, occasionally 3′, untranslated regions of prokaryotic, eukaryotic, or viral DNAs or cDNAs. These regions contain nucleotide segments transcribed as polyadenylated fragments in the untranslated portion of the mRNA encoding the polypeptide of interest. Still other methods, vectors, and host cells suitable for adaptation to the synthesis of polypeptides in recombinant vertebrate cell culture are described in Gething et al., Nature, 293:620 625 (1981); Mantei et al., Nature, 281:40 46 (1979); EP 0 117 060; and EP 0 117 058.
  • Gene amplification and/or expression may be measured in a sample directly, for example, by conventional Southern blotting, Northern blotting to quantitate the transcription of mRNA (see, e.g., Thomas, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 77:5201 5205 (1980)), dot blotting (DNA analysis), or in situ hybridization, using an appropriately labeled probe, based on the sequences provided herein. Alternatively, antibodies may be employed that can recognize specific duplexes, including DNA duplexes, RNA duplexes, and DNA-RNA hybrid duplexes or DNA-protein duplexes. The antibodies in turn may be labeled and the assay may be carried out where the duplex is bound to a surface, so that upon the formation of duplex on the surface, the presence of antibody bound to the duplex can be detected.
  • Gene expression, alternatively, may be measured by immunological methods, such as immunohistochemical staining of cells or tissue sections and assay of cell culture or body fluids, to quantitate directly the expression of gene product. Antibodies useful for immunohistochemical staining and/or assay of sample fluids may be either monoclonal or polyclonal, and may be prepared in any mammal. Conveniently, the antibodies may be prepared against a full-length sequence polypeptide or against a truncated or fragment peptide based on the DNA sequences provided herein or against exogenous sequence fused to CAE DNA and encoding a specific antibody epitope.
  • Forms of the polypeptide may be recovered from culture medium or from host cell lysates. If membrane-bound, it can be released from the membrane using a suitable detergent solution (e.g. Triton-X 100) or by enzymatic cleavage. Cells employed in expression of polypeptides can be disrupted by various physical or chemical means, such as freeze-thaw cycling, sonication, mechanical disruption, or cell lysing agents. It may be desired to purify the polypeptide(s) from recombinant cell proteins or polypeptides. Exemplary of suitable purification procedures are ammonium sulfate precipitation; chromatofocusing; chromatography on silica or on a cation-exchange resin such as DEAE; ethanol precipitation; fractionation on an ion-exchange column; gel filtration using, for example, Sephadex G-75; metal chelating columns to bind epitope-tagged forms of the polypeptide; protein A Sepharose columns to remove contaminants such as IgG; reverse phase HPLC; and SDS-PAGE. Various methods of protein purification may be employed and such methods are known in the art and described for example in Deutscher, Methods in Enzymology, 182 (1990); Scopes, Protein Purification: Principles and Practice, Springer-Verlag, New York (1982). In general, the purification step(s) performed will depend, for example, on the nature of the production process, the particular polypeptide produced, and the downstream use(s) of the polypeptide.
  • Alternatively, for instance, desired peptides and fragments thereof may be chemically synthesized, or may be extracted from a natural source organism(s). Another alternative approach involves generating polypeptides and fragments thereof by enzymatic digestion, e.g., by treating the protein with an enzyme known to cleave proteins at sites defined by particular amino acid residues, or by digesting the DNA with suitable restriction enzymes and isolating the desired fragment. Yet another suitable technique involves isolating and amplifying a DNA sequence or fragment encoding a desired polypeptide or polypeptide fragment, by polymerase chain reaction (PCR). Oligonucleotides that define the desired termini of the DNA are employed at the 5′ and 3′ primers in the PCR. Where the polypeptide is a polypeptide fragment, the polypeptide fragment preferably shares at least one biological and/or immunological activity with the native (i.e., full-length) polypeptide disclosed herein. In certain instances, the polypeptide fragment may have greater activity than the full-length polypeptide, or may otherwise be optimized or improved relative to the full-length polypeptide.
  • Other alternative methods, which are well known in the art, may also be employed to prepare the polypeptides described herein. For instance, the polypeptide sequence, or portions thereof, may be produced by direct peptide synthesis using solid-phase techniques (see, e.g., Stewart et al., Solid-Phase Peptide Synthesis, W.H. Freeman Co., San Francisco, Calif. (1969); Merrifield, J. Am. Chem. Soc., 85:2149 2154 (1963)). In vitro protein synthesis may be performed using automation, or by manual techniques. Automated synthesis may be accomplished, for instance, using an Applied Biosystems Peptide Synthesizer (Foster City, Calif.) in accordance with the manufacturer's instructions. Various portions of the polypeptides described herein may be chemically synthesized separately and combined using chemical or enzymatic methods to produce the full-length, truncated, or other variant polypeptides.
  • Polynucleotides
  • Another aspect of the disclosure provides polynucleotides and fragments thereof, and partial or complete complements thereof, mRNA, and/or coding sequences, preferably in isolated form, including polynucleotides encoding a polypeptide or enzyme having colanic acid-degrading (CAE) activity and/or a CAE-related protein and fragments thereof (as described above), DNA, RNA, DNA/RNA hybrid, and related molecules, polynucleotides or oligonucleotides complementary to the polynucleotides described herein or mRNA sequence or a part thereof, and polynucleotides or oligonucleotides that hybridize to a CAE-encoding polynucleotide or mRNA of the same.
  • In certain embodiments, the polynucleotide comprises a nucleic acid sequence generally corresponding to SEQ ID NO: 7, and the complement thereof. In certain other embodiments, the polynucleotide comprises a nucleic acid sequence generally corresponding to SEQ ID NO: 8. Preferably, the polynucleotide is an isolated polynucleotide. In other embodiments, the polynucleotide is a recombinant polynucleotide.
  • Polynucleotide variants are also provided herein. Polynucleotide variants may contain one or more substitutions, additions, deletions, and/or insertions such that the activity of the polynucleotide is not substantially diminished, as described above. The effect on the activity of the polynucleotide may generally be assessed as described herein, or using conventional methods. Generally, polynucleotide variants have at least about 80% nucleic acid sequence identity with a nucleotide acid sequence encoding a full-length or truncated polypeptide having colanic acid-degrading activity, as disclosed herein or any other fragment of a full-length or truncated polypeptide sequence as disclosed herein. Variants preferably exhibit at least about 85%, 87%, 88% or 89% identity and more preferably at least about 90%, 92%, 95%, 96%, or 97% identity to a portion of a polynucleotide sequence that encodes a polypeptide having endotoxin-degrading capabilities. The percent identity may be readily determined by comparing sequences of the polynucleotides to the corresponding portion of the target polynucleotide, using any method including using computer algorithms well known to those having ordinary skill in the art, such as Align or the BLAST algorithms (see, e.g., Altschul, J. Mol. Biol. 219:555-565, 1991; Henikoff and Henikoff, Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA 89:10915-10919, 1992), which is available at the NCBI website, and which are described elsewhere herein. Default parameters may be used.
  • Ordinarily, a variant polynucleotide will have at least about 80% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 81% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 82% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 83% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 84% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 85% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 86% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 87% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 88% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 89% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 90% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 91% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 92% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 93% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 94% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 95% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 96% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 97% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 98% nucleic acid sequence identity and alternatively at least about 99% nucleic acid sequence identity with a nucleic acid sequence encoding a full-length polypeptide sequence as disclosed herein (e.g., SEQ ID NO: 7).
  • For polynucleotides encoding truncated polypeptides, the polynucleotide variant will ordinarily have at least about 80% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 81% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 82% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 83% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 84% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 85% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 86% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 87% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 88% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 89% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 90% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 91% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 92% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 93% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 94% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 95% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 96% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 97% nucleic acid sequence identity, alternatively at least about 98% nucleic acid sequence identity and alternatively at least about 99% nucleic acid sequence identity with a nucleic acid sequence encoding a truncated polypeptide sequence as disclosed herein (e.g., SEQ ID NO: 8).
  • In one embodiment, the nucleic acid molecule shares at least 90% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 7. For example, the nucleic acid molecule may share at least 95% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 7, or may share at least 98% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 7. In a particular embodiment, the nucleic acid molecule has the sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 7; that is, the nucleic acid molecule exhibits 100% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 7.
  • In another embodiment, the nucleic acid molecule shares at least 90% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 8. For example, the nucleic acid molecule may share at least 95% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 8, or may share at least 98% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 8. In a particular embodiment, the nucleic acid molecule has the sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 8; that is, the nucleic acid molecule exhibits 100% sequence identity with the nucleic acid sequence set forth in SEQ ID NO: 8.
  • Certain polynucleotide and variants thereof are substantially homologous to a portion of a native gene that encodes a desired target polypeptide. Single-stranded nucleic acids derived (e.g., by thermal denaturation) from such polynucleotides and variants are capable of hybridizing under moderately stringent conditions to a naturally occurring DNA or RNA sequence encoding a native target polypeptide. A polynucleotide that detectably hybridizes under moderately stringent conditions may have a nucleotide sequence that includes at least 10 consecutive nucleotides, for example, at least 50, at least 100, at least 150, at least 200, at least 250, and least 300, at least 350, at least 400, at least 450, at least 500, or more consecutive nucleotides that are complementary to a particular target polynucleotide. In certain preferred embodiments such a sequence (or its complement) will be unique to a single particular target polypeptide for which interference with expression is desired, and in certain other embodiments the sequence (or its complement) may be shared by two or more related target polypeptides for which interference with polypeptide expression is desired.
  • Sequence specific polynucleotides of the present invention may be designed using one or more of several criteria. For example, to design a polynucleotide that has 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90, 100, 200, 300, 400, 500, 600, or more, consecutive nucleotides identical to a sequence encoding a polypeptide of interest (e.g., a polypeptide having colanic acid-degrading activity, such as those described herein), the open reading frame of the polynucleotide sequence may be scanned for sequences that have one or more of the following characteristics: (1) an A+T/G+C ratio of approximately 1:1 but no greater than 2:1 or 1:2; (2) an AA dinucleotide or a CA dinucleotide at the 5′ end; (3) an internal hairpin loop melting temperature less than 55° C.; (4) a homodimer melting temperature of less than 37° C. (melting temperature calculations as described in (3) and (4) can be determined using computer software known to those skilled in the art); (5) a sequence of at least 10-20 consecutive nucleotides not identified as being present in any other known polynucleotide sequence (such an evaluation can be readily determined using computer programs available to a skilled artisan such as BLAST to search publicly available databases). Alternatively, a polynucleotide sequence may be designed and chosen using a computer software available commercially from various vendors (e.g., OligoEngine™ (Seattle, Wash.); Dharmacon, Inc. (Lafayette, Colo.); Ambion Inc. (Austin, Tex.); and QIAGEN, Inc. (Valencia, Calif.)). See also Elbashir et al., Genes & Development 15:188-200 (2000); Elbashir et al., Nature 411:494-98 (2001). The polynucleotides of interest may then be tested for their ability to encode target polypeptides, to hybridize to other polynucleotides of interest, or to interfere with the expression of the target polypeptide according to methods known in the art, and the determination of the effectiveness of a particular polynucleotide based on these tests will be evident to one of skill in the art.
  • Persons having ordinary skill in the art will also readily appreciate that as a result of the degeneracy of the genetic code, many nucleotide sequences may encode a polypeptide as described herein. That is, an amino acid may be encoded by one of several different codons and a person skilled in the art can readily determine that while one particular nucleotide sequence may differ from another (which may be determined by alignment methods disclosed herein and known in the art), the sequences may encode polypeptides with identical amino acid sequences. By way of example, the amino acid leucine in a polypeptide may be encoded by one of six different codons (TTA, TTG, CTT, CTC, CTA, and CTG) as can serine (TCT, TCC, TCA, TCG, AGT, and AGC). Other amino acids, such as proline, alanine, and valine, for example, may be encoded by any one of four different codons (CCT, CCC, CCA, CCG for proline; GCT, GCC, GCA, GCG for alanine; and GTT, GTC, GTA, GTG for valine). Some of these polynucleotides bear minimal homology to the nucleotide sequence of any native gene. Nonetheless, polynucleotides that vary due to differences in codon usage are specifically contemplated by the present invention.
  • The polynucleotide may also comprise a codon optimized sequence; that is, a nucleotide sequence that has been optimized for a particular host species by replacing any codons having a usage frequency of less than about 20%. Nucleotide sequences that have been optimized for expression in a given host species by elimination of spurious polyadenylation sequences, elimination of exon/intron splicing signals, elimination of transposon-like repeats and/or optimization of GC content in addition to codon optimization may be generally referred to in the art as expression enhanced sequences.
  • The polynucleotides may also be labeled with reagents that facilitate their detection. For example, the agents may be combined with fluorescent labels (e.g., Prober et al., Science 238:336-340 (1987); Albarella et al., EP 144914); chemical labels (e.g., Sheldon et al., U.S. Pat. No. 4,582,789; Albarella et al., U.S. Pat. No. 4,563,417); and/or modified bases (e.g., Miyoshi et al., EP 0 119 448) (each of which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entirety).
  • Polynucleotides or fragments thereof of the present invention are also generally capable of specifically hybridizing to other nucleic acid molecules under certain circumstances. For example, two nucleic acid molecules are said to be capable of specifically hybridizing to one another if the two molecules are capable of forming an anti-parallel, double-stranded nucleic acid structure. A nucleic acid molecule or polynucleotide is said to be the complement of another nucleic acid molecule or polynucleotide if they exhibit complete complementarity. Molecules are said to exhibit complete complementarity when every nucleotide of one of the molecules is complementary to a nucleotide of the other. Two molecules are said to be minimally complementary if they can hybridize to one another with sufficient stability to permit them to remain annealed to one another under at least conventional low-stringency conditions. Similarly, the molecules are said to be complementary if they can hybridize to one another with sufficient stability to permit them to remain annealed to one another under conventional high-stringency conditions. Conventional stringency conditions are described elsewhere herein and by Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning, A Laboratory Manual, 2nd Ed., Cold Spring Harbor Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y. (1989) and by Haymes et al., Nucleic Acid Hybridization, A Practical Approach, IRL Press, Washington, D.C. (1985), each of which is herein incorporated by reference. Departures from complete complementarity are therefore permissible, as long as such departures do not completely preclude the capacity of the molecules to form a double-stranded structure. Thus, in order for a nucleic acid molecule to serve as a primer or probe it need only be sufficiently complementary in sequence to be able to form a stable double-stranded structure under the particular solvent and salt concentrations employed.
  • In a particular embodiment, a polynucleotide of the present invention will specifically hybridize to one or more of SEQ ID NO: 7 and SEQ ID NO: 8, or complements thereof, under moderately stringent conditions.
  • Preparation of Polynucleotides
  • Polynucleotides, including polynucleotides encoding polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading activity, may be prepared using any of a variety of techniques, which will be useful for the preparation of specifically desired polynucleotides and for the identification and selection of desirable sequences to be used in polynucleotides. For example, a polynucleotide may be amplified from cDNA prepared from a suitable bacteria, cell, or tissue type. Such polynucleotides may be amplified via polymerase chain reaction (PCR). For this approach, sequence-specific primers may be designed based on the sequences provided herein and may be purchased or synthesized. An amplified portion may be used to isolate a full-length gene, or a desired portion thereof, from a suitable library using well known techniques. Within such techniques, a library (cDNA or genomic) is screened using one or more polynucleotide probes or primers suitable for amplification. Preferably, a library is size-selected to include larger molecules. Random primed libraries may also be preferred for identifying 5′ and upstream regions of genes. Genomic libraries are preferred for obtaining introns and extending 5′ sequences. Suitable sequences for a polynucleotide contemplated by the present invention may also be selected from a library of polynucleotide sequences.
  • For hybridization techniques, a partial sequence may be labeled (e.g., by nick-translation or end-labeling with 32P) using well known techniques. A bacterial or bacteriophage library may then be screened by hybridizing filters containing denatured bacterial colonies (or lawns containing phage plaques) with the labeled probe (see, e.g., Sambrook et al., Molecular Cloning: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Laboratories, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y., 2001). Hybridizing colonies or plaques are selected and expanded, and the DNA is isolated for further analysis. Clones may be analyzed to determine the amount of additional sequence by, for example, PCR using a primer from the partial sequence and a primer from the vector. Restriction maps and partial sequences may be generated to identify one or more overlapping clones. A full-length cDNA molecule can be generated by ligating suitable fragments, using well known techniques.
  • Alternatively, numerous amplification techniques are known in the art for obtaining a full-length coding sequence from a partial cDNA sequence. Within such techniques, amplification is generally performed via PCR. One such technique is known as rapid amplification of cDNA ends or RACE. This technique involves the use of an internal primer and an external primer, which hybridizes to a polyA region or vector sequence, to identify sequences that are 5′ and 3′ of a known sequence. Any of a variety of commercially available kits may be used to perform the amplification step. Primers may be designed using, for example, software well known in the art. Primers (or oligonucleotides for other uses contemplated herein, including, for example, probes and antisense oligonucleotides) are preferably 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31 or 32 nucleotides in length, have a GC content of at least 40% and anneal to the target sequence at temperatures of about 54° C. to 72° C. The amplified region may be sequenced as described above, and overlapping sequences assembled into a contiguous sequence. Certain oligonucleotides contemplated by the present invention may, for some preferred embodiments, have lengths of 10, 11, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20, 21, 22, 23, 24, 25, 26, 27, 28, 29, 30, 31, 32, 33-35, 35-40, 41-45, 46-50, 56-60, 61-70, 71-80, 81-90, or more, nucleotides.
  • Nucleotide sequences as described herein may be joined to a variety of other nucleotide sequences using established recombinant DNA techniques. For example, a polynucleotide may be cloned into any of a variety of cloning vectors, including plasmids, phagemids, lambda phage derivatives, and cosmids. Vectors of particular interest include expression vectors, replication vectors, probe generation vectors, and sequencing vectors. In general, a suitable vector contains an origin of replication functional in at least one organism, convenient restriction endonuclease sites, and one or more selectable markers. (See, e.g., PCT International Pub. No. WO 01/96584; PCT International Pub. No. WO 01/29058; U.S. Pat. No. 6,326,193; U.S. Pub. App. No. 2002/0007051 (each of which is hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety). Other elements will depend upon the desired use, and will be apparent to those having ordinary skill in the art. For example, the invention contemplates the use of polynucleotide sequences in the preparation of recombinant nucleic acid constructs including vectors for the expression of a desired target polypeptide such as a CAE polypeptide; the invention also contemplates the generation of transgenic animals and cells (e.g., cells, cell clones, lines or lineages, or organisms in which expression of one or more desired polypeptides (e.g., a target polypeptide) is facilitated). Within certain embodiments, polynucleotides may be formulated so as to permit entry into a cell of a mammal, and expression therein. Such formulations are particularly useful for therapeutic purposes, as described below. Those having ordinary skill in the art will appreciate that there are many ways to achieve expression of a polynucleotide and/or polypeptide in a target cell, and any suitable method may be employed. For example, a polynucleotide may be incorporated into a viral vector using well known techniques (see also, e.g., U.S. Pub. App. No. 2003/0068821 (hereby incorporated by reference herein in its entirety)). A viral vector may additionally transfer or incorporate a gene for a selectable marker (to aid in the identification or selection of transduced cells) and/or a targeting moiety, such as a gene that encodes a ligand for a receptor on a specific target cell, to render the vector target specific. Targeting may also be accomplished using an antibody, by methods known to those having ordinary skill in the art.
  • In other embodiments, one or more promoters may be identified, isolated and/or incorporated into recombinant nucleic acid constructs of the present invention, using standard techniques. The present invention provides nucleic acid molecules comprising such a promoter sequence or one or more cis- or trans-acting regulatory elements thereof. Such regulatory elements may enhance expression of a polynucleotide or polypeptide described herein. A 5′ flanking region may be generated using standard techniques, based on the genomic sequence provided herein. If necessary, additional 5′ sequences may be generated using PCR-based or other standard methods. The 5′ region may be subcloned and sequenced using standard methods. Primer extension and/or RNase protection analyses may be used to verify the transcriptional start site deduced from the cDNA.
  • To define the boundary of the promoter region, putative promoter inserts of varying sizes may be subcloned into a heterologous expression system containing a suitable reporter gene without a promoter or enhancer. Suitable reporter genes may include genes encoding beta-galactosidase, chloramphenicol acetyl transferase, luciferase, secreted alkaline phosphatase, or the Green Fluorescent Protein (GFP) gene (see, e.g., Ui-Tei et al., FEBS Lett. 479:79-82 (2000)). Suitable expression systems are well known and may be prepared using well known techniques or obtained commercially. Internal deletion constructs may be generated using unique internal restriction sites or by partial digestion of non-unique restriction sites. Constructs may then be transfected into cells that display high levels of polynucleotide and/or polypeptide expression. In general, the construct with the minimal 5′ flanking region showing the highest level of expression of reporter gene is identified as the promoter. Such promoter regions may be linked to a reporter gene and used to evaluate agents for the ability to modulate promoter-driven transcription.
  • Once a functional promoter is identified, cis- and trans-acting elements may be located. Cis-acting sequences may generally be identified based on homology to previously characterized transcriptional motifs. Point mutations may then be generated within the identified sequences to evaluate the regulatory role of such sequences. Such mutations may be generated using site-specific mutagenesis techniques or a PCR-based strategy. The altered promoter is then cloned into a reporter gene expression vector, as described above, and the effect of the mutation on reporter gene expression is evaluated.
  • Antibodies
  • One aspect of the present invention concerns antibodies, single-chain antigen binding molecules, or other proteins that specifically bind to one or more of the polypeptides of the present invention and their homologues, fusions or fragments. Such antibodies may be used to quantitatively or qualitatively detect the polypeptides of the present invention. In general, an antibody or peptide is said to specifically bind to a protein or peptide molecule of the present invention if such binding is not competitively inhibited by the presence of non-related molecules.
  • Polynucleotides that encode all or part of the polypeptide of the present invention can be expressed, via recombinant means, to yield protein or peptides that can in turn be used to elicit antibodies that are capable of binding the expressed protein or peptide. Such antibodies may be used, for example, in immunoassays for that protein. Such protein-encoding molecules, or their fragments may be a fusion molecule (i.e., a part of a larger nucleic acid molecule) such that, upon expression, a fusion protein is produced. It is understood that any of the nucleic acid molecules of the present invention may be expressed, via recombinant means, to yield proteins or peptides encoded by these nucleic acid molecules.
  • The antibodies that specifically bind polypeptides and fragments thereof may be polyclonal or monoclonal and may comprise intact immunoglobulins, or antigen binding portions of immunoglobulins fragments (such as (F(ab′), F(ab′).sub.2), or single-chain immunoglobulins producible, for example, via recombinant means. It is understood that practitioners are familiar with the standard resource materials which describe specific conditions and procedures for the construction, manipulation and isolation of antibodies (see, for example, Harlow and Lane, In: Antibodies: A Laboratory Manual, Cold Spring Harbor Press, Cold Spring Harbor, N.Y. (1988), the entirety of which is herein incorporated by reference).
  • As discussed elsewhere herein, such antibody molecules or their fragments may be used for diagnostic purposes. Where the antibodies are intended for diagnostic purposes, it may be desirable to derivatize them, for example with a ligand group (such as biotin) or a detectable marker group (such as a fluorescent group, a radioisotope or an enzyme). The ability to produce antibodies that bind the protein or peptide molecules of the present invention permits the identification of mimetic compounds of those molecules. Generally, mimetic compounds are compounds that is not the particular compound of interest, or a fragment of that compound, but which nonetheless exhibits an ability to specifically bind to antibodies directed against that compound. In one embodiment, the antibody is a rabbit polyclonal antibody.
  • Kits
  • Other aspects of the invention are directed to kits useful in carrying out the processes described herein. In general, the kits for practice of the methods of the invention preferably have somewhat different forms depending on their intended functions
  • The kits will typically be packaged and include vessels containing reagents, the solution volumes of which will vary based on the amount of preparations for which the kit is rated. The vessels will generally include one or more reagents useful in carrying out the processes described herein. In certain embodiments, the kit is a compartmentalized kit; that is, the kit includes reagents contained in the same or separate vessels. Examples of vessels include, but are not limited to, small glass containers, plastic containers, or strips of plastic or paper. These and other similar vessels allow the efficient transfer of reagents from one compartment to another, or to some other vessel, such that the various samples and reagents are not cross-contaminated and the agents or solutions of each container can be added in a quantitative fashion from one compartment to another. Such containers can include a container which will accept the test sample, a container which contains the polypeptide or polynucleotide of the disclosure, a container which contains host cells or other materials for producing the polypeptides described herein (e.g., a vector, virus, or bacteriophage), containers which contain chromatography materials (such as one or more of the ion exchange, affinity, and hydrophobic interaction chromatography resins described above), containers which contain wash reagents (such as phosphate buffered saline, Tris-buffers, and the like), and/or containers which contain reagents useful in the detection of polysaccharides such as colanic acid (such as those described in the assays detailed below in Example 16). The kit can include sources and concentrations of the CAE polypeptides described herein. For larger scale applications, the kits will generally include similar reagents and solutions, but in larger quantity.
  • For instance, the kit may include a suitable bacterial expression vector for cloning the CAE polynucleotides described herein. Alternatively, the kit may include the polynucleotides and/or polypeptides themselves. The kit may also include cells, such as competent cells, for transforming recombinant clones into expression vectors. The kit may also include media (such as broth) for bacterial expression of the polypeptides of the invention. The kits may also include a set of three common alkaline lysis buffers as described in the Qiagen product manual and in Sambrook et al. as Solutions I, II, and III (i.e., 25 mM Tris HCl with 10 mM EDTA at pH 8.0, 1% SDS and 0.2 N NaOH, and 3 M potassium acetate at pH 5.5 respectively) and/or a resuspension solution (e.g., 10 mM Tris HCl at pH 8.0).
  • In some embodiments, for example, centrifuge-based spin filters or disc filters can be included. One model spin filter that works for this application is a Millipore Durapore centrifuge filter (Millipore Corporation, Billerica, Mass.). In addition, or by way of an alternative, filters can be included that have a packed steel wool, cellulose or polymer/plastic material in a centrifuge or other filter mechanism (e.g., a disc). Ceramic filters can also be included. Filter aids, such as a diatomaceous earth or similar compound, may also be included. For larger scale applications, a tangential-flow filter can be provided.
  • In one particular embodiment, the kit includes one or more of the polypeptides described herein. For example, the polypeptide included in the kit may be a purified polypeptide comprising an amino acid sequence having at least 90%, 98%, 99%, or 100% homology to SEQ ID NO: 1, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. In a particular embodiment, the polypeptide may have the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 1. Additionally or alternatively, the polypeptide included in the kit may be a purified polypeptide comprising an amino acid sequence having at least 90%, 98%, 99%, or 100% homology to SEQ ID NO: 2, and conservative amino acid substitutions thereof. In a particular embodiment, the polypeptide may have the amino acid sequence of SEQ ID NO: 2. The polypeptide included in the kit may also include a tag for isolation or purification (e.g., a His-tag or a FLAG®-tag); thus, the polypeptide included in the kit correspond to SEQ ID NO: 3, SEQ ID NO: 4, SEQ ID NO: 5, or SEQ ID NO: 6. Alternatively, the kit may include reagents and compositions that may be used to form such tagged polypeptides, along with the polypeptides of SEQ ID NO: 1 or SEQ ID NO: 2, and variants thereof.
  • The kits will also typically include instructions for use. The instructions will generally be suitable to enable an end user to carry out the desired preparation or assay. The instructions will generally be in a tangible expression, e.g., describing the reagent concentration for at least one preparation or assay, parameters such as the relative amount of reagent and sample to be admixed, maintenance or incubation time periods for reagent/sample admixtures, temperature requirements or preferences, and the like. The instructions may be printed on the outer or inner packaging of the kit, in a brochure, card, or other paper within the kit, and/or on the outer surface of the containers or vessels included in the kit.
  • Having described the invention in detail, it will be apparent that modifications and variations are possible without departing the scope of the invention defined in the appended claims. Furthermore, it should be appreciated that all examples in the present disclosure are provided as non-limiting examples.
  • Examples
  • Colanic acid is present at significant levels in all plasmid DNA preparations, including clinical grade (cGMP) preparations. Colanic Acid comprises about 25% of the bacterial cell wall of gram negative bacteria. Colanic acid must be removed in order to provide the greatest safety, especially when mixed with cationic carriers for delivery in animals and in humans. Removal of colanic acid also increases gene expression from each plasmid because colanic acid is an inhibitor of RNA polymerase activity. A range of 2.2 to 4.4-fold increased reporter gene expression (CAT, chloramphenicol acetyltransferase) in the organs of Balb/c mice post-intravenous (iv) injection of BIV DNA-liposome complexes has been observed. Because colanic acid is often extremely large and branched-chain, it typically must be degraded in order to be effectively removed.
  • With the identification of colanic acid as a primary contaminating component of plasmid DNA polysaccharides, experiments were performed to develop methods for removing colanic acid from plasmid DNA. A specific enzyme, referred to hereafter as colanic acid degrading enzyme (CAE), had been reported to be produced by specific lytic bacteriophages (Hughes, K. A. et al. 1998. J. Appl. Microbiol. 85:583-590). The colanic acid degrading enzyme (CAE) had only been partially purified by researchers. Therefore, in order to develop a method for removal of colanic acid using a CAE, the enzyme must be purified, sequenced and expressed.
  • A bacteriophage (NST1) was identified that has the ability to lyse the E. coli strain SC12078, a strain that overproduces colanic acid. The NST1 bacteriophage was isolated and used as a source to isolate a purified CAE. It has been shown that polysaccharide viscosity decreases after incubation with a specific polysaccharide degrading enzyme (Sutherland, I. W. 1967. Biochem. J. 104:278-285). Thus, the protein samples containing CAE were identified by their ability to affect viscosity of samples containing colanic acid. It was found that the purified CAE isolated from NST1 had high levels of CAE activity as demonstrated by its ability to decrease the viscosity of colanic acid.
  • Once the purified CAE was isolated, as identified by bioassay of the ability to decrease sample viscosity, it was subjected to mass spectrometry and Edman degradation. Using Edman degradation, 15 amino acids were identified. By mass spectrometry, 8 additional protein fragments were sequenced, with each fragment containing between 6 to 16 amino acids. Screening of publicly available protein databases, including bacteriophage databases, did not reveal a single match with any of the peptide fragments.
  • A set of degenerate oligonucleotides was prepared based on the peptide sequences. These oligonucleotides were used to sequence the Colanic Acid Degrading Enzyme from the genomic DNA purified from the NST1 bacteriophage. The open reading frame (ORF) of the CAE was determined. The nucleotide CAE ORF was sequenced and the amino acid sequence of CAE determined using the universal genetic code. These sequences are shown in FIG. 1. PCR primers made to the beginning and end of the CAE ORF were used to amplify the ORF sequences from the NST1 bacteriophage genomic DNA by PCR for subsequent cloning into a yeast expression vector.
  • A naturally occurring colanic acid degrading enzyme (CAE) has been produced from bacteriophage that is a newly identified protein; generally, only small amounts are produced, approximately 110 ug from a 4.5 L phage+bacterial growth. A rabbit polyclonal antibody to this protein has also been produced that is a peptide generated antibody. This antibody is highly active and can be used for any purpose including Western blotting, ELISA assay, etc.
  • In order to produce large-scale amounts of CAE, a recombinant form of CAE was created for use in further purifying plasmid DNA preparations. Prior attempts to produce full-length recombinant CAE in yeast, baculovirus, and bacteria were generally unsuccessful, believed to be due to improper protein folding. After examining the predicted structure of the CAE and chymotrypsin digestion of the natural protein, we determined that 107 amino acids could be removed from the amino terminus (N-terminus) of the CAE protein without loss of activity. Chymotrypsin was the only protease that cleaved the natural full-length protein at this one location, amino acids 106-107. The recombinant CAE protein is not cleaved by any protease and is extremely stable (>2 years). We produced the functional truncated form of CAE in bacteria using the expression vector pET28a (Invitrogen; see Example 9). The truncated protein is produced in Escherichia coli, BL21(DE3) grown at 16° C. overnight and then purified. About 10 mg of CAE recombinant protein from 1 L of growth can be produced.
  • Any plasmid DNA preparation can then be digested with recombinant CAE and further purified. Briefly, plasmid DNA is digested with CAE for 3 hours at 37° C. and then at 50° C. for 21 hours. Protein is removed, and the DNA is first purified by boronic acid chromatography. The plasmid DNA flows through and does not bind the column. Most polysaccharides except for extremely small fragments bind to the column. To remove the smallest, digested polysaccharides, the DNA suspension is finally purified by a Macrosep 100 Centrifugal Concentrator unit in the presence of zwittergent. The zwittergent is generally preferred because colanic acid appears to bind tightly to the plasmid DNA.
  • For use in the preparation of clinical grade plasmid DNA and to reduce cost, recombinant CAE can also be placed on a solid support that can be regenerated and reused multiple times.
  • By the assays described herein, we find no detectable levels of polysaccharides including colanic acid.
  • Example 1 Preparation of Colanic Acid
  • Colanic acid was prepared using SC12078 bacteria, a bacterial strain that is known to overproduce colanic acid. A few colonies of SC12078 bacteria were picked from a plate and inoculated into 2 liters of LB broth with 0.4% glycerol containing chloramphenicol (10 ug/ml). The bacteria were allowed to grow at 37° C. in a shaker incubator at 230 rpm overnight. The growth was stopped when the cultures reached an optical density (OD) 600 between about 4.5 to about 4.7.
  • Prior to removing the bacteria by centrifugation, the flasks of bacteria were briefly shaken to increase the amount of colanic acid released into the culture medium. The bacteria were pelleted by centrifugation at 6,000×g for 15 min at 4° C. The bacterial pellet was discarded and the supernatant saved and concentrated using an Amicon filter apparatus with a YM30 membrane.
  • The colanic acid was precipitated from the concentrated supernatant by adding 3 volumes of ice cold ethanol to one volume of supernatant and letting the mixture sit on ice for 15 min. The precipitate was collected by centrifuging the mixture at 10,000×g for at least 15 min at 0° C., or until the supernatant is clear. The precipitate was dissolved in a minimal amount of sterile water and dialyzed overnight against at least three changes of water.
  • The dialyzed solution was lyophilized to dryness, being sure to weigh the tube that the solution was to be dried in before adding the solution in order to determine the weight of the sample after freeze drying. Once the sample was totally dried, water was added to the sample to make a 2% solution of the lyophilized sample.
  • Solid ammonium sulfate was added to the 2% solution of the lyophilized sample to achieve a 90% ammonium sulfate saturated solution. The 90% ammonium sulfate saturated solution precipitated the 0 antigen and the colanic acid. The precipitated polysaccharides were collected by centrifugation at 10,000×g for at least 15 min at 0° C., or until the supernatant was clear. The pelleted precipitate was dissolved in a minimal amount of water, dialyzed overnight against at least three changes of water, and lyophilized to dryness.
  • The lyophilate was dissolved in 150 ml of 0.1 M sodium phosphate pH 7.2. The colanic acid was precipitated from the lyophilate solution by adding 37.5 ml of hexa-decyl-trimethyl-ammonium bromide (also called cetavlon or cetrimide). The colanic acid precipitate was collected by centrifugation at 10,000×g for at least 15 min at 0° C., or until the supernatant was clear.
  • The pelleted precipitate was dissolved in 100 ml of 1M NaCl. The colanic acid is reprecipitated by adding 3 volumes of ice cold ethanol to the 1M NaCl solution and letting the mixture sit on ice for 15 min. The colanic acid precipitate was collected by centrifuging the mixture at 10,000×g for at least 15 min at 0° C., or until the supernatant was clear. The colanic acid precipitate was dissolved in a minimal amount of sterile water and dialyzed in a cold room overnight against at least three changes of water.
  • The dialyzed solution was lyophilized to dryness, being sure to weigh the tube that the solution was to be dried in before adding the solution in order to determine the weight of the sample after freeze drying. Once the sample was totally dried, the colanic acid was dissolved in a minimal amount of water, aliquoted into sterile tubes, and stored at −25° C.
  • Example 2 NST1 Phage Production
  • The NST1 bacteriophage was identified as a good source of CAE by its ability to lyse E. coli strain SC12078, a strain that overproduces colanic acid. The NST1 bacteriophage was isolated and used as a source to isolate a purified CAE.
  • A few colonies of SC12078 bacteria were taken from agar plates and inoculated into two tubes containing 5 ml of LB-glycerol media containing 0.4% chloramphenicol (10 ug/ml). The bacteria were allowed to grow at 37° C. overnight to prepare a phage stock that is. Serial dilutions (1:102, 1:101, 1:10°, 1:10−1, and 1:10−2) are prepared of the phage stock containing five different NST1 phage particle numbers. The dilutions are based on 1 ul of phage stock stored at 4° C. containing 107 phage particles). The overnight growth (200 ul) is mixed with 1 ul of phage stock to make the 107 concentration of phage. Additional dilutions are made containing 180 ul of overnight bacterial growth mixed with 20 ul of the next higher concentration of phage. The highest concentrations containing 107 through 103 particles are discarded.
  • The lower 5 dilutions were plated by quickly mixing each into 3 ml of LB+glycerol top agar (agarose at 0.7%, kept at 55° C.). The mixture was quickly poured onto LB+Chloramphenicol (10 ug/ml) plates. The mixing and pouring is preferably done quickly to avoid solidification of the top agar. The plates were then incubated upside down at 37° C. for 5 hours. After incubation, plates were wrapped with parafilm and stored at 4° C. Plates that do not contain plaques are discarded.
  • Example 3 Large Scale Production of NST1 Phage Supernatant
  • The bacterial strain SC12078 (a strain overproducing colanic acid) was maintained on LB-containing chloramphenicol (10 ug/ml) agar plates and stored at 4° C. Several plates of NST1 phage, as described in Example 2, were maintained on LB-glycerol top agar (agarose 0.7%), layered on top of LB-chloramphenicol (10 mg/ml) agar plates stored at 4° C. The plates were not stored for more than one month as NST1 loses viability and its ability to infect bacteria with longer storage time periods.
  • A few colonies of the SC12078 bacteria were inoculated into four 50 ml sterile tubes, each tube containing 15 ml of LB-glycerol-chloramphenicol (10 ug/ml) media. The colonies were allowed to grow overnight at 37° C. in a shaker incubator.
  • Three 4 liter flasks were then inoculated with 15 ml of the overnight culture, each flasks containing 1.5 liters of LB-glycerol-chloramphenicol (10 ug/ml) media. The bacterial colonies were allowed to grow at 37° C. in a shaker incubator (230 rpm) for about 2-4 hours until the solution had an OD600 between 0.12 and 0.67.
  • Each flask was then inoculated with 30 NST1 phage plugs and the flask incubated overnight at 37° C. with shaking (230 rpm). The OD600 of the SC12078 cultures inoculated with the NST1 phage that were incubated overnight was measured and was typically between 4.5 and 4.7. These cultures were centrifuged at 4200 rpm at 4° C. for 5 min using large, autoclaved centrifuge bottles. The supernatant, containing the NST1 phage, was poured into sterile containers and stored at −80° C., or immediately purified. The pellets containing the bacterial cells and debris were discarded.
  • Example 4 Isolation of the Colanic Acid Degrading Enzyme
  • Phage supernatant was prepared as described in Example 3. Phenyl methyl sulfonyl fluoride (PMSF) was added to the phage supernatant to a final concentration of 0.1 mM PMSF to prepare the starting solution and then stored at 4° C.
  • The starting solution for CAE purification was centrifuged in the table-top centrifuged at about 4200 rpm for 20 min at 4° C. The resulting supernatant was removed and saved and the pellet discarded. Using an Amicon filter apparatus and a YM30 membrane, the supernatant volume was reduced from 4 liters to a 4 ml sample. The 4 ml sample was further centrifuged in a polycarbonate centrifuge tube at 40,000×g in an SS34 rotor for 60 minutes at 4° C. The sample was dialyzed overnight in the cold room against at least 3 changes of 10 mM Tris HCl, pH 7.5, containing 0.1 mM PMSF.
  • A Q Sepharose Fast Flow column (10 cm high, 1.5 cm diameter) was equilibrated with 10 mM Tris HCl, pH 7.5, 0.1 mM PMSF until the pH of the fluid eluting from the column was 7.5. The dialyzed supernatant was loaded onto the equilibrated column and the column washed with 2 column volumes (about 30 ml) of 10 mM Tris HCl, pH 7.5, 0.1 mM PMSF.
  • The column was eluted using a linear gradient from 10 mM Tris HCl, pH 7.5, 0.1 mM PMSF (150 ml) to 200 mM Tris HCl, pH 6.5, 0.1 mM PMSF (150 ml) collecting 4 ml fractions (75 fractions total) at a flow rate of 7 ml per hour. The fractions collected were tested for colanic acid degrading activity using a viscometer test, described below in Example 5, and those fractions containing CAE activity were pooled.
  • The pooled CAE active fractions were then concentrated on a disposable Amicon filter by centrifugation. The protein concentration of the resulting concentrate was determined and a sample of the concentrate was electrophoresed on a gradient polyacrylamide gel (4-12%). The electrophoresed sample contained five protein bands.
  • The protein concentrate was then separated by size on a 120 cm column containing Toyopearl HW-50F resin equilibrated with phosphate buffered saline (PBS), pH 7.3-7.4, containing 0.1 mM PMSF. The column eluate was collected in 1 ml fractions. Each fraction was tested for CAE activity and the active fractions were pooled.
  • The pooled fractions were concentrated on a disposable Amicon filter by centrifugation. The protein concentration of the concentrate was determined and a sample of the concentrate was electrophoresed on a gradient polyacrylamide gel (4-12%). A single protein band was obtained that had a molecular weight of about 84,000 Daltons.
  • The protein band was prepared by standard procedures and submitted for mass spectrometric analysis and Edman degradation.
  • Example 5 Identification of the Partial Amino Acid Sequence of CAE Isolated from Bacteriophage NST1
  • The CAE protein was purified as described previously. The purified CAE protein was subjected to mass spectrometry using the Applied Biosystems Procise Sequencer PROCISE-cLC for 17 cycles and Edman degradation. Using Edman degradation, 15 amino acids of the N-terminus were identified as set forth below:
  • ANSYNAYVANGSQTA (SEQ ID NO: 9)
  • By mass spectrometry, 8 additional protein fragments were sequenced, with each fragment containing between 6 to 16 amino acids as set
  • out below:
  • LLEQGTGEALTDGVLR (SEQ ID NO: 10)
    VPNSEVSLNALPNVQR (SEQ ID NO: 11)
    LADYEFTSAPSNSK (SEQ ID NO: 12)
    YSDLSTLN (SEQ ID NO: 13)
    QLLFDTAPLA (SEQ ID: 14)
    APYQVDDNL (SEQ ID NO: 15)
    FGAYLPDD (SEQ ID NO: 16)
    LGTLGG (SEQ ID NO: 17)
  • In each of these peptide fragment sequences the amino acid leucine (L) may actually be either leucine (L) or isoleucine (I), the amino acid aspartic acid (D) may actually be aspartic acid (D) or asparagine (N), the amino acid glutamine (Q) may actually be glutamine (Q) or lysine (K), and the amino acid phenylalanine (F) may actually be phenylalanine (F) or oxidized methionine.
  • Example 6 Cloning the Colanic Acid Degrading Enzyme A. Preparation of Degenerate Oligonucleotide Primers
  • Degenerate oligonucleotide primers are prepared using degenerate codons of the amino acid sequences from the protein fragments of the CAE protein described above.
  • B. Preparation of Bacteriophage Genomic DNA
  • The genomic DNA of the Bacteriophage NST1 was purified using standard DNA purification methods. The degenerate oligonucleotide primers were used to hybridize with the bacteriophage genomic DNA to identify the CAE gene as described below.
  • C. Sequencing and Amplification of CAE gene from Genomic DNA
  • Sequencing of the CAE ORF was performed directly on the NST1 bacteriophage genomic DNA starting with the degenerate primers and then using primers based on known sequences for subsequent rounds of sequencing. The CAE ORF was fully sequenced on both strands of the NST1 bacteriophage genomic DNA.
  • Primers made to the beginning and end of the CAE ORF sequences were made and then used to amplify the sequences of the CAE gene from the NST1 bacteriophage genomic DNA using the Polymerase Chain Reaction (PCR) using the Deep Vent DNA Polymerase (New England BioLabs) to avoid errors during amplification. The amplified DNA was then electrophoresed and the appropriate band was excised and purified from the gel.
  • Example 7 Sequence of the Colanic Acid Degrading Enzyme
  • The nucleotide sequence of the CAE was determined as set out in FIG. 9:
  • (SEQ ID NO: 7)
    ATGGCGAACA GCTATAATGC TTACGTGGCG AACGGTTCAC AGACCGCATT CCTCGTCACG   60
    TTCGAGCAGC GCGTGTTCAC TGAGATTCAG GTGTACCTCA ACTCCGAACT CCAGACGGAA  120
    GGGTACACCT ACAACTCTGT GACCAAACAG ATTATCTTCG ACACCGCCCC GCTCGCCGGG  180
    GTGATTGTCC GACTCCAACG CTACACCTCT GAGGTTCTGC TGAACAAGTT TGGCCAAGAC  240
    GCTGCCTTCA CCGGGCAGAA CCTTGACGAG AACTTTGAGC AGATTCTGTT CAAGGCTGAG  300
    GAAACTCAGG AAGCATGGCT CGCGCCACTT GACCGCGCCG TCCGTGTTCC GAACTCCGAA  360
    GTCTCCATCA ACGCATTACC GAACGTCGCT GGCCGCCGCA ACAAGGCACT GGGCTTTGAC  420
    AGCAATGGTC AGCCGTTCAT GATTCCTCTG GTCGATATCC CGGACTCCGC GCTGGCGATT  480
    GCTCTGGCAA TGGCTGACGG CGGTAAGTGG ATTGGTACTC TCGGCGGGGG CACGTTCCTC  540
    GACCGTCAGG ATACCGTCTG CCTGTCCGAG TTCACCAACA ACACTGGGTA CGCCTCTGTC  600
    GCCGCTGCGG TGCAGGCTTG CTTCGACTAT GCGAAAGCCA ACGGCAAGGT CGTTGACGCT  660
    CGCGGCTGGG AAGGTACGGT GGATTCCACT GTGCTGATGG ACGGTATTGA GGTCGTCGGC  720
    GGTACGTGGC ACGGCAAGGC TGACATTCGC CTGCTGAACT CCACCTTCCG CAACTTCGTG  780
    GCCTCTACTG TCCGTGTCGC CTACTGGGGC GGCGAGGTGC GTATTGCTGA CTATGAGTTC  840
    ACCAGCGCAC CGAGCAACTC CAAGGTTACG TCTATCCTGT TCCAAGGCAA CATCGCCGGG  900
    GGCAGCTACG TCATTGAGAA CGGTATCCAC CGCAATGGTA AGTTCGGTAT TCTCCAACAG  960
    GGTACTGGCG AGGCTATCAC CAACGGCGTT ATCCGTGGCA TCACCATGAT GGATATGCAG 1020
    GGTGACGGTA TCGAGATGAA CGTAATCAAC AAGCACTATG ATGGTGGCCT GCTGATTGAG 1080
    AACATCTTCC TTGAGAACAT CGACGGCACC AACGCGCCTA TCCCACTGTC CAACTGGGGC 1140
    ATTGGTATCG GTATCGCTGG TCAAGGCCCG TTCGGTTGGG ATGCTGCTGA GACGCAGTAT 1200
    GCGAAGAACG TCACTGTCCG TAACGTCCAT GCTCCGCGTG GTGTGCGTCA GGTCGTCCAC 1260
    TTCGAGGTTA CGCGTGACAG CACCTGCGAG AACGTAGTGG CCAACCCTGA CCTGTCCGTC 1320
    TCCATTGGTA CTGGCCTGAC TGCCGCTGGT GTAATCACGT ACGGCTGCAA GCGCATGACC 1380
    ATTGACGGTG TAGTCGGTGA GCCTATGAAC ACCGGAGCAA CCTCTCCGAA CGATATTCGT 1440
    ATCGTGATGT TGGAGTGGGG TGCGAACCAA GCAGGTGCTG GCGGTACGCC GGGTGCAGCT 1500
    TGCCCATCGT TCGACATGAC CGTGCGTAAC GTGCAGACCC GTACCGGGCG CTTCTATGCT 1560
    GGTGTCGGCT CCGACGATGA CAACACCAAC ACATATCACC TTGAAAACAT TCACTGTTAC 1620
    AAGATGACGC TGTTTGGTGT GGCAACTCTG CTGAACATGA CCAACGTGAC TGGTGTGGTG 1680
    TTCGACGCTG TAGGCGATGA CTCCAGCGGC GGTACGTCCT CCAACGGTCT GTACCCGCGT 1740
    AAGAAGACTG TTCTCAACAT GGTGAACGTG AACTTCTACG GGCCGGGCAT GACCGAGGGT 1800
    GCGCTGTACA GTAAGGCTCG CTACTCGGAT ATCAGCACGC TGAACTCCAA CGTGCGTGCT 1860
    ATCCCGTACA CCAACATCCA AGGTAACGTG GGTGTCATCC TGTCTCCGGT CAACCGCATG 1920
    TACACGCTGC CGAACGCCCT CGCTACCCTT GACGGTAATG AGTTCCCCAC CGGGAAAGAG 1980
    TTCTGCGAAG GTACTGTGCT GTTCAAGACC GATGGCTCCG GTGGCAACTT CATCGTGACC 2040
    CGGTTCGGTG CGTACATCCC GGATGACGGT AACAACTTCA AGGTGCGTGC TGCTGCCGCT 2100
    GGCCAGACGT ATCTGGAGCA GAACCTGACT CCGGCTGGTA CTCAGGCTTC CACCTCGTGG 2160
    CTGTACCATA AGCCAATCTC TGCTGGTACT CGACTCAATG TTCCGGGTGC CGGGCCGAGC 2220
    GGCGGTACGC TCACTGTGAC GGTGGTGCGT GCTCCGTATC AGGTGGACAA CAACATCGGA 2280
    AACCCGGTAC GCATCGACAT TACCCCGGCC ATTGTGACGG CAATCCCTGC GGGAACGCAG 2340
    CTCGCCGCTA CCTACCCGGT GGCTTACATC TAA
  • The amino acid sequence was determined using the universal genetic code and is shown in alignment with the nucleotide sequence in FIG. 1. The amino terminus of the CAE matched the Edman degradation results, except the Edman degradation did not detect the terminal methionine. In addition, the molecular weight for the CAE was determined to be 84,354 and corresponded to the molecular weight of the protein band sequenced as determined by its position on polyacrylamide gels.
  • Example 8 Using Colanic Acid Degrading Enzyme in the Purification of Plasmid DNA
  • A plasmid DNA sample is tested for the presence of colanic acid. If colanic acid is present in the plasmid DNA sample then the sample of plasmid DNA is incubated with the recombinant colanic acid degrading enzyme of the present invention. The CAE will digest the colanic acid into a number of smaller polysaccharides that can be separated from the plasmid DNA by a variety of methods known in the art. The plasmid DNA sample will then be separated from the CAE and further purified as described herein.
  • Example 9 Construction of Recombinant CAE, Amino Acids 107-790 (Underlined) Including 6 Histidines at the N-Terminus, in Vector PET-28A-C(+)
  • Amino Acids Contained in the Construct: [(Nco1) MGHHHHHH . . . stop (Xho1)]
  • (SEQ ID NO: 4)
    MGHHHHHHLAPLDRAVRVPNSEVSINALPNVAGRRNKALGF
    DSNGQPFMIPLVDIPDSALAIALAMADGGKWIGTLGGGTFLDRQDTVCLS
    EFTNNTGYASVAAAVQACFDYAKANGKVVDARGWEGTVDSTVLMDGIEVV
    GGTWHGKADIRLLNSTFRNFVASTVRVAYWGGEVRIADYEFTSAPSNSKV
    TSILFQGNIAGGSYVIENGIHRNGKFGILQQGTGEAITNGVIRGITMMDM
    QGDGIEMNVINKHYDGGLLIENIFLENIDGTNAPIPLSNWGIGIGIAGQG
    PFGWDAAETQYAKNVTVRNVHAPRGVRQVVHFEVTRDSTCENVVANPDLS
    VSIGTGLTAAGVITYGCKRMTIDGVVGEPMNTGATSPNDIRIVMLEWGAN
    QAGAGGTPGAACPSFDMTVRNVQTRTGRFYAGVGSDDDNTNTYHLENIHC
    YKMTLFGVATLLNMTNVTGVVFDAVGDDSSGGTSSNGLYPRKKTVLNMVN
    VNFYGPGMTEGALYSKARYSDISTLNSNVRAIPYTNIQGNVGVILSPVNR
    MYTLPNALATLDGNEFPTGKEFCEGTVLFKTDGSGGNFIVTRFGAYIPDD
    GNNFKVRAAAAGQTYLEQNLTPAGTQASTSWLYHKPISAGTRLNVPGAGP
    SGGTLTVTVVRAPYQVDNNIGNPVRIDITPAIVTAIPAGTQLAATYPVAY
    I stop.
  • The PCR amplified region of CAE from amino acids 107 to 790, including 8 additional amino acids at the N-terminus, was digested with restriction enzymes Nco1 and Xho1, and ligated into the multiple cloning site of vector pET-28a-c (+) that was also digested with Nco1 and Xho1. This construct was transformed and grown in expression host BL21 (DE3) in Hyper Broth medium containing 50 mg/liter kanamycin. The large-scale culture was grown at 37° C. with shaking at 225 rpm until OD600 reached 0.5 (about 2 to 4 hours). The temperature was changed to 16° C., and growth was continued for 30 min. Then IPTG was added to a final concentration of 0.015 mM, and growth continued for an additional 20 hours. The recombinant CAE is then purified on a Ni-NTA column that selectively binds the 6 histidines at the N-terminus. The bound protein is then eluted, concentrated, reconstituted in storage buffer, and stored in the refrigerator at 4° C.
  • Example 10 Transform Recombinant CAE Clone into Expression Host BL21 (DE3)
  • Thaw on ice one vial of One Shot® BL21 (DE3) cells. Add 10 ng of plasmid DNA, in a volume of 1 to 5 μl, to the cells and mix by tapping gently. Do not mix cells by pipetting. Incubate the vial on ice for 30 minutes. Incubate for exactly 30 seconds in the 42° C. water bath. Do not mix or shake. Remove vial from the 42° C. bath and quickly place on ice. Add 250 μl of pre-warmed SOC medium to the vial. Place the vial in a microcentrifuge rack and secure the vials in the rack with tape. Place the rack on its side in a shaking incubator, and shake the vial at 37° C. for exactly 1 hour at 225 rpm. Plate 20 to 200 μl each of the transformation reaction onto two LB plates containing 80 μg/ml Kanamycin. Plate two different volumes to ensure well-spaced colonies on at least one plate. The remaining transformation reaction may be stored at +4° C. and plated out the next day, if needed. Invert the plates and incubate at 37° C. overnight.
  • Example 11 Growing Bacteria Expressing Recombinant CAE
  • Inoculate a single colony or 30 μl from a glycerol stock into 30 ml LB medium containing 50 mg/liter kanamycin. Incubate at 37° C. with shaking at 225 rpm overnight. Add 24 ml overnight culture to 2 liters of Hyper Broth medium containing 50 mg/liter kanamycin. Grow the culture at 37° C. with shaking at 225 rpm until OD600 reaches 0.5 (2-4 hours). Change temperature to 16° C., continue shaking for 30 min. Add IPTG to the final concentration of 0.015 mM, continue growing for 20 hours. Harvest cell by centrifugation at 4800×g for 15 min and store the pellet at −80° C.
  • Example 12 Purification of Recombinant CAE
  • Make solutions. Add PMSF just before use.
  • A. 20 mM Tris-HCl pH 8.0, 0.25M NaCl, 10% Glycerol, 10 mM Imidazole, 0.1 ml/liter β-mercaptoethanol, 1 mM PMSF.
  • B. 20 mM Tris-HCl pH 8.0, 0.25M NaCl, 10% Glycerol, 125 mM Imidazole, 0.1 ml/liter β-mercaptoethanol, 0.1 mM PMSF.
  • C. 20 mM Tris-HCl pH 8.0, 0.25M NaCl, 10% Glycerol, 500 mM Imidazole, 0.1 ml/liter β-mercaptoethanol, 0.1 mM PMSF.
  • D. 20 mM Tris-HCl pH 8.0, 0.25M NaCl, 10% Glycerol, 0.1 mM PMSF.
  • Equilibrate Ni-NTA column (20 ml bed volume, for 2 liter culture) with 200 ml of buffer A. Thaw and suspend the cell pellet (from 2 liter culture) in 150 ml of buffer A. Break cell pastes using MICROFLUIDIZER PROCESSOR (Model M-110Y) (according to manufacture's instructions) and centrifuge at 40,000×g to obtain clear supernatant. Load supernatant to Ni-NTA column and wash with 600 ml of Buffer A, then wash with 80 ml of Buffer B. Elute bound recombinant CAE with 80 ml of Buffer C. Add elutant to Amicon Ultra-4 Centrifugal Filter unit with 30K cutoff. Spin at 2800×g at 4° C. to concentrate elutant. Reconstitute the retentate to the original sample volume with Buffer D. Repeat this process three times. Examine the total protein obtained.
  • Example 13 Digestion of Plasmid DNA with Recombinant CAE
  • Purify plasmid DNA from 2.5 liters LB culture using EndoFree Plasmid Giga Kit (according to manufacture's instructions). Dissolve plasmid DNA in 4 ml of 0.05 M potassium phosphate buffer, pH 6.5. Add a suitable amount of recombinant CAE (plasmid DNA: CAE=10:1), incubate at 37° C. for 3 hours. Change temperature to 50° C. and incubate for 21 hours.
  • Example 14 Boronate Affinity Chromatography
  • Boronate chromatography has been used to purify samples containing RNA, mononucleotides, oligonucleotides, thymine glycol-containing DNA, and benzo(a) pyrene: DNA adducts (Schott, H. et al. 1973. Biochemistry 12:932-938; Singh, N. and R. C. Wilson. 1999. J. Chromatography 840:205-213; Jerkovic, B. et al. 1998. Anal. Biochem. 255:90-94; Pruess-Schwartz, D. et al. 1984. Cancer Res. 44:4104-4110). Boronate chromatography, however, has not been used in the past for successful purification of plasmid DNA because no one had identified the presence of substantial quantities of polysaccharides present in plasmid DNA and the toxic effects of these polysaccharides during gene therapy.
  • Commercially available boronic acid affinity resins bind compounds containing cis-diol groups. A preferred boronic acid affinity column can be acquired from Pierce, Rockford, Il. This boronic acid column has a coupled m-aminophenylboronic acid to polyacrylamide spherical beads at 100 mmoles of boronate/ml of gel.
  • The boronic acid column was equilibrated in 0.2 M ammonium acetate, pH 8.8. The plasmid DNA samples were precipitated in ethanol and the precipitate washed with 70% ethanol. The washed pellet of DNA was dissolved in 0.2 M ammonium acetate, pH 8.8. The DNA solution was then loaded onto a boronic acid column at approximately 10 mg DNA per 2 ml of boronate column material. The column was then washed with 0.2 M ammonium acetate, pH 8.8. The column wash was collected in fractions and the optical density (O.D.) of each fraction at 260 nm was measured. The fractions having the highest O.D. 260 nm were pooled and loaded onto a second boronic acid column. The second column was washed with 0.2 M ammonium acetate, pH 8.8. Fractions from the column wash were collected and each of their O.D. 260 nm measured. The fractions having the highest O.D. 260 nm were pooled and the DNA precipitated with ethanol. The precipitate was washed with 70% ethanol and resuspended in 10 mM Tris buffer, pH 8.0. The DNA sample was filter sterilized and stored at −20° C. until it was used.
  • Plasmid DNA did not bind to the boronate column and flowed through the boronate column with the wash buffer. On the other hand, the polysaccharide contaminants, RNA, and LPS bound or adsorbed onto the boronate column. Eluting the polysaccharide fractions with 0.1 M formic acid regenerated the boronic acid columns. The boronic acid columns were then washed and stored in 0.1 M sodium chloride and 0.02% sodium azide.
  • The purified DNA sample was then subjected to the methods of detection and quantification for polysaccharides of the present invention. Each purified sample was subjected to one or more polysaccharide detection method (i.e., the uronic acid detection method, the fucose detection method, and/or the fluorescence labeling method). The results of the polysaccharide detection methods consistently demonstrated that the use of boronate chromatography produced DNA samples with polysaccharide contents that were reduced to undetectable levels. These data are provided below in Table 2.
  • Example 15 Macrosep Clean-Up
  • After Boronic Acid chromatography, pool the fractions having the highest OD260. Precipitate plasmid DNA with 2 volume of 100% cold ethanol, and 1/10 volume of 3M sodium acetate, pH 5.2. Incubate at −20° C. (1 hour to 0/N). Spin at 13000 rpm for 15 min at 4° C. Wash the pellet twice with 1 ml of 70% ethanol, spin at 13000 rpm for 5 min. Air dry and resuspend the pellet in 14 ml of 10 mM Tris-HCl, pH 8.0, containing 0.1% zwittergent. Incubate at 37° C. for 15 min. Add solution to Macrosep 100 Centrifugal Concentrator unit with 300K cutoff (according to manufacture's instructions). Spin at 3500 rpm for 1 hour at 30° C. to concentrate plasmid DNA. Reconstitute the retentate to the original sample volume with 10 mM Tris-HCl, pH 8.0, containing 0.1% zwittergent. Spin at 3500 rpm for 1 hour at 30° C. Repeat this process three times. Reconstitute the retentate to the original sample volume with 10 mM Tris-HCl, pH 8.0. Spin at 3500 rpm for 1 hour at 30° C. Repeat this process two times. Precipitate plasmid DNA with 2 volume of 100% cold ethanol, and 1/10 volume of 3M sodium acetate, pH 5.2. Incubate at −20° C. (1 hour to 0/N). Spin at 13000 rpm for 15 min at 4° C. Wash the pellet twice with 1 ml of 70% ethanol, spin at 13000 rpm for 5 min. Air dry and resuspend the plasmid DNA pellet in sterile water and adjust the final concentration to 5 mg/ml.
  • Example 16 Quantification of Polysaccharides in Plasmid DNA Samples
  • In order to assure that any method of purification of a plasmid DNA sample successfully removes virtually all of the contaminating polysaccharides, a means for assessing polysaccharide contamination of DNA before and after such purification process was developed.
  • Three assays were developed, one based on detection of uronic acid levels (where polysaccharides are known to contain high levels of uronic acid), one based on fucose levels (where fucose is known to make up 22% of colanic acid), and one based on the visual detection of fluorescent-labeled polysaccharides in gel-electrophoresed samples.
  • 1. Uronic Acid Assay
  • E. coli expresses several major classes of polysaccharides, including O- and K-antigen associated polysaccharides, colanic acid, and enterobacterial common antigen (ECA). Colanic acid exists in both high and low molecular weight forms, whereas ECA is typically in a low molecular weight form. The O- and K-antigen associated polysaccharides have variants that are associated with Lipid A and other variants that are not associated with Lipid A. The Lipid A associated polysaccharides may be either covalently linked, or non-covalently linked. The Lipid A associated polysaccharides are characteristically low molecular weight variants. The O- and K-antigen associated polysaccharides that are not associated with Lipid A exist as high and low molecular weight variants.
  • Each of these E. coli capsular polysaccharides, particularly the long-chain and branched polysaccharides found in plasmid DNA preparations, contains uronic acid. For example, colanic acid is approximately 11 weight % uronic acid. Enterobacterial common antigen (ECA) consists of about 33 weight % uronic acid and the O- and K-antigen associated polysaccharides have about 25 weight % uronic acid.
  • The uronic acid content of a plasmid DNA sample was measured using standard curves generated with heparin sulfate and glucuronic acid as standards. Heparin sulfate resembles the polysaccharide contaminants from E. coli, because uronic acid comprises about 25% of the total weight of heparin sulfate. Heparin sulfate consists of 50% sugars by weight. Half of these sugars are glucosamine and the other half of the sugars are iduronic acid and glucuronic acid. The rest of the heparin sulfate is contributed by modifications of the sugars including sulfates and acetylamides. Alternatively, glucuronic acid can be used to create a standard curve for the direct measurement of uronic acid.
  • Standard curves are generated using 0.1 ml of heparin or glucuronic acid standards containing 0.0, 0.05, 0.1, 0.2, or 0.5 mg of the standard per milliliter of solution. The standard solution (0.1 ml) is placed is a glass test tube with 3 ml of a borate/sulfuric acid solution (i.e., 0.025 M sodium tetraborate 10-hydrate dissolved in sulfuric acid having a specific gravity of 1.84) and mixed well. A 0.1 ml of a 0.125% solution of carbazole in absolute ethanol is added to the mixture and the entire mixture is vortexed. The top of each test tube is covered and the tubes are immersed in boiling water for 10 min. The tubes are allowed to cool and the absorbance of the solution at 530 nm is read in a spectrophotometer. The absorbance values obtained for the standards are plotted against the concentration of the standards. The uronic acid content of plasmid DNA samples can be extrapolated from its absorbance value at 530 nm when the DNA sample has undergone the same reaction.
  • The polysaccharide content of the plasmid DNA sample can then be extrapolated by multiplying the amount of uronic acid by a number ranging from 3.3 to 9.1 (depending on the prevalence of colanic acid, ECA and the O- and K-antigens in the sample). The uronic acid content of plasmid DNA samples was calculated from standard curves generated with heparin and glucuronic acid standards. The results generated from the two standard curves were substantially equivalent.
  • This method was used to assess the uronic acid content of many plasmid DNA preparations; such DNA preparations included GMP grade DNA prepared by certain companies for use in human drug trials, as well as clinical grade DNA. “GMP” is a term used by the U.S. Food and Drug Administration to designate a compound as having been produced according to regulations known as the Good Manufacturing Practice (GMP) regulations. Compounds produced by GMP are considered to be safe for use in humans. The results of testing various plasmid DNA preparations are presented below in Table 2.
  • TABLE 2
    Amount of Uronic Acid
    DNA Plasmid Preparation/Source Detected (mg/mg DNA)
    Qiagen Endotoxin Free, Prep A 0.12
    Qiagen Endotoxin Free, Prep B 0.18
    GMP Grade DNA, Company 1 0.11
    Clinical Grade DNA, Company 1 0.11
    GMP Grade DNA, Company 2 0.11
    GMP Grade DNA, Company 3, Prep A 0.20
    GMP Grade DNA, Company 3, Prep B 0.22
    GMP Grade DNA, Company 4, Prep A 0.22
    GMP Grade DNA, Company 4, Prep A 0.25
    Plasmid DNA prepared according to 0.00
    present disclosure
  • 2. Fucose Assay
  • Since gram-negative bacteria are known to consist of approximately 25% colanic acid, plasmid DNA preparations were also subjected to an assay for colanic acid. The colanic acid assay was based on the amount of fucose present per mg of DNA. Colanic acid consists of 22% fucose in the ratio of 2:2:1:1:3 (fucose:galactose: glucose: uronic acid:other modifications), whereas the other polysaccharide contaminants do not contain fucose, or only small amounts of fucose. Thus, the fucose assay allowed for identification of the amount of colanic acid contamination in a purified plasmid DNA preparation.
  • For example, a plasmid DNA preparation containing about 0.7 mg polysaccharide per mg of DNA, as estimated by the uronic acid assay, had 0.14 mg of fucose per mg of DNA or about 0.64 mg of colanic acid. It was generally found that the primary polysaccharide contaminant in plasmid DNA preparations was colanic acid.
  • Since colanic acid was present in high levels in even clinical grade plasmid DNA, it is necessary to assure that any method of purification of a plasmid DNA sample successfully removes virtually all of the contaminating colanic acid. Thus, a method for assessing colanic acid contamination of DNA before and after such purification process was developed.
  • The basic procedures for assay of fucose content in samples can be found in a paper by Morris (Morris, J. B. 1982. Anal. Biochem. 121:129-134). Detailed descriptions of the solution preparation and storage conditions for solutions and samples for this assay have also been published (Passonneau, J. V. and O. H. Lowry. 1974. In: Methods of Enzymatic Analysis, U. H. Bergmeyer (ed.), 2nd edition, Academic Press: New York, volume 4, pp. 2059-2072).
  • DNA samples to be assayed (450 ug) are transferred to 3 ml vials and lyophilized. To each sample, 200 ul of 5.5 M trifluoroacetic acid is added and the reaction vials are sealed with a Teflon-lined cap. Hydrolysis is accomplished by heating the samples for 4 hours at 100° C. After cooling to room temperature, the trifluoroacetic acid is removed with a stream of argon gas under a fume hood. The remaining residue is then redissolved in 212 ul of sterile water. Only 200 ul of the resulting sample, which corresponds to 425 ug of the initial DNA sample, is used in the fucose assay.
  • Using the method described by Morris (1982. Anal. Biochem. 121:129-134), 200 ul of the samples and standards are pipetted into 1.5 ml micro centrifuge tubes. The standards used are fucose solutions ranging in concentration from 0 ug fucose to 200 ug fucose (0, 1, 12.5, 25, 50, 100 and 200 ug fucose).
  • The tubes are placed on ice and 50 ul of a 1 mg/ml fucose dehydrogenase solution is added, followed by 50 ul of 200 uM NAD+. The tubes are mixed and incubated for 3 hours at 4° C. To stop the enzymatic reaction, 50 ul of 1 N NaOH is added to each tube, mixed, and incubated for 10 minutes at 60° C. The tubes are then cooled on ice and the samples are mixed with 50 ul of 1 M hydrochloric to neutralize the samples.
  • From each sample, a 50 ul aliquot is removed and transferred to a fresh 1.5 ml micro centrifuge tube. To each sample, 250 ul of cycling reagent (200 mM Tris pH 8.4; 50 mM ammonium acetate; 0.5 mM ADP; 100 mM lactate; 5 mM alpha-ketoglutarate; 20 units/ml lactate dehydrogenase; 20 units/ml glutamate dehydrogenase) is added, the solution is mixed, and incubated for 1 hour at room temperature. Heating each tube for 2 minutes in boiling water stops the enzymatic reaction of the cycling reagent.
  • The tubes are cooled on ice and then 250 ul of pyruvate reagent (800 mM imidazole buffer, pH 6.2; 0.45 mM NADH; 0.06 units/ml lactate dehydrogenase) is added and the tubes mixed. The tubes are then warmed for 1 to 2 minutes at room temperature in a water bath before placement in an incubator at 30° C. for 20 minutes. The pyruvate reaction is stopped by adding 200 ul of 1.5 M HCl to each sample and mixing the solution.
  • The contents of each tube are then transferred to a 15 ml capped tube and 2.5 ml of 6 N NaOH is added and mixed. The tubes are then incubated for 10 minutes at 60° C. After cooling the samples to room temperature, 4 ml of sterile water is added to each tube, the tubes inverted and then subjected to fluorescence measurement.
  • A part of each sample (300 ul) is aliquoted into a well of a 96-well microtiter plate. Three to five wells are filled with sterile water and used as blanks. The fluorometer is set using a 360 nm excitation filter and a 465 nm emission filter. The fluorescence of the standards and samples is read and the fluorescence of the blanks subtracted out. The fluorescence readings of the standards are graphed as a standard curve and the amount of fucose in the plasmid DNA samples is determined by interpolation from the standard curve.
  • Using this method, the fucose levels of plasmid DNA samples were determined and the concentration of colanic acid levels calculated. Colanic acid was consistently found to be the primary contaminant in plasmid DNA from a variety of sources, even GMP grade plasmid DNA.
  • 3. Fluorescent Detection of Gel Electrophoresed DNA Samples
  • A visual method developed for the detection of polysaccharides in plasmid DNA samples involved labeling of the samples with a substance capable of selectively labeling polysaccharides in a plasmid DNA sample. One such substance is DTAF, (4,6-dichlorotriazinyl) aminofluorescein (Molecular Probes, Eugene, Oreg.). DTAF specifically labels all polysaccharides whether or not they contain uronic acid. This fluorescence probe reacts with hydroxyl groups found in polysaccharides or carbohydrates and is therefore a probe with application beyond the assay method using uronic acid detection.
  • DTAF does not label DNA, since DNA does not have free hydroxyl groups available. All of the available hydroxyl groups in DNA are phosphorylated. This specificity makes DTAF the preferred label for distinguishing DNA from its polysaccharide contaminants. Although DTAF was used in the method of the present invention, one of skill would understand that any fluorescence label that provides for specificity of labeling between polysaccharides and DNA would be useful in the method of the present invention.
  • DNA and polysaccharide can be visualized in parallel samples run on one gel. DNA is pretreated with ethidium bromide (EtBr) before adding the samples to the gel. Polysaccharides are labeled with DTAF. A plasmid DNA sample can be run in two lanes on one gel with the sample in one lane stained with EtBr and the sample in the other lane stained with DTAF; thereby, allowing one to visualize the polysaccharide and DNA content of a plasmid DNA sample.
  • DNA and polysaccharide standards (40 ul of a 2 mg/ml solution) were precipitated by the addition of 10 ul of 3M sodium acetate, pH 5.2, followed by 200 ul of cold ethanol. The samples were incubated for 30 minutes at −20° C., then centrifuged 4 minutes at 10,000 rpm in an Eppendorf microfuge. The precipitates were then suspended in 10 ul sodium acetate plus 200 ul ethanol and recentrifuged. The precipitates were then resuspended in 200 ul ethanol, recentrifuged and dissolved in 50 ul 0.1 M sodium carbonate, pH 10.5.
  • A fresh DTAF suspension is prepared by suspending 60 mg/ml DTAF in carbonate buffer. Since not all of the DTAF will go into solution, the resulting suspension is vortexed before its addition to each sample. A 5 ul sample of the fresh DTAF suspension (which has been kept dark and cold) is added to the dissolved sample at timed intervals of 0 minutes, 45 minutes, and 90 minutes. Upon each addition of the DTAF suspension, the reaction mixture is vortexed and placed at room temperature in the dark. The reaction is terminated after 2.5 hours by precipitating each sample with the addition of 10 ul sodium acetate and 325 ul ethanol. Incubating these samples for 45 minutes at −20° C. encourages the precipitation. The samples are then centrifuged and the precipitates washed 3 times with 25 ul sodium acetate and 500 ul ethanol. The samples are finally washed with 500 ul ethanol and then dried for 20 minutes at room temperature in the dark.
  • The washed samples are dissolved in 40 ul Tris Acetate EDTA (TAE) buffer and 2.5 ul to 20 ul of the sample are applied to the gel. DNA samples that were not reacted with DTAF were added to other lanes in the gel in the presence of EtBr. Lambda DNA-Hind III Digest and PhiX174 DNA-HaeIII Digest are run as gel markers.
  • The gel is a 1% agarose Tris Acetate EDTA gel, pH 8.3. Neither the gel nor the running buffer contain ethidium bromide. The gel is electrophoresed for 45 minutes at 90 volts. It is important to note that the sample buffer must be free of bromophenol blue, which will quench the DTAF fluorescence, except in the Lambda Hind III marker lane.
  • FIG. 2 shows a gel where several different DNA plasmid samples were tested using this gel electrophoretic method for polysaccharide visualization and quantification. LPS (Sigma Chemical Company, St. Louis, Mo.) and “detoxified” LPS, where the fatty acid portions of the Lipid A have been removed, (Sigma Chemical Company, St. Louis, Mo.) were added as controls in lanes 10 and 8 respectively of the gel. Lanes 1-4 and 12 illustrate the DTAF staining of plasmid DNA samples for which the uronic acid content is given in Table 1. Lane 5, 7, 9, 11 and 13 have no sample loaded. Lane 6 illustrates the DTAF staining of a Qiagen endotoxin free DNA sample (currently considered the gold standard for purified plasmid DNA).
  • Lanes 14 through 20 of the gel illustrated in FIG. 2 show the results of EtBr staining of different DNA samples. Lanes 14-17 are the same DNA samples stained with EtBr that are stained with DTAF in Lanes 1-4. Lane 18 is the DNA sample shown in Lane 12 stained with EtBr. Lane 19 is the EtBr stain of the Qiagen endotoxin-free DNA sample, shown in Lane 6 stained with DTAF. Lane 20 is a mixture of high and low DNA molecular weight markers labeled with EtBr.
  • The results showed that the polysaccharides and the DNA migrate at different locations on the gel and that DTAF only labeled polysaccharides contained in the DNA samples and ethidium bromide only labeled DNA. All of the DNA samples, including the Qiagen endotoxin-free DNA, had detectable levels of polysaccharides. LPS and detoxified LPS also contained detectable levels of polysaccharides. Therefore, although the “detoxified” LPS (Sigma Chemical Company, St. Louis, Mo.) has supposedly had all Lipid A removed, there were still significant levels of polysaccharides detected in Lane 8 which contained the detoxified LPS sample.
  • These data are provided below in Table 3.
  • TABLE 3
    Polysaccharide
    DNA Plasmid Method of Detected
    Preparation Detection (mg/mg DNA)
    Boronate-purified uronic acid assay undetectable, ≦0.05
    plasmid DNA
    Boronate-purified DTAF/EtBr gels undetectable by
    plasmid DNA visualization
  • 4. Toxicity of Polysaccharides Found in Plasmid DNA Samples
  • To determine whether the levels of polysaccharide detected in plasmid DNA samples were clinically significant, acute toxicity studies of the samples were performed in animals. Balb/c mice, six weeks old, were injected intravenously with DNA-liposome complexes, where the liposomes were prepared according to published procedures (Nancy Smyth Templeton, et al. July 1997. Nature Biotechnology 15:647-652). Twenty mice in each group were injected and followed for one week post-injection. The results are shown in Table 4.
  • Results showed that the intravenous injection of 100 ul of DNA containing 0.4 mg polysaccharide per mg DNA caused all of the mice to die within 18 hours post-injection. In contrast, the injection of 50 ul of the same DNA did not cause any of the animals to dies within a week after injection. Similar results were obtained using DNA samples from various sources.
  • Plasmid DNA containing levels of about 0.26 mg polysaccharide per mg DNA were found to reduce gene expression when 50 ug DNA were injected into immune compromised transgenic mice once a week for three months. When plasmid DNA preparations contained undetectable levels of polysaccharide per mg DNA (<0.03 mg), there were no adverse effects in the animals.
  • TABLE 4
    # Dead Mice # Dead Mice
    # Mice
    18 hr 1 Wk Post-
    Source of DNA [DNA] Injected Post-Injection Injection
    Clean DNA* 100 μg 20 0 0
    Clean DNA*  50 μg 20 0 0
    Qiagen Endo-Free 100 μg 20 20 NA
    Qiagen Endo-Free  50 μg 20 0 0
    GMP, Company #1 100 μg 20 20 NA
    GMP, Company #1  50 μg 20 0 0
    GMP, Company #2 100 μg 20 20 NA
    GMP, Company #2  50 μg 20 0 0
    Clean DNA + 0.4 mg 100 μg 20 20 NA
    polysaccharide/mg
    DNA
    Clean DNA + 0.4 mg  50 μg 20 0 0
    polysaccharide/mg
    DNA
    Liposomes** 0 20 0 0
    *Clean DNA contains no detectable polysaccharide as measured by the uronic acid assay or staining with DTAF.
    **The quantity of liposomes injected were equivalent to the quantity injected with 100 μl of DNA.
  • We also performed additional in vivo studies in mice to test our DNA purification procedure using the truncated CAE recombinant protein. These studies were performed in normal mice (Balb/c), and in SCID mice with or without pancreatic tumors. SCID mice are more sensitive to colanic acid and die at iv injections containing 40 ug of commercially produced plasmid DNA complexed to liposomes and other cationic carriers, whereas Balb/c mice die at levels just above 50 ug of plasmid DNA. In the tables show in FIGS. 12-14, we showed that a total of 120 mice survived high doses of DNA-BIV liposomal complexes post-iv injections, purified according to the processes of the invention.
  • 5. Assay for Detecting CAE Using BCA Reagent
  • Principle: Colanic Acid Enzyme (6×His-CAE) and other carbohydrases increase the reducing ends when degrading their substrates. The miniaturized highly sensitive bicinchoninic acid (BCA) reducing value assay, presented in this protocol detects reducing ends of sugars. This assay can be used for the detection of all carbohydrases degrading any polysaccharide; enzymes with either an exo- or endo-type of mechanisms. However caution should be exercised to reduce background absorbance caused by culture medium, proteins and substrates.
  • Material and Equipment:
  • Colanic Acid (CA): 2 μg/μl in 0.05 M potassium phosphate buffer pH 6.5
  • 6×His-CAE: 0.5 μg/μl in 0.05 M potassium phosphate buffer pH 6.5
  • Bovine Serum Albumin (BSA): 0.5 μg/μl in 0.05 M potassium phosphate buffer pH 6.5
  • Buffer: 0.05 M potassium phosphate buffer pH 6.5
  • Micro BCA Protein Assay Kit (Pierce Product #23235)
  • Optical 96-Well Reaction plate (Applied Biosystems, Part #4306737)
  • 96 Well, Flat bottom Non Tissue Culture tested, Nonsterile PVC Flexible Plate(Falcon #353912) or Fisherbrand Flat Bottom 96 Well plate, clear, PS, non-sterile (Cat #12565501)
  • Multichannel pipet
  • 96 Well Plate Reader
  • 37° C. and 50° C. Incubator
  • Centrifuge with rotor for spinning 96 well plate
  • Brief Procedure: Briefly, this assay uses a 96 well format, with each well contains a mixture of 2 μg of CAE (TEST) or BSA (BLANK), 100 μg CA, in a total volume of 110 μl of Buffer which is incubated at 37° C. for 3 hours, and later at 50° C. for 21 hours. Subsequently 100 μl of each reaction mix is transferred to a new 96 well plate, to which 100 μl of freshly prepared BCA reagent is added and allowed to incubate at 37° C. for 2 hours, cooled to RT for 15 min, and readings at 550 nm are taken using a multiplate reader.
  • Detailed Procedure: In an Optical 96-Well Reaction plate (Applied Biosystems), Aliquot Blank total volume is 110 μl (i.e. Buffer+CA+BSA) in triplicates, i.e. add the following in the same sequence, 56 μl Buffer+50 μl of 2 μg/μl CA+4 μl of 0.5 μg/μl BSA.
  • Aliquot Test total volume is 110 μl (i.e. Buffer+CA+6×His CAE) in triplicates, i.e. add the following in the sequence, 56 μl Buffer+50 μl of 2 μg/μl CA+4 μl of 0.5 μg/μl 6×His-CAE.
  • Seal all the wells using the strip caps provided. Spin the plate at 1500 rpm at RT for 1 min. Remove caps from the wells, and mix by gently pipeting up and down three times using Multichannel pipet. Reseal the wells using the caps and incubate plate in 37° C. incubator for 3 hours.
  • Shift plate to 50° C. incubator and incubate overnight for a total of 21 hours.
  • Spin plate at 1500 rpm at RT for 1 min.
  • Use a multichannel pipet to aliquot 100 μl of each well sample to a new 96 well plate (Falcon or Fisherbrand).
  • Prepare BCA reagent by mixing the three reagents provided in the Micro BCA kit, i.e., MA+MB+MC in a ratio of 0.5:0.48:0.02 using enough to be sufficient for all the wells. Aliquot 100 μl of this freshly prepared BCA reagent to each of the well using a multichannel pipet, mixing gently by pipeting three times up and down. Put lid on 96 well plate, and incubate plate in 37° C. incubator for 2 hours. Let plate cool at room temp for 15 mins, and take reading at 550 nm using multiplate reader.
  • To get the value of CAE activity subtract values of Blank from the Test. Note: You can take readings at other wavelengths if the Multiplate reader does not allow you to take at 550 nm, For example at 544 nm, 570 nm, 595 nm. But readings are best near to the 550 nm.
  • References: P. J. A. Meeuwsen, J.-P. Vincken, G. Beldman and A. G. J. Voragen, J. A Universal Assay for screening expression libraries for carbohydrases. Biosci. Bioeng. 89 (2000), pp. 107-109; Verhoef R, Beldman G, Schols H A, Siika-aho M, Rättö M, Buchert J, Voragen A G. Characterisation of a 1,4-beta-fucoside hydrolase degrading colanic acid. Carbohydr Res. 2005 Aug. 15; 340(11):1780-1788.
  • 6A. Viscosity Assay for the Detection of CAE in Plasmid DNA Preparations
  • Principle: Colanic Acid (CA) is viscous, and there is a reduction of its viscosity when it is catalytically degraded by Colanic Acid Enzyme (6×His-CAE). This drop in viscosity can be accurately measured using a viscometer and can be used to calculate activity of CAE by comparing it to the values obtained using a Control reaction i.e., containing CA but in the absence of the enzyme.
  • Material and Equipment:
  • Colanic Acid (CA) 1.2 mg/ml in 0.05 M Potassium Phosphate Buffer pH 6.5
  • Colanic Acid Enzyme (6×His-CAE) 1.0 μg/μl in 0.05 M Potassium Phosphate Buffer pH 6.5
  • Buffer: 0.05 M Potassium Phosphate Buffer pH 6.5
  • Water Bath at 37° C.
  • Brookfield DV-I+Viscometer
  • Brookfield CPE 40 spindle
  • Brief Procedure:
  • 600 μg CA was mixed with 1 μg CAE in the presence of 0.05 M Pot Phosphate Buffer pH 6.5, in a total volume of 500 μl. Mix an incubate at 37° C. using a water bath. Let cool to RT for 10 min, and take readings using a viscometer. This is compared to a Control reaction in the absence of CAE.
  • Detailed Procedure:
  • For CONTROL, in a 1.5 ml eppendorf tube, aliquot 0.5 ml of 1.2 mg/ml CA+50 μl 0.05 M Pot Phosphate Buffer pH 6.5.
  • For TEST, in a 1.5 ml eppendorf tube, aliquot 0.5 ml of 1.2 mg/ml CA+1 μl of 6×His-CAE (1.0 μg/μl)+49 μl 0.05 M Pot Phosphate Buffer pH 6.5.
  • Mix by gently pipeting up and down, and incubate at 37° C. for 1 hour using a water bath. Remove tubes from water bath and let cool to RT for 10 min.
  • Measure Viscosity of Test and Control using a Brookfield DV+Viscometer, set at 100 rpm, for 30 seconds using 0.5 ml of the respective reaction mix aliquoted into a CPE 40 spindle.
  • Note down Viscosity values as CentiPoise (cP) for both Test and Control, and calculate CAE activity using cP values as follows: The calculation is based on the fact that water which has no viscosity has a cP value of 1.00. If CAE has 100% activity it would reduce the viscosity of CA to a cP value of 1.00. Hence for eg If the CONTROL has a cP value of 1.57, we would substract 1.00 from it to get a value of 1.57-1.00=0.57 which represents 100% activity (that is if the cP value drops by 0.57 in the test it would have 100% CAE activity). If the TEST has a cP value of 1.05, we would similarly substract this cP value from that of the Control. i.e. 1.57-1.05=0.52, this figure would be used to calculate actual CAE activity as follows: 0.57 is 100% activity, hence 0.52 is how much % activity ? 0.52 multiplied by 100 and divided by 0.57=91.22% CAE activity.
  • 6B. Viscometry Testing for Identification of CAE Activity
  • A bioassay measuring changes in the viscosity of colanic acid samples was used to detect CAE. A decrease the viscosity of colanic acid samples was indicative of CAE activity. The viscosity of the colanic acid samples, before and after incubation with an enzyme fraction, was measured using a Wells-Brookfield Cone Plate viscometer with a CPE-40 cone. This viscometer provided the most sensitive measurement of changes in viscosity in small volumes of about 500 ul. Viscometer accuracy was monitored by measuring the viscosity of a mineral oil standard and comparing the reading with the known viscosity for mineral oil.
  • The CAE assay utilized a 500 ul sample of a 1.5% colanic acid solution. Diluted enzyme samples or controls samples, between 50 to 100 ul, was added to the 1.5% colanic acid solution. Controls for the enzyme assays were prepared by adding the diluted enzyme samples to buffer and by adding non-proteinaceous samples to the 1.5% colanic acid solution. Each test sample (enzyme samples or control samples) was incubated for one hour at 37° C. After the one hour incubation, the test samples were allowed to adjust to room temperature for 10 minutes.
  • The viscosity of all test samples was taken at room temperature for 30 seconds at 100 rpm. All test samples having CAE activity, isolated and purified as described above, demonstrated a significant decrease in viscosity, as compared to the control samples that showed no change in viscosity. The CAE test samples decreased the viscosity of the 1.5% colanic acid solution from 1.51 to 0.99, where 0.99 was the lowest viscometry reading obtainable using the Wells-Brookfield Cone Plate viscometer and was equal to the viscometry reading of the buffer controls.
  • Therefore, the present invention provides both a method of detection and quantification of polysaccharides in plasmid DNA samples and a method for removing polysaccharide from plasmid DNA samples to levels of polysaccharides below levels that produce clinically significant toxicity.
  • It is to be understood that this invention is capable of other embodiments and of being practiced and carried out in various ways. Also, it is to be understood that the phraseology and terminology employed herein is for the purposes of description and should not be regarded as limiting.
  • All of the compositions and methods disclosed and claimed herein can be made and executed without undue experimentation in light of the present disclosure. While the compositions and methods of this invention have been described in terms of preferred embodiments, it will be apparent to those of skill in the art that variations may be applied to the compositions and/or methods and in the steps or in the sequence of steps of the methods described herein without departing from the concept, spirit and scope of the invention. More specifically, it will be apparent that certain agents which are both chemically and physiologically related may be substituted for the agents described herein while the same or similar results would be achieved. All such similar substitutes and modifications apparent to those skilled in the art are deemed to be within the spirit, scope and concept of the invention as defined by the appended claims.

Claims (20)

1. A gram negative bacterial plasmid composition comprising gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA and less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
2. The composition of claim 1, wherein the composition comprises less than about 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
3. The composition of claim 1, wherein the composition comprises no detectable colanic acid.
4. The composition of claim 1, wherein the composition comprises no detectable colanic acid, as measured by a bicinchoninic acid (BCA) assay.
5. The composition of claim 1, wherein the composition further comprises less than about 0.1 mg uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
6. The composition of claim 1, wherein the composition further comprises less than about 0.05 mg uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
7. The composition of claim 1, wherein the composition comprises no detectable uronic acid.
8. The composition of claim 1, wherein the composition comprises no detectable uronic acid, as measured by a uronic acid assay.
9. The composition of claim 1, wherein the composition further comprises less than about 0.1 mg fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
10. The composition of claim 1, wherein the composition further comprises less than about 0.05 mg fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
11. The composition of claim 1, wherein the composition comprises no detectable fucose.
12. The composition of claim 1, wherein the composition comprises no detectable fucose, as measured by a fucose assay.
13. The composition of claim 1, wherein the composition comprises no visually detectable polysaccharides when combined with a polysaccharide-selective labeling agent.
14. The composition of claim 13 wherein the polysaccharide-selective labeling agent is (4,6-dichlorotriazinyl)aminofluorescein (DTAF).
15. A gram negative bacterial plasmid composition comprising gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, less than about 0.1 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.1 mg uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
16. The composition of claim 15 wherein the composition further comprises less than about 0.1 mg fucose per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
17. The composition of claim 16 wherein the composition comprises no detectable colanic acid, uronic acid, and fucose.
18. A gram negative bacterial plasmid composition comprising gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, less than about 0.05 mg of colanic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA, and less than about 0.05 mg fucose acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
19. The composition of claim 15 wherein the composition further comprises less than about 0.05 mg uronic acid per mg of gram negative bacterial plasmid DNA.
20. The composition of claim 19 wherein the composition further comprises no detectable colanic acid, fucose, uronic acid chromosomal or genomic DNA, RNA, protein, and/or endotoxin contaminants.
US12/433,645 2008-04-30 2009-04-30 Highly pure plasmid dna preparations Abandoned US20110020924A1 (en)

Priority Applications (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US12/433,645 US20110020924A1 (en) 2008-04-30 2009-04-30 Highly pure plasmid dna preparations
US13/431,359 US20120231537A1 (en) 2008-04-30 2012-03-27 Highly Pure Plasmid DNA Preparations
US14/099,488 US20140093888A1 (en) 2009-04-30 2013-12-06 Highly pure plasmid dna preparations

Applications Claiming Priority (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US12592308P 2008-04-30 2008-04-30
US12591608P 2008-04-30 2008-04-30
US12/433,645 US20110020924A1 (en) 2008-04-30 2009-04-30 Highly pure plasmid dna preparations

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/433,691 Continuation-In-Part US8460908B2 (en) 2008-04-30 2009-04-30 Polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading activity

Related Child Applications (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/433,691 Continuation-In-Part US8460908B2 (en) 2008-04-30 2009-04-30 Polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading activity
US13/431,359 Continuation-In-Part US20120231537A1 (en) 2008-04-30 2012-03-27 Highly Pure Plasmid DNA Preparations

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20110020924A1 true US20110020924A1 (en) 2011-01-27

Family

ID=41255821

Family Applications (8)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/433,701 Expired - Fee Related US8647857B2 (en) 2008-04-30 2009-04-30 Processes for the digestion of colanic acid
US12/433,691 Active US8460908B2 (en) 2008-04-30 2009-04-30 Polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading activity
US12/433,674 Expired - Fee Related US8969068B2 (en) 2008-04-30 2009-04-30 Processes for the preparation of highly pure plasmid compositions by enzymatic digestion of colanic acid
US12/433,645 Abandoned US20110020924A1 (en) 2008-04-30 2009-04-30 Highly pure plasmid dna preparations
US13/858,697 Expired - Fee Related US8524475B1 (en) 2008-04-30 2013-04-08 Polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading activity
US13/954,682 Expired - Fee Related US8735119B2 (en) 2008-04-30 2013-07-30 Polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading activity
US14/103,573 Abandoned US20140349389A1 (en) 2008-04-30 2013-12-11 Processes for the digestion of colanic acid
US14/606,901 Abandoned US20150132843A1 (en) 2008-04-30 2015-01-27 Processes for the Preparation of Highly Pure Plasmid Compositions

Family Applications Before (3)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/433,701 Expired - Fee Related US8647857B2 (en) 2008-04-30 2009-04-30 Processes for the digestion of colanic acid
US12/433,691 Active US8460908B2 (en) 2008-04-30 2009-04-30 Polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading activity
US12/433,674 Expired - Fee Related US8969068B2 (en) 2008-04-30 2009-04-30 Processes for the preparation of highly pure plasmid compositions by enzymatic digestion of colanic acid

Family Applications After (4)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US13/858,697 Expired - Fee Related US8524475B1 (en) 2008-04-30 2013-04-08 Polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading activity
US13/954,682 Expired - Fee Related US8735119B2 (en) 2008-04-30 2013-07-30 Polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading activity
US14/103,573 Abandoned US20140349389A1 (en) 2008-04-30 2013-12-11 Processes for the digestion of colanic acid
US14/606,901 Abandoned US20150132843A1 (en) 2008-04-30 2015-01-27 Processes for the Preparation of Highly Pure Plasmid Compositions

Country Status (11)

Country Link
US (8) US8647857B2 (en)
EP (1) EP2283131B1 (en)
JP (2) JP5693449B2 (en)
KR (1) KR20110028258A (en)
CN (2) CN103255130B (en)
AU (1) AU2009242587B2 (en)
CA (1) CA2739341A1 (en)
HK (1) HK1189027A1 (en)
IL (1) IL209001A (en)
SG (1) SG2014015010A (en)
WO (1) WO2009135048A2 (en)

Cited By (3)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US8969068B2 (en) 2008-04-30 2015-03-03 Gradalis, Inc. Processes for the preparation of highly pure plasmid compositions by enzymatic digestion of colanic acid
WO2020191251A1 (en) * 2019-03-20 2020-09-24 Anchor Molecular Inc. Method of removing nucleic acids from human plasma
US11541105B2 (en) 2018-06-01 2023-01-03 The Research Foundation For The State University Of New York Compositions and methods for disrupting biofilm formation and maintenance

Families Citing this family (17)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JP6153516B2 (en) * 2011-06-06 2017-06-28 バイオカーティス エヌベー Selective lysis of cells by ionic surfactants.
JP5899731B2 (en) * 2011-09-13 2016-04-06 ソニー株式会社 Nucleic acid purification method, nucleic acid extraction method, and nucleic acid purification kit
WO2013142352A1 (en) 2012-03-20 2013-09-26 The Research Foundation Of State University Of New York Flocculation of lignocellulosic hydrolyzates
US9556427B2 (en) * 2013-02-27 2017-01-31 Syngenta Participations Ag Methods and compositions for preparation of nucleic acids
US9850512B2 (en) 2013-03-15 2017-12-26 The Research Foundation For The State University Of New York Hydrolysis of cellulosic fines in primary clarified sludge of paper mills and the addition of a surfactant to increase the yield
US9951363B2 (en) 2014-03-14 2018-04-24 The Research Foundation for the State University of New York College of Environmental Science and Forestry Enzymatic hydrolysis of old corrugated cardboard (OCC) fines from recycled linerboard mill waste rejects
US11389783B2 (en) 2014-05-02 2022-07-19 W.R. Grace & Co.-Conn. Functionalized support material and methods of making and using functionalized support material
KR102445863B1 (en) * 2014-06-13 2022-09-20 아반토 퍼포먼스 머티리얼즈, 엘엘씨 High purity lower endotoxin carbohydrate (HPLE) composition, and method for isolation thereof
WO2016196906A1 (en) * 2015-06-05 2016-12-08 W. R. Grace & Co.-Conn. Adsorbent bioprocessing clarification agents and methods of making and using the same
US10947262B2 (en) * 2016-06-14 2021-03-16 Biogen Ma Inc. Hydrophobic interaction chromatography for purification of oligonucleotides
CN106554956A (en) * 2016-12-07 2017-04-05 安徽智飞龙科马生物制药有限公司 A kind of method that industrialization prepares BCG CpG DNA
CN111088248B (en) * 2019-12-23 2020-10-16 广州湾区生物科技有限公司 Magnetic material for extracting endotoxin-free plasmid and use method thereof
EP4090380A1 (en) 2020-01-13 2022-11-23 Gradalis, Inc. Methods for treating cancers using gm-csf encoding polynucleotide and additional agents
CN111304193A (en) * 2020-02-28 2020-06-19 恒瑞源正(上海)生物科技有限公司 Method for large-scale rapid purification of plasmid DNA
CN111462813B (en) * 2020-03-18 2020-10-20 华东师范大学 Protein fusion design method based on alpha helix fusion of two proteins and maintenance of respective subunit activities
CN112960780B (en) * 2021-03-03 2023-02-03 龙江环保集团股份有限公司 Pretreatment method of biomembrane carrier and biological sewage treatment process
CN113265396B (en) * 2021-05-31 2024-01-09 上海碧博生物医药科技有限公司 Process for continuous production of large plasmid DNA

Citations (25)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4604359A (en) * 1979-07-05 1986-08-05 Genentech, Inc. Microbial expression of a gene for human growth hormone
US5747663A (en) * 1994-02-07 1998-05-05 Qiagen Gmbh Process for the depletion or removal of endotoxins
US5792651A (en) * 1994-02-07 1998-08-11 Qiagen Gmbh Enhancement of the transfection efficiency of nucleic acids by using isopropanol in aqueous solutions
US5808041A (en) * 1993-08-30 1998-09-15 Promega Corporation Nucleic acid purification using silica gel and glass particles
US5898071A (en) * 1994-09-20 1999-04-27 Whitehead Institute For Biomedical Research DNA purification and isolation using magnetic particles
US5969129A (en) * 1994-01-27 1999-10-19 The University Of Strathclyde Purification of polynucleotides from polynucleotide/polysaccharide mixtures
US5972663A (en) * 1997-06-19 1999-10-26 Consortium Fur Elektrochemische Industrie Gmbh Microorganisms and processes for the fermentative preparation of L-cysteine, L-cystine, N-acetylserine or thiazolidine derivatives
US6069230A (en) * 1994-11-10 2000-05-30 Promega Corporation High level expression and facile purification of proteins, peptides and conjugates for immunization, purification and detection applications
US6194562B1 (en) * 1998-04-22 2001-02-27 Promega Corporation Endotoxin reduction in nucleic acid purification
US20020010145A1 (en) * 1999-07-12 2002-01-24 Willson Richard C. Apparatus, methods and compositions for biotechnical separations
US20020177196A1 (en) * 2001-04-04 2002-11-28 Consortium Fur Elektrochemische Industrie Gmbh Process for preparing non-proteinogenic L-amino acids
US20020197637A1 (en) * 2001-06-02 2002-12-26 Willson Richard C. Process and compositions for protection of nucleic acids
US6503738B1 (en) * 1996-02-12 2003-01-07 Cobra Therapeutics Limited Method of plasmid DNA production and purification
US6504021B2 (en) * 2000-07-05 2003-01-07 Edge Biosystems, Inc. Ion exchange method for DNA purification
US20030064951A1 (en) * 1998-11-12 2003-04-03 Valentis, Inc. Methods for purifying nucleic acids
US6617443B2 (en) * 2000-03-06 2003-09-09 Merck Patent Gmbh Method for removing endotoxins
US6617108B1 (en) * 1999-07-12 2003-09-09 Technology Licensing Co. Llc Methods and compositions for biotechnical separations using selective precipitation by compaction agents
US6855816B1 (en) * 1999-01-29 2005-02-15 Xantos Biomedicine Ag Method for producing endotoxin-free nucleic acids and the use thereof
US20050080251A1 (en) * 2002-02-21 2005-04-14 Raf Lemmens Method of separation using aromatic thioether ligands
US7026468B2 (en) * 1996-07-19 2006-04-11 Valentis, Inc. Process and equipment for plasmid purification
US20070213289A1 (en) * 2004-04-19 2007-09-13 Centelion Method for purifying plasmid DNA
US20080269174A1 (en) * 2005-07-21 2008-10-30 Syngenta Crop Protection, Inc. Fungicidal Combinations
US20090068707A1 (en) * 2006-05-24 2009-03-12 Scarab Genomics, Llc Plasmid dna preparations and methods for producing same
US7740850B2 (en) * 2007-04-17 2010-06-22 ImClone, LLC PDGFRβ-specific antibodies
US20130315985A1 (en) * 1996-02-06 2013-11-28 Roche Diagnostics Gmbh Process for preparing purified nucleic acid and the use thereof

Family Cites Families (20)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4981591A (en) 1989-04-07 1991-01-01 Cuno, Incorporated Cationic charge modified filter media
US5206161A (en) 1991-02-01 1993-04-27 Genentech, Inc. Human plasma carboxypeptidase B
MX9603866A (en) 1994-03-18 1997-03-29 Boehringer Ingelheim Int Process for treating eucaryotic cells.
US5534911A (en) * 1994-11-02 1996-07-09 Levitan; Gutman Virtual personal channel in a television system
US5758257A (en) * 1994-11-29 1998-05-26 Herz; Frederick System and method for scheduling broadcast of and access to video programs and other data using customer profiles
AU705804B2 (en) * 1995-04-07 1999-06-03 Betzdearborn Inc. Exopolysaccharide degrading enzyme and use of the same
SE9703532D0 (en) 1997-09-30 1997-09-30 Pharmacia Biotech Ab A process for the purification of plasmid DNA
US7041814B1 (en) * 1998-02-18 2006-05-09 Genome Therapeutics Corporation Nucleic acid and amino acid sequences relating to Enterobacter cloacae for diagnostics and therapeutics
DE69922740T2 (en) 1998-05-11 2005-12-08 Tosoh Corp., Shinnanyo Method for the separation of nucleic acids by liquid chromatography
JP2003535589A (en) * 2000-06-02 2003-12-02 パル・コーポレーション Processing of plasmid-containing solutions
PT102491B (en) 2000-07-10 2003-02-28 Inst Superior Tecnico PROCESS FOR PRODUCTION AND PURIFICATION OF PLASMIDIC DNA
US6772147B2 (en) * 2002-02-26 2004-08-03 Sony Corporation System and method for effectively implementing a personal channel for interactive television
CN101472604B (en) 2006-01-19 2013-11-06 研究技术股份有限公司 Viable non-toxic gram negative bacteria
CN101091797B (en) 2006-06-23 2012-08-01 上海海规生物科技有限公司 Method for taking off endotoxin in primary pure plasmids or proteins, and kit
US8252526B2 (en) * 2006-11-09 2012-08-28 Gradalis, Inc. ShRNA molecules and methods of use thereof
US9211581B2 (en) 2007-09-21 2015-12-15 Wilson Tool International Inc. Stripper assemblies and components thereof for multi-tool punch assemblies
US20120231537A1 (en) 2008-04-30 2012-09-13 Gradalis, Inc. Highly Pure Plasmid DNA Preparations
JP5693449B2 (en) 2008-04-30 2015-04-01 グラダリス インク.Gradalis, Inc. High-purity plasmid DNA preparation and preparation method thereof
US20140093888A1 (en) 2009-04-30 2014-04-03 Gradalis, Inc. Highly pure plasmid dna preparations
US8166038B2 (en) * 2009-06-11 2012-04-24 Kaufman Mark A Intelligent retrieval of digital assets

Patent Citations (27)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US4634677A (en) * 1979-07-05 1987-01-06 Genentech, Inc. Plasmid capable of expressing human growth hormone
US4604359A (en) * 1979-07-05 1986-08-05 Genentech, Inc. Microbial expression of a gene for human growth hormone
US5808041A (en) * 1993-08-30 1998-09-15 Promega Corporation Nucleic acid purification using silica gel and glass particles
US5969129A (en) * 1994-01-27 1999-10-19 The University Of Strathclyde Purification of polynucleotides from polynucleotide/polysaccharide mixtures
US6297371B1 (en) * 1994-02-07 2001-10-02 Qiagen Gmbh Process for the preparation of endotoxin-free or endotoxin-depleted nucleic acids and/or oligonucleotides for gene therapy
US5747663A (en) * 1994-02-07 1998-05-05 Qiagen Gmbh Process for the depletion or removal of endotoxins
US5792651A (en) * 1994-02-07 1998-08-11 Qiagen Gmbh Enhancement of the transfection efficiency of nucleic acids by using isopropanol in aqueous solutions
US5898071A (en) * 1994-09-20 1999-04-27 Whitehead Institute For Biomedical Research DNA purification and isolation using magnetic particles
US6069230A (en) * 1994-11-10 2000-05-30 Promega Corporation High level expression and facile purification of proteins, peptides and conjugates for immunization, purification and detection applications
US20130315985A1 (en) * 1996-02-06 2013-11-28 Roche Diagnostics Gmbh Process for preparing purified nucleic acid and the use thereof
US6503738B1 (en) * 1996-02-12 2003-01-07 Cobra Therapeutics Limited Method of plasmid DNA production and purification
US7026468B2 (en) * 1996-07-19 2006-04-11 Valentis, Inc. Process and equipment for plasmid purification
US5972663A (en) * 1997-06-19 1999-10-26 Consortium Fur Elektrochemische Industrie Gmbh Microorganisms and processes for the fermentative preparation of L-cysteine, L-cystine, N-acetylserine or thiazolidine derivatives
US6194562B1 (en) * 1998-04-22 2001-02-27 Promega Corporation Endotoxin reduction in nucleic acid purification
US20030064951A1 (en) * 1998-11-12 2003-04-03 Valentis, Inc. Methods for purifying nucleic acids
US6855816B1 (en) * 1999-01-29 2005-02-15 Xantos Biomedicine Ag Method for producing endotoxin-free nucleic acids and the use thereof
US6617108B1 (en) * 1999-07-12 2003-09-09 Technology Licensing Co. Llc Methods and compositions for biotechnical separations using selective precipitation by compaction agents
US20020010145A1 (en) * 1999-07-12 2002-01-24 Willson Richard C. Apparatus, methods and compositions for biotechnical separations
US6617443B2 (en) * 2000-03-06 2003-09-09 Merck Patent Gmbh Method for removing endotoxins
US6504021B2 (en) * 2000-07-05 2003-01-07 Edge Biosystems, Inc. Ion exchange method for DNA purification
US20020177196A1 (en) * 2001-04-04 2002-11-28 Consortium Fur Elektrochemische Industrie Gmbh Process for preparing non-proteinogenic L-amino acids
US20020197637A1 (en) * 2001-06-02 2002-12-26 Willson Richard C. Process and compositions for protection of nucleic acids
US20050080251A1 (en) * 2002-02-21 2005-04-14 Raf Lemmens Method of separation using aromatic thioether ligands
US20070213289A1 (en) * 2004-04-19 2007-09-13 Centelion Method for purifying plasmid DNA
US20080269174A1 (en) * 2005-07-21 2008-10-30 Syngenta Crop Protection, Inc. Fungicidal Combinations
US20090068707A1 (en) * 2006-05-24 2009-03-12 Scarab Genomics, Llc Plasmid dna preparations and methods for producing same
US7740850B2 (en) * 2007-04-17 2010-06-22 ImClone, LLC PDGFRβ-specific antibodies

Non-Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Title
Boyd et al. Towards single-copy gene expression systems making gene cloning physiologically relevant. J. Bacteriol. 182:842-847, 2000. *

Cited By (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US8969068B2 (en) 2008-04-30 2015-03-03 Gradalis, Inc. Processes for the preparation of highly pure plasmid compositions by enzymatic digestion of colanic acid
US11541105B2 (en) 2018-06-01 2023-01-03 The Research Foundation For The State University Of New York Compositions and methods for disrupting biofilm formation and maintenance
WO2020191251A1 (en) * 2019-03-20 2020-09-24 Anchor Molecular Inc. Method of removing nucleic acids from human plasma
US11365405B2 (en) 2019-03-20 2022-06-21 Anchor Molecular Inc. Method of removing nucleic acids from human plasma

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US8460908B2 (en) 2013-06-11
US8647857B2 (en) 2014-02-11
JP2011519560A (en) 2011-07-14
US8524475B1 (en) 2013-09-03
WO2009135048A3 (en) 2009-12-23
EP2283131A4 (en) 2011-08-10
HK1189027A1 (en) 2014-05-23
EP2283131A2 (en) 2011-02-16
US20140349389A1 (en) 2014-11-27
EP2283131B1 (en) 2016-08-10
US20100075404A1 (en) 2010-03-25
US20130309752A1 (en) 2013-11-21
JP6038972B2 (en) 2016-12-07
SG2014015010A (en) 2014-05-29
IL209001A0 (en) 2011-01-31
US20090275088A1 (en) 2009-11-05
CN103255130B (en) 2015-12-23
US20150132843A1 (en) 2015-05-14
US8969068B2 (en) 2015-03-03
US20090275122A1 (en) 2009-11-05
IL209001A (en) 2016-10-31
KR20110028258A (en) 2011-03-17
JP2015128428A (en) 2015-07-16
US8735119B2 (en) 2014-05-27
CN103255130A (en) 2013-08-21
AU2009242587B2 (en) 2015-05-28
WO2009135048A2 (en) 2009-11-05
CA2739341A1 (en) 2009-11-05
JP5693449B2 (en) 2015-04-01
CN102171341A (en) 2011-08-31
AU2009242587A1 (en) 2009-11-05
US20130210118A1 (en) 2013-08-15

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US8735119B2 (en) Polypeptides having colanic acid-degrading activity
US20120231537A1 (en) Highly Pure Plasmid DNA Preparations
US20140093888A1 (en) Highly pure plasmid dna preparations
JP4804347B2 (en) Compositions and methods for purifying RNA using a solid support
JP3379758B2 (en) Enhancement of transfection efficiency of nucleic acid using aqueous solution containing isopropanol
CA2122004C (en) Heparinase gene from flavobacterium heparinum
CN101622345B (en) A novel beta-galactoside-alpha-2,6-sialyltransferase, a geneencoding thereof, and a method for enhancing enzyme activity
Firozi et al. Identification and removal of colanic acid from plasmid DNA preparations: implications for gene therapy
JP2014082936A (en) Variant reverse transcriptase
JP6236512B2 (en) Agarase, compositions comprising said, and applications thereof
CN102803486A (en) Novel protein and gene that codes therefor
US20160319316A1 (en) Method for producing fructose-added carbohydrate
WO2015075842A1 (en) Variant reverse transcriptase
JP2013165669A (en) Variant reverse transcriptase
KR100488965B1 (en) Nucleotide sequences and amino acid sequences of aminoglycoside phosphotransferase and uses thereof
JP4196232B2 (en) Polypeptide purification method and kit reagent
WO1999037785A1 (en) RECOMBINANT BirA PROTEIN

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AS Assignment

Owner name: GRADALIS,INC., TEXAS

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:TEMPLETON, NANCY SMYTH;REEL/FRAME:022760/0342

Effective date: 20090513

AS Assignment

Owner name: STRIKE BIO, INC., TEXAS

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:GRADALIS, INC.;REEL/FRAME:035603/0731

Effective date: 20140228

STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION